blob: 390fab01de339cd00a753b928e9ac5cd346501f8 [file] [log] [blame]
Bram Moolenaar45758762016-10-12 23:08:06 +02001*options.txt* For Vim version 8.0. Last change: 2016 Oct 12
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002
3
4 VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
5
6
7Options *options*
8
91. Setting options |set-option|
102. Automatically setting options |auto-setting|
113. Options summary |option-summary|
12
Bram Moolenaar2ec618c2016-10-01 14:47:05 +020013For an overview of options see quickref.txt |option-list|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000014
15Vim has a number of internal variables and switches which can be set to
16achieve special effects. These options come in three forms:
17 boolean can only be on or off *boolean* *toggle*
18 number has a numeric value
19 string has a string value
20
21==============================================================================
Bram Moolenaarf75a9632005-09-13 21:20:47 +0000221. Setting options *set-option* *E764*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000023
24 *:se* *:set*
25:se[t] Show all options that differ from their default value.
26
27:se[t] all Show all but terminal options.
28
29:se[t] termcap Show all terminal options. Note that in the GUI the
30 key codes are not shown, because they are generated
31 internally and can't be changed. Changing the terminal
32 codes in the GUI is not useful either...
33
34 *E518* *E519*
35:se[t] {option}? Show value of {option}.
36
37:se[t] {option} Toggle option: set, switch it on.
38 Number option: show value.
39 String option: show value.
40
41:se[t] no{option} Toggle option: Reset, switch it off.
42
Bram Moolenaar00a927d2010-05-14 23:24:24 +020043 *:set-!* *:set-inv*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000044:se[t] {option}! or
45:se[t] inv{option} Toggle option: Invert value. {not in Vi}
46
47 *:set-default* *:set-&* *:set-&vi* *:set-&vim*
48:se[t] {option}& Reset option to its default value. May depend on the
49 current value of 'compatible'. {not in Vi}
50:se[t] {option}&vi Reset option to its Vi default value. {not in Vi}
51:se[t] {option}&vim Reset option to its Vim default value. {not in Vi}
52
Bram Moolenaar88774fd2015-08-25 19:52:04 +020053:se[t] all& Set all options to their default value. The values of
54 these options are not changed:
55 all terminal options, starting with t_
56 'columns'
57 'cryptmethod'
58 'encoding'
59 'key'
60 'lines'
61 'term'
62 'ttymouse'
63 'ttytype'
64 Warning: This may have a lot of side effects.
65 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000066
67 *:set-args* *E487* *E521*
68:se[t] {option}={value} or
69:se[t] {option}:{value}
70 Set string or number option to {value}.
71 For numeric options the value can be given in decimal,
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +010072 hex (preceded with 0x) or octal (preceded with '0').
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000073 The old value can be inserted by typing 'wildchar' (by
74 default this is a <Tab> or CTRL-E if 'compatible' is
75 set). See |cmdline-completion|.
76 White space between {option} and '=' is allowed and
77 will be ignored. White space between '=' and {value}
78 is not allowed.
79 See |option-backslash| for using white space and
80 backslashes in {value}.
81
82:se[t] {option}+={value} *:set+=*
83 Add the {value} to a number option, or append the
84 {value} to a string option. When the option is a
85 comma separated list, a comma is added, unless the
86 value was empty.
87 If the option is a list of flags, superfluous flags
Bram Moolenaara5792f52005-11-23 21:25:05 +000088 are removed. When adding a flag that was already
89 present the option value doesn't change.
Bram Moolenaar899dddf2006-03-26 21:06:50 +000090 Also see |:set-args| above.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000091 {not in Vi}
92
93:se[t] {option}^={value} *:set^=*
94 Multiply the {value} to a number option, or prepend
95 the {value} to a string option. When the option is a
96 comma separated list, a comma is added, unless the
97 value was empty.
98 Also see |:set-args| above.
99 {not in Vi}
100
101:se[t] {option}-={value} *:set-=*
102 Subtract the {value} from a number option, or remove
103 the {value} from a string option, if it is there.
104 If the {value} is not found in a string option, there
105 is no error or warning. When the option is a comma
106 separated list, a comma is deleted, unless the option
107 becomes empty.
108 When the option is a list of flags, {value} must be
109 exactly as they appear in the option. Remove flags
110 one by one to avoid problems.
111 Also see |:set-args| above.
112 {not in Vi}
113
114The {option} arguments to ":set" may be repeated. For example: >
115 :set ai nosi sw=3 ts=3
116If you make an error in one of the arguments, an error message will be given
117and the following arguments will be ignored.
118
119 *:set-verbose*
120When 'verbose' is non-zero, displaying an option value will also tell where it
121was last set. Example: >
122 :verbose set shiftwidth cindent?
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +0000123< shiftwidth=4 ~
124 Last set from modeline ~
125 cindent ~
126 Last set from /usr/local/share/vim/vim60/ftplugin/c.vim ~
127This is only done when specific option values are requested, not for ":verbose
128set all" or ":verbose set" without an argument.
129When the option was set by hand there is no "Last set" message.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000130When the option was set while executing a function, user command or
131autocommand, the script in which it was defined is reported.
132Note that an option may also have been set as a side effect of setting
133'compatible'.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +0000134A few special texts:
135 Last set from modeline ~
136 Option was set in a |modeline|.
137 Last set from --cmd argument ~
138 Option was set with command line argument |--cmd| or +.
139 Last set from -c argument ~
140 Option was set with command line argument |-c|, +, |-S| or
141 |-q|.
142 Last set from environment variable ~
143 Option was set from an environment variable, $VIMINIT,
144 $GVIMINIT or $EXINIT.
145 Last set from error handler ~
146 Option was cleared when evaluating it resulted in an error.
147
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +0200148{not available when compiled without the |+eval| feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000149
150 *:set-termcap* *E522*
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +0000151For {option} the form "t_xx" may be used to set a terminal option. This will
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000152override the value from the termcap. You can then use it in a mapping. If
153the "xx" part contains special characters, use the <t_xx> form: >
154 :set <t_#4>=^[Ot
155This can also be used to translate a special code for a normal key. For
156example, if Alt-b produces <Esc>b, use this: >
157 :set <M-b>=^[b
158(the ^[ is a real <Esc> here, use CTRL-V <Esc> to enter it)
159The advantage over a mapping is that it works in all situations.
160
Bram Moolenaar0b2f94d2011-03-22 14:35:05 +0100161You can define any key codes, e.g.: >
162 :set t_xy=^[foo;
163There is no warning for using a name that isn't recognized. You can map these
164codes as you like: >
165 :map <t_xy> something
166< *E846*
167When a key code is not set, it's like it does not exist. Trying to get its
168value will result in an error: >
169 :set t_kb=
170 :set t_kb
171 E846: Key code not set: t_kb
172
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +0000173The t_xx options cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
174security reasons.
175
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000176The listing from ":set" looks different from Vi. Long string options are put
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000177at the end of the list. The number of options is quite large. The output of
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000178"set all" probably does not fit on the screen, causing Vim to give the
179|more-prompt|.
180
181 *option-backslash*
182To include white space in a string option value it has to be preceded with a
183backslash. To include a backslash you have to use two. Effectively this
184means that the number of backslashes in an option value is halved (rounded
185down).
186A few examples: >
187 :set tags=tags\ /usr/tags results in "tags /usr/tags"
188 :set tags=tags\\,file results in "tags\,file"
189 :set tags=tags\\\ file results in "tags\ file"
190
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000191The "|" character separates a ":set" command from a following command. To
192include the "|" in the option value, use "\|" instead. This example sets the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000193'titlestring' option to "hi|there": >
194 :set titlestring=hi\|there
195This sets the 'titlestring' option to "hi" and 'iconstring' to "there": >
196 :set titlestring=hi|set iconstring=there
197
Bram Moolenaar7df351e2006-01-23 22:30:28 +0000198Similarly, the double quote character starts a comment. To include the '"' in
199the option value, use '\"' instead. This example sets the 'titlestring'
200option to 'hi "there"': >
201 :set titlestring=hi\ \"there\"
202
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000203For MS-DOS and WIN32 backslashes in file names are mostly not removed. More
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000204precise: For options that expect a file name (those where environment
205variables are expanded) a backslash before a normal file name character is not
206removed. But a backslash before a special character (space, backslash, comma,
207etc.) is used like explained above.
208There is one special situation, when the value starts with "\\": >
209 :set dir=\\machine\path results in "\\machine\path"
210 :set dir=\\\\machine\\path results in "\\machine\path"
211 :set dir=\\path\\file results in "\\path\file" (wrong!)
212For the first one the start is kept, but for the second one the backslashes
213are halved. This makes sure it works both when you expect backslashes to be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000214halved and when you expect the backslashes to be kept. The third gives a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000215result which is probably not what you want. Avoid it.
216
217 *add-option-flags* *remove-option-flags*
218 *E539* *E550* *E551* *E552*
219Some options are a list of flags. When you want to add a flag to such an
220option, without changing the existing ones, you can do it like this: >
221 :set guioptions+=a
222Remove a flag from an option like this: >
223 :set guioptions-=a
224This removes the 'a' flag from 'guioptions'.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000225Note that you should add or remove one flag at a time. If 'guioptions' has
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000226the value "ab", using "set guioptions-=ba" won't work, because the string "ba"
227doesn't appear.
228
229 *:set_env* *expand-env* *expand-environment-var*
Bram Moolenaard4755bb2004-09-02 19:12:26 +0000230Environment variables in specific string options will be expanded. If the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000231environment variable exists the '$' and the following environment variable
232name is replaced with its value. If it does not exist the '$' and the name
233are not modified. Any non-id character (not a letter, digit or '_') may
234follow the environment variable name. That character and what follows is
235appended to the value of the environment variable. Examples: >
236 :set term=$TERM.new
237 :set path=/usr/$INCLUDE,$HOME/include,.
238When adding or removing a string from an option with ":set opt-=val" or ":set
239opt+=val" the expansion is done before the adding or removing.
240
241
242Handling of local options *local-options*
243
244Some of the options only apply to a window or buffer. Each window or buffer
245has its own copy of this option, thus can each have their own value. This
246allows you to set 'list' in one window but not in another. And set
247'shiftwidth' to 3 in one buffer and 4 in another.
248
249The following explains what happens to these local options in specific
250situations. You don't really need to know all of this, since Vim mostly uses
251the option values you would expect. Unfortunately, doing what the user
252expects is a bit complicated...
253
254When splitting a window, the local options are copied to the new window. Thus
255right after the split the contents of the two windows look the same.
256
257When editing a new buffer, its local option values must be initialized. Since
258the local options of the current buffer might be specifically for that buffer,
259these are not used. Instead, for each buffer-local option there also is a
260global value, which is used for new buffers. With ":set" both the local and
261global value is changed. With "setlocal" only the local value is changed,
262thus this value is not used when editing a new buffer.
263
Bram Moolenaar95ec9d62016-08-12 18:29:59 +0200264When editing a buffer that has been edited before, the options from the window
265that was last closed are used again. If this buffer has been edited in this
266window, the values from back then are used. Otherwise the values from the
267last closed window where the buffer was edited last are used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000268
269It's possible to set a local window option specifically for a type of buffer.
270When you edit another buffer in the same window, you don't want to keep
271using these local window options. Therefore Vim keeps a global value of the
272local window options, which is used when editing another buffer. Each window
273has its own copy of these values. Thus these are local to the window, but
274global to all buffers in the window. With this you can do: >
275 :e one
276 :set list
277 :e two
278Now the 'list' option will also be set in "two", since with the ":set list"
279command you have also set the global value. >
280 :set nolist
281 :e one
282 :setlocal list
283 :e two
284Now the 'list' option is not set, because ":set nolist" resets the global
285value, ":setlocal list" only changes the local value and ":e two" gets the
286global value. Note that if you do this next: >
287 :e one
Bram Moolenaar531da592013-05-06 05:58:55 +0200288You will get back the 'list' value as it was the last time you edited "one".
289The options local to a window are remembered for each buffer. This also
290happens when the buffer is not loaded, but they are lost when the buffer is
291wiped out |:bwipe|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000292
293 *:setl* *:setlocal*
294:setl[ocal] ... Like ":set" but set only the value local to the
295 current buffer or window. Not all options have a
296 local value. If the option does not have a local
297 value the global value is set.
Bram Moolenaarc3301872010-07-25 20:53:06 +0200298 With the "all" argument: display local values for all
299 local options.
300 Without argument: Display local values for all local
301 options which are different from the default.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000302 When displaying a specific local option, show the
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +0000303 local value. For a global/local boolean option, when
304 the global value is being used, "--" is displayed
305 before the option name.
306 For a global option the global value is
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000307 shown (but that might change in the future).
308 {not in Vi}
309
Bram Moolenaar899dddf2006-03-26 21:06:50 +0000310:setl[ocal] {option}< Set the local value of {option} to its global value by
311 copying the value.
312 {not in Vi}
313
Bram Moolenaar6be7f872012-01-20 21:08:56 +0100314:se[t] {option}< For |global-local| options: Remove the local value of
315 {option}, so that the global value will be used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000316 {not in Vi}
317
318 *:setg* *:setglobal*
319:setg[lobal] ... Like ":set" but set only the global value for a local
320 option without changing the local value.
321 When displaying an option, the global value is shown.
Bram Moolenaarc3301872010-07-25 20:53:06 +0200322 With the "all" argument: display global values for all
323 local options.
324 Without argument: display global values for all local
325 options which are different from the default.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000326 {not in Vi}
327
328For buffer-local and window-local options:
329 Command global value local value ~
330 :set option=value set set
331 :setlocal option=value - set
332:setglobal option=value set -
333 :set option? - display
334 :setlocal option? - display
335:setglobal option? display -
336
337
338Global options with a local value *global-local*
339
Bram Moolenaarb5bf5b82004-12-24 14:35:23 +0000340Options are global when you mostly use one value for all buffers and windows.
341For some global options it's useful to sometimes have a different local value.
342You can set the local value with ":setlocal". That buffer or window will then
343use the local value, while other buffers and windows continue using the global
344value.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000345
346For example, you have two windows, both on C source code. They use the global
347'makeprg' option. If you do this in one of the two windows: >
348 :set makeprg=gmake
349then the other window will switch to the same value. There is no need to set
350the 'makeprg' option in the other C source window too.
351However, if you start editing a Perl file in a new window, you want to use
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +0000352another 'makeprg' for it, without changing the value used for the C source
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000353files. You use this command: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000354 :setlocal makeprg=perlmake
355You can switch back to using the global value by making the local value empty: >
356 :setlocal makeprg=
357This only works for a string option. For a boolean option you need to use the
358"<" flag, like this: >
359 :setlocal autoread<
360Note that for non-boolean options using "<" copies the global value to the
361local value, it doesn't switch back to using the global value (that matters
Bram Moolenaar899dddf2006-03-26 21:06:50 +0000362when the global value changes later). You can also use: >
363 :set path<
364This will make the local value of 'path' empty, so that the global value is
365used. Thus it does the same as: >
366 :setlocal path=
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000367Note: In the future more global options can be made global-local. Using
368":setlocal" on a global option might work differently then.
369
370
371Setting the filetype
372
373:setf[iletype] {filetype} *:setf* *:setfiletype*
374 Set the 'filetype' option to {filetype}, but only if
375 not done yet in a sequence of (nested) autocommands.
376 This is short for: >
377 :if !did_filetype()
378 : setlocal filetype={filetype}
379 :endif
380< This command is used in a filetype.vim file to avoid
381 setting the 'filetype' option twice, causing different
382 settings and syntax files to be loaded.
383 {not in Vi}
384
Bram Moolenaard58e9292011-02-09 17:07:58 +0100385 *option-window* *optwin*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000386:bro[wse] se[t] *:set-browse* *:browse-set* *:opt* *:options*
387:opt[ions] Open a window for viewing and setting all options.
388 Options are grouped by function.
389 Offers short help for each option. Hit <CR> on the
390 short help to open a help window with more help for
391 the option.
392 Modify the value of the option and hit <CR> on the
393 "set" line to set the new value. For window and
394 buffer specific options, the last accessed window is
395 used to set the option value in, unless this is a help
396 window, in which case the window below help window is
397 used (skipping the option-window).
398 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| or
399 |+autocmd| features}
400
401 *$HOME*
402Using "~" is like using "$HOME", but it is only recognized at the start of an
403option and after a space or comma.
404
405On Unix systems "~user" can be used too. It is replaced by the home directory
406of user "user". Example: >
407 :set path=~mool/include,/usr/include,.
408
409On Unix systems the form "${HOME}" can be used too. The name between {} can
410contain non-id characters then. Note that if you want to use this for the
411"gf" command, you need to add the '{' and '}' characters to 'isfname'.
412
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +0100413On MS-Windows, if $HOME is not defined as an environment variable, then
414at runtime Vim will set it to the expansion of $HOMEDRIVE$HOMEPATH.
415
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000416NOTE: expanding environment variables and "~/" is only done with the ":set"
417command, not when assigning a value to an option with ":let".
418
419
420Note the maximum length of an expanded option is limited. How much depends on
421the system, mostly it is something like 256 or 1024 characters.
422
423 *:fix* *:fixdel*
424:fix[del] Set the value of 't_kD':
425 't_kb' is 't_kD' becomes ~
426 CTRL-? CTRL-H
427 not CTRL-? CTRL-?
428
429 (CTRL-? is 0177 octal, 0x7f hex) {not in Vi}
430
431 If your delete key terminal code is wrong, but the
432 code for backspace is alright, you can put this in
433 your .vimrc: >
434 :fixdel
435< This works no matter what the actual code for
436 backspace is.
437
438 If the backspace key terminal code is wrong you can
439 use this: >
440 :if &term == "termname"
441 : set t_kb=^V<BS>
442 : fixdel
443 :endif
444< Where "^V" is CTRL-V and "<BS>" is the backspace key
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000445 (don't type four characters!). Replace "termname"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000446 with your terminal name.
447
448 If your <Delete> key sends a strange key sequence (not
449 CTRL-? or CTRL-H) you cannot use ":fixdel". Then use: >
450 :if &term == "termname"
451 : set t_kD=^V<Delete>
452 :endif
453< Where "^V" is CTRL-V and "<Delete>" is the delete key
454 (don't type eight characters!). Replace "termname"
455 with your terminal name.
456
457 *Linux-backspace*
458 Note about Linux: By default the backspace key
459 produces CTRL-?, which is wrong. You can fix it by
460 putting this line in your rc.local: >
461 echo "keycode 14 = BackSpace" | loadkeys
462<
463 *NetBSD-backspace*
464 Note about NetBSD: If your backspace doesn't produce
465 the right code, try this: >
466 xmodmap -e "keycode 22 = BackSpace"
467< If this works, add this in your .Xmodmap file: >
468 keysym 22 = BackSpace
469< You need to restart for this to take effect.
470
471==============================================================================
4722. Automatically setting options *auto-setting*
473
474Besides changing options with the ":set" command, there are three alternatives
475to set options automatically for one or more files:
476
4771. When starting Vim initializations are read from various places. See
478 |initialization|. Most of them are performed for all editing sessions,
479 and some of them depend on the directory where Vim is started.
480 You can create an initialization file with |:mkvimrc|, |:mkview| and
481 |:mksession|.
4822. If you start editing a new file, the automatic commands are executed.
483 This can be used to set options for files matching a particular pattern and
484 many other things. See |autocommand|.
4853. If you start editing a new file, and the 'modeline' option is on, a
486 number of lines at the beginning and end of the file are checked for
487 modelines. This is explained here.
488
489 *modeline* *vim:* *vi:* *ex:* *E520*
490There are two forms of modelines. The first form:
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200491 [text]{white}{vi:|vim:|ex:}[white]{options}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000492
Bram Moolenaar22dbc772013-06-28 18:44:48 +0200493[text] any text or empty
494{white} at least one blank character (<Space> or <Tab>)
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200495{vi:|vim:|ex:} the string "vi:", "vim:" or "ex:"
Bram Moolenaar22dbc772013-06-28 18:44:48 +0200496[white] optional white space
497{options} a list of option settings, separated with white space
498 or ':', where each part between ':' is the argument
499 for a ":set" command (can be empty)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000500
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200501Examples:
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +0000502 vi:noai:sw=3 ts=6 ~
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200503 vim: tw=77 ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000504
505The second form (this is compatible with some versions of Vi):
506
Bram Moolenaar22dbc772013-06-28 18:44:48 +0200507 [text]{white}{vi:|vim:|Vim:|ex:}[white]se[t] {options}:[text]
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000508
Bram Moolenaar22dbc772013-06-28 18:44:48 +0200509[text] any text or empty
510{white} at least one blank character (<Space> or <Tab>)
511{vi:|vim:|Vim:|ex:} the string "vi:", "vim:", "Vim:" or "ex:"
512[white] optional white space
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200513se[t] the string "set " or "se " (note the space); When
514 "Vim" is used it must be "set".
Bram Moolenaar22dbc772013-06-28 18:44:48 +0200515{options} a list of options, separated with white space, which
516 is the argument for a ":set" command
517: a colon
518[text] any text or empty
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000519
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200520Examples:
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +0000521 /* vim: set ai tw=75: */ ~
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200522 /* Vim: set ai tw=75: */ ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000523
Bram Moolenaar22dbc772013-06-28 18:44:48 +0200524The white space before {vi:|vim:|Vim:|ex:} is required. This minimizes the
525chance that a normal word like "lex:" is caught. There is one exception:
526"vi:" and "vim:" can also be at the start of the line (for compatibility with
527version 3.0). Using "ex:" at the start of the line will be ignored (this
528could be short for "example:").
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000529
530 *modeline-local*
531The options are set like with ":setlocal": The new value only applies to the
Bram Moolenaar843ee412004-06-30 16:16:41 +0000532buffer and window that contain the file. Although it's possible to set global
533options from a modeline, this is unusual. If you have two windows open and
534the files in it set the same global option to a different value, the result
535depends on which one was opened last.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000536
Bram Moolenaar15d0a8c2004-09-06 17:44:46 +0000537When editing a file that was already loaded, only the window-local options
538from the modeline are used. Thus if you manually changed a buffer-local
539option after opening the file, it won't be changed if you edit the same buffer
540in another window. But window-local options will be set.
541
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000542 *modeline-version*
543If the modeline is only to be used for some versions of Vim, the version
Bram Moolenaar22dbc772013-06-28 18:44:48 +0200544number can be specified where "vim:" or "Vim:" is used:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000545 vim{vers}: version {vers} or later
546 vim<{vers}: version before {vers}
547 vim={vers}: version {vers}
548 vim>{vers}: version after {vers}
Bram Moolenaar2b8388b2015-02-28 13:11:45 +0100549{vers} is 700 for Vim 7.0 (hundred times the major version plus minor).
550For example, to use a modeline only for Vim 7.0:
551 /* vim700: set foldmethod=marker */ ~
552To use a modeline for Vim after version 7.2:
553 /* vim>702: set cole=2: */ ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000554There can be no blanks between "vim" and the ":".
555
556
557The number of lines that are checked can be set with the 'modelines' option.
558If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is 0 no lines are checked.
559
560Note that for the first form all of the rest of the line is used, thus a line
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +0000561like:
562 /* vi:ts=4: */ ~
563will give an error message for the trailing "*/". This line is OK:
564 /* vi:set ts=4: */ ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000565
566If an error is detected the rest of the line is skipped.
567
568If you want to include a ':' in a set command precede it with a '\'. The
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +0000569backslash in front of the ':' will be removed. Example:
570 /* vi:set dir=c\:\tmp: */ ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000571This sets the 'dir' option to "c:\tmp". Only a single backslash before the
572':' is removed. Thus to include "\:" you have to specify "\\:".
573
574No other commands than "set" are supported, for security reasons (somebody
Bram Moolenaar8243a792007-05-01 17:05:03 +0000575might create a Trojan horse text file with modelines). And not all options
576can be set. For some options a flag is set, so that when it's used the
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +0000577|sandbox| is effective. Still, there is always a small risk that a modeline
Bram Moolenaar8243a792007-05-01 17:05:03 +0000578causes trouble. E.g., when some joker sets 'textwidth' to 5 all your lines
579are wrapped unexpectedly. So disable modelines before editing untrusted text.
580The mail ftplugin does this, for example.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000581
582Hint: If you would like to do something else than setting an option, you could
583define an autocommand that checks the file for a specific string. For
584example: >
585 au BufReadPost * if getline(1) =~ "VAR" | call SetVar() | endif
586And define a function SetVar() that does something with the line containing
587"VAR".
588
589==============================================================================
5903. Options summary *option-summary*
591
592In the list below all the options are mentioned with their full name and with
593an abbreviation if there is one. Both forms may be used.
594
595In this document when a boolean option is "set" that means that ":set option"
596is entered. When an option is "reset", ":set nooption" is used.
597
598For some options there are two default values: The "Vim default", which is
599used when 'compatible' is not set, and the "Vi default", which is used when
600'compatible' is set.
601
602Most options are the same in all windows and buffers. There are a few that
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000603are specific to how the text is presented in a window. These can be set to a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000604different value in each window. For example the 'list' option can be set in
605one window and reset in another for the same text, giving both types of view
606at the same time. There are a few options that are specific to a certain
607file. These can have a different value for each file or buffer. For example
608the 'textwidth' option can be 78 for a normal text file and 0 for a C
609program.
610
611 global one option for all buffers and windows
612 local to window each window has its own copy of this option
613 local to buffer each buffer has its own copy of this option
614
615When creating a new window the option values from the currently active window
616are used as a default value for the window-specific options. For the
617buffer-specific options this depends on the 's' and 'S' flags in the
618'cpoptions' option. If 's' is included (which is the default) the values for
619buffer options are copied from the currently active buffer when a buffer is
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000620first entered. If 'S' is present the options are copied each time the buffer
621is entered, this is almost like having global options. If 's' and 'S' are not
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000622present, the options are copied from the currently active buffer when the
623buffer is created.
624
Bram Moolenaar578b49e2005-09-10 19:22:57 +0000625Hidden options *hidden-options*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000626
Bram Moolenaar578b49e2005-09-10 19:22:57 +0000627Not all options are supported in all versions. This depends on the supported
628features and sometimes on the system. A remark about this is in curly braces
629below. When an option is not supported it may still be set without getting an
630error, this is called a hidden option. You can't get the value of a hidden
631option though, it is not stored.
632
633To test if option "foo" can be used with ":set" use something like this: >
634 if exists('&foo')
635This also returns true for a hidden option. To test if option "foo" is really
636supported use something like this: >
637 if exists('+foo')
638<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000639 *E355*
640A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
641
642 *'aleph'* *'al'* *aleph* *Aleph*
643'aleph' 'al' number (default 128 for MS-DOS, 224 otherwise)
644 global
645 {not in Vi}
646 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
647 feature}
648 The ASCII code for the first letter of the Hebrew alphabet. The
649 routine that maps the keyboard in Hebrew mode, both in Insert mode
650 (when hkmap is set) and on the command-line (when hitting CTRL-_)
651 outputs the Hebrew characters in the range [aleph..aleph+26].
652 aleph=128 applies to PC code, and aleph=224 applies to ISO 8859-8.
653 See |rileft.txt|.
654
655 *'allowrevins'* *'ari'* *'noallowrevins'* *'noari'*
656'allowrevins' 'ari' boolean (default off)
657 global
658 {not in Vi}
659 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
660 feature}
661 Allow CTRL-_ in Insert and Command-line mode. This is default off, to
662 avoid that users that accidentally type CTRL-_ instead of SHIFT-_ get
663 into reverse Insert mode, and don't know how to get out. See
664 'revins'.
665 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
666
667 *'altkeymap'* *'akm'* *'noaltkeymap'* *'noakm'*
668'altkeymap' 'akm' boolean (default off)
669 global
670 {not in Vi}
671 {only available when compiled with the |+farsi|
672 feature}
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +0000673 When on, the second language is Farsi. In editing mode CTRL-_ toggles
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000674 the keyboard map between Farsi and English, when 'allowrevins' set.
675
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +0000676 When off, the keyboard map toggles between Hebrew and English. This
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000677 is useful to start the Vim in native mode i.e. English (left-to-right
678 mode) and have default second language Farsi or Hebrew (right-to-left
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000679 mode). See |farsi.txt|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000680
681 *'ambiwidth'* *'ambw'*
682'ambiwidth' 'ambw' string (default: "single")
683 global
684 {not in Vi}
685 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
686 feature}
687 Only effective when 'encoding' is "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding.
688 Tells Vim what to do with characters with East Asian Width Class
689 Ambiguous (such as Euro, Registered Sign, Copyright Sign, Greek
690 letters, Cyrillic letters).
691
692 There are currently two possible values:
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +0000693 "single": Use the same width as characters in US-ASCII. This is
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000694 expected by most users.
695 "double": Use twice the width of ASCII characters.
Bram Moolenaar5c3bd0a2010-08-04 20:55:44 +0200696 *E834* *E835*
697 The value "double" cannot be used if 'listchars' or 'fillchars'
698 contains a character that would be double width.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000699
700 There are a number of CJK fonts for which the width of glyphs for
701 those characters are solely based on how many octets they take in
702 legacy/traditional CJK encodings. In those encodings, Euro,
703 Registered sign, Greek/Cyrillic letters are represented by two octets,
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +0000704 therefore those fonts have "wide" glyphs for them. This is also
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000705 true of some line drawing characters used to make tables in text
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +0000706 file. Therefore, when a CJK font is used for GUI Vim or
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000707 Vim is running inside a terminal (emulators) that uses a CJK font
708 (or Vim is run inside an xterm invoked with "-cjkwidth" option.),
709 this option should be set to "double" to match the width perceived
710 by Vim with the width of glyphs in the font. Perhaps it also has
711 to be set to "double" under CJK Windows 9x/ME or Windows 2k/XP
712 when the system locale is set to one of CJK locales. See Unicode
713 Standard Annex #11 (http://www.unicode.org/reports/tr11).
714
Bram Moolenaarac7bd632013-03-19 11:35:58 +0100715 Vim may set this option automatically at startup time when Vim is
716 compiled with the |+termresponse| feature and if |t_u7| is set to the
Bram Moolenaarbf884932013-04-05 22:26:15 +0200717 escape sequence to request cursor position report.
Bram Moolenaarac7bd632013-03-19 11:35:58 +0100718
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000719 *'antialias'* *'anti'* *'noantialias'* *'noanti'*
720'antialias' 'anti' boolean (default: off)
721 global
722 {not in Vi}
723 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled
724 on Mac OS X}
725 This option only has an effect in the GUI version of Vim on Mac OS X
726 v10.2 or later. When on, Vim will use smooth ("antialiased") fonts,
727 which can be easier to read at certain sizes on certain displays.
728 Setting this option can sometimes cause problems if 'guifont' is set
729 to its default (empty string).
730
731 *'autochdir'* *'acd'* *'noautochdir'* *'noacd'*
732'autochdir' 'acd' boolean (default off)
733 global
734 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar00a927d2010-05-14 23:24:24 +0200735 {only available when compiled with it, use
736 exists("+autochdir") to check}
Bram Moolenaard8c00872005-07-22 21:52:15 +0000737 When on, Vim will change the current working directory whenever you
738 open a file, switch buffers, delete a buffer or open/close a window.
739 It will change to the directory containing the file which was opened
740 or selected.
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +0000741 Note: When this option is on some plugins may not work.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000742
743 *'arabic'* *'arab'* *'noarabic'* *'noarab'*
744'arabic' 'arab' boolean (default off)
745 local to window
746 {not in Vi}
747 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
748 feature}
749 This option can be set to start editing Arabic text.
750 Setting this option will:
751 - Set the 'rightleft' option, unless 'termbidi' is set.
752 - Set the 'arabicshape' option, unless 'termbidi' is set.
753 - Set the 'keymap' option to "arabic"; in Insert mode CTRL-^ toggles
754 between typing English and Arabic key mapping.
755 - Set the 'delcombine' option
756 Note that 'encoding' must be "utf-8" for working with Arabic text.
757
758 Resetting this option will:
759 - Reset the 'rightleft' option.
760 - Disable the use of 'keymap' (without changing its value).
761 Note that 'arabicshape' and 'delcombine' are not reset (it is a global
Bram Moolenaarc8734422012-06-01 22:38:45 +0200762 option).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000763 Also see |arabic.txt|.
764
765 *'arabicshape'* *'arshape'*
766 *'noarabicshape'* *'noarshape'*
767'arabicshape' 'arshape' boolean (default on)
768 global
769 {not in Vi}
770 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
771 feature}
772 When on and 'termbidi' is off, the required visual character
773 corrections that need to take place for displaying the Arabic language
Bram Moolenaar3a0d8092012-10-21 03:02:54 +0200774 take effect. Shaping, in essence, gets enabled; the term is a broad
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000775 one which encompasses:
776 a) the changing/morphing of characters based on their location
777 within a word (initial, medial, final and stand-alone).
778 b) the enabling of the ability to compose characters
779 c) the enabling of the required combining of some characters
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +0100780 When disabled the display shows each character's true stand-alone
781 form.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000782 Arabic is a complex language which requires other settings, for
783 further details see |arabic.txt|.
784
785 *'autoindent'* *'ai'* *'noautoindent'* *'noai'*
786'autoindent' 'ai' boolean (default off)
787 local to buffer
788 Copy indent from current line when starting a new line (typing <CR>
789 in Insert mode or when using the "o" or "O" command). If you do not
790 type anything on the new line except <BS> or CTRL-D and then type
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +0000791 <Esc>, CTRL-O or <CR>, the indent is deleted again. Moving the cursor
792 to another line has the same effect, unless the 'I' flag is included
793 in 'cpoptions'.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000794 When autoindent is on, formatting (with the "gq" command or when you
795 reach 'textwidth' in Insert mode) uses the indentation of the first
796 line.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000797 When 'smartindent' or 'cindent' is on the indent is changed in
798 a different way.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +0200799 The 'autoindent' option is reset when the 'paste' option is set and
800 restored when 'paste' is reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000801 {small difference from Vi: After the indent is deleted when typing
802 <Esc> or <CR>, the cursor position when moving up or down is after the
803 deleted indent; Vi puts the cursor somewhere in the deleted indent}.
804
805 *'autoread'* *'ar'* *'noautoread'* *'noar'*
806'autoread' 'ar' boolean (default off)
807 global or local to buffer |global-local|
808 {not in Vi}
809 When a file has been detected to have been changed outside of Vim and
810 it has not been changed inside of Vim, automatically read it again.
811 When the file has been deleted this is not done. |timestamp|
812 If this option has a local value, use this command to switch back to
813 using the global value: >
814 :set autoread<
815<
816 *'autowrite'* *'aw'* *'noautowrite'* *'noaw'*
817'autowrite' 'aw' boolean (default off)
818 global
819 Write the contents of the file, if it has been modified, on each
820 :next, :rewind, :last, :first, :previous, :stop, :suspend, :tag, :!,
Bram Moolenaar14716812006-05-04 21:54:08 +0000821 :make, CTRL-] and CTRL-^ command; and when a :buffer, CTRL-O, CTRL-I,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000822 '{A-Z0-9}, or `{A-Z0-9} command takes one to another file.
823 Note that for some commands the 'autowrite' option is not used, see
824 'autowriteall' for that.
825
826 *'autowriteall'* *'awa'* *'noautowriteall'* *'noawa'*
827'autowriteall' 'awa' boolean (default off)
828 global
829 {not in Vi}
830 Like 'autowrite', but also used for commands ":edit", ":enew", ":quit",
831 ":qall", ":exit", ":xit", ":recover" and closing the Vim window.
832 Setting this option also implies that Vim behaves like 'autowrite' has
833 been set.
834
835 *'background'* *'bg'*
Bram Moolenaar446beb42011-05-10 17:18:44 +0200836'background' 'bg' string (default "dark" or "light", see below)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000837 global
838 {not in Vi}
839 When set to "dark", Vim will try to use colors that look good on a
840 dark background. When set to "light", Vim will try to use colors that
841 look good on a light background. Any other value is illegal.
842 Vim tries to set the default value according to the terminal used.
843 This will not always be correct.
844 Setting this option does not change the background color, it tells Vim
845 what the background color looks like. For changing the background
846 color, see |:hi-normal|.
847
848 When 'background' is set Vim will adjust the default color groups for
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000849 the new value. But the colors used for syntax highlighting will not
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +0000850 change. *g:colors_name*
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +0100851 When a color scheme is loaded (the "g:colors_name" variable is set)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000852 setting 'background' will cause the color scheme to be reloaded. If
853 the color scheme adjusts to the value of 'background' this will work.
854 However, if the color scheme sets 'background' itself the effect may
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +0100855 be undone. First delete the "g:colors_name" variable when needed.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000856
857 When setting 'background' to the default value with: >
858 :set background&
859< Vim will guess the value. In the GUI this should work correctly,
860 in other cases Vim might not be able to guess the right value.
861
862 When starting the GUI, the default value for 'background' will be
863 "light". When the value is not set in the .gvimrc, and Vim detects
864 that the background is actually quite dark, 'background' is set to
865 "dark". But this happens only AFTER the .gvimrc file has been read
866 (because the window needs to be opened to find the actual background
867 color). To get around this, force the GUI window to be opened by
868 putting a ":gui" command in the .gvimrc file, before where the value
869 of 'background' is used (e.g., before ":syntax on").
Bram Moolenaar446beb42011-05-10 17:18:44 +0200870
871 For MS-DOS, Windows and OS/2 the default is "dark".
872 For other systems "dark" is used when 'term' is "linux",
873 "screen.linux", "cygwin" or "putty", or $COLORFGBG suggests a dark
874 background. Otherwise the default is "light".
875
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000876 Normally this option would be set in the .vimrc file. Possibly
877 depending on the terminal name. Example: >
878 :if &term == "pcterm"
879 : set background=dark
880 :endif
881< When this option is set, the default settings for the highlight groups
882 will change. To use other settings, place ":highlight" commands AFTER
883 the setting of the 'background' option.
884 This option is also used in the "$VIMRUNTIME/syntax/syntax.vim" file
885 to select the colors for syntax highlighting. After changing this
886 option, you must load syntax.vim again to see the result. This can be
887 done with ":syntax on".
888
889 *'backspace'* *'bs'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +0200890'backspace' 'bs' string (default "", set to "indent,eol,start"
891 in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000892 global
893 {not in Vi}
894 Influences the working of <BS>, <Del>, CTRL-W and CTRL-U in Insert
895 mode. This is a list of items, separated by commas. Each item allows
896 a way to backspace over something:
897 value effect ~
898 indent allow backspacing over autoindent
899 eol allow backspacing over line breaks (join lines)
900 start allow backspacing over the start of insert; CTRL-W and CTRL-U
901 stop once at the start of insert.
902
903 When the value is empty, Vi compatible backspacing is used.
904
905 For backwards compatibility with version 5.4 and earlier:
906 value effect ~
907 0 same as ":set backspace=" (Vi compatible)
908 1 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol"
909 2 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol,start"
910
911 See |:fixdel| if your <BS> or <Del> key does not do what you want.
912 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set.
913
914 *'backup'* *'bk'* *'nobackup'* *'nobk'*
915'backup' 'bk' boolean (default off)
916 global
917 {not in Vi}
918 Make a backup before overwriting a file. Leave it around after the
919 file has been successfully written. If you do not want to keep the
920 backup file, but you do want a backup while the file is being
921 written, reset this option and set the 'writebackup' option (this is
922 the default). If you do not want a backup file at all reset both
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000923 options (use this if your file system is almost full). See the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000924 |backup-table| for more explanations.
925 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway.
926 When 'patchmode' is set, the backup may be renamed to become the
927 oldest version of a file.
928 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
929
930 *'backupcopy'* *'bkc'*
931'backupcopy' 'bkc' string (Vi default for Unix: "yes", otherwise: "auto")
Bram Moolenaarb8ee25a2014-09-23 15:45:08 +0200932 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000933 {not in Vi}
934 When writing a file and a backup is made, this option tells how it's
935 done. This is a comma separated list of words.
936
937 The main values are:
938 "yes" make a copy of the file and overwrite the original one
939 "no" rename the file and write a new one
940 "auto" one of the previous, what works best
941
942 Extra values that can be combined with the ones above are:
943 "breaksymlink" always break symlinks when writing
944 "breakhardlink" always break hardlinks when writing
945
946 Making a copy and overwriting the original file:
947 - Takes extra time to copy the file.
948 + When the file has special attributes, is a (hard/symbolic) link or
949 has a resource fork, all this is preserved.
950 - When the file is a link the backup will have the name of the link,
951 not of the real file.
952
953 Renaming the file and writing a new one:
954 + It's fast.
955 - Sometimes not all attributes of the file can be copied to the new
956 file.
957 - When the file is a link the new file will not be a link.
958
959 The "auto" value is the middle way: When Vim sees that renaming file
960 is possible without side effects (the attributes can be passed on and
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +0000961 the file is not a link) that is used. When problems are expected, a
962 copy will be made.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000963
964 The "breaksymlink" and "breakhardlink" values can be used in
965 combination with any of "yes", "no" and "auto". When included, they
966 force Vim to always break either symbolic or hard links by doing
967 exactly what the "no" option does, renaming the original file to
968 become the backup and writing a new file in its place. This can be
969 useful for example in source trees where all the files are symbolic or
970 hard links and any changes should stay in the local source tree, not
971 be propagated back to the original source.
972 *crontab*
973 One situation where "no" and "auto" will cause problems: A program
974 that opens a file, invokes Vim to edit that file, and then tests if
975 the open file was changed (through the file descriptor) will check the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000976 backup file instead of the newly created file. "crontab -e" is an
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000977 example.
978
979 When a copy is made, the original file is truncated and then filled
980 with the new text. This means that protection bits, owner and
981 symbolic links of the original file are unmodified. The backup file
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000982 however, is a new file, owned by the user who edited the file. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000983 group of the backup is set to the group of the original file. If this
984 fails, the protection bits for the group are made the same as for
985 others.
986
987 When the file is renamed this is the other way around: The backup has
988 the same attributes of the original file, and the newly written file
989 is owned by the current user. When the file was a (hard/symbolic)
990 link, the new file will not! That's why the "auto" value doesn't
991 rename when the file is a link. The owner and group of the newly
992 written file will be set to the same ones as the original file, but
993 the system may refuse to do this. In that case the "auto" value will
994 again not rename the file.
995
996 *'backupdir'* *'bdir'*
997'backupdir' 'bdir' string (default for Amiga: ".,t:",
Bram Moolenaardfb18412013-12-11 18:53:29 +0100998 for MS-DOS and Win32: ".,$TEMP,c:/tmp,c:/temp"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000999 for Unix: ".,~/tmp,~/")
1000 global
1001 {not in Vi}
1002 List of directories for the backup file, separated with commas.
1003 - The backup file will be created in the first directory in the list
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01001004 where this is possible. The directory must exist, Vim will not
1005 create it for you.
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01001006 - Empty means that no backup file will be created ('patchmode' is
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001007 impossible!). Writing may fail because of this.
1008 - A directory "." means to put the backup file in the same directory
1009 as the edited file.
Bram Moolenaar009b2592004-10-24 19:18:58 +00001010 - A directory starting with "./" (or ".\" for MS-DOS et al.) means to
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001011 put the backup file relative to where the edited file is. The
1012 leading "." is replaced with the path name of the edited file.
1013 ("." inside a directory name has no special meaning).
1014 - Spaces after the comma are ignored, other spaces are considered part
1015 of the directory name. To have a space at the start of a directory
1016 name, precede it with a backslash.
1017 - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with a backslash.
1018 - A directory name may end in an '/'.
1019 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
1020 - Careful with '\' characters, type one before a space, type two to
1021 get one in the option (see |option-backslash|), for example: >
1022 :set bdir=c:\\tmp,\ dir\\,with\\,commas,\\\ dir\ with\ spaces
1023< - For backwards compatibility with Vim version 3.0 a '>' at the start
1024 of the option is removed.
1025 See also 'backup' and 'writebackup' options.
1026 If you want to hide your backup files on Unix, consider this value: >
1027 :set backupdir=./.backup,~/.backup,.,/tmp
1028< You must create a ".backup" directory in each directory and in your
1029 home directory for this to work properly.
1030 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
1031 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
1032 uses another default.
1033 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
1034 security reasons.
1035
1036 *'backupext'* *'bex'* *E589*
1037'backupext' 'bex' string (default "~", for VMS: "_")
1038 global
1039 {not in Vi}
1040 String which is appended to a file name to make the name of the
1041 backup file. The default is quite unusual, because this avoids
1042 accidentally overwriting existing files with a backup file. You might
1043 prefer using ".bak", but make sure that you don't have files with
1044 ".bak" that you want to keep.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00001045 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001046
Bram Moolenaar3fdfa4a2004-10-07 21:02:47 +00001047 If you like to keep a lot of backups, you could use a BufWritePre
1048 autocommand to change 'backupext' just before writing the file to
1049 include a timestamp. >
1050 :au BufWritePre * let &bex = '-' . strftime("%Y%b%d%X") . '~'
1051< Use 'backupdir' to put the backup in a different directory.
1052
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001053 *'backupskip'* *'bsk'*
1054'backupskip' 'bsk' string (default: "/tmp/*,$TMPDIR/*,$TMP/*,$TEMP/*")
1055 global
1056 {not in Vi}
1057 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
1058 feature}
1059 A list of file patterns. When one of the patterns matches with the
1060 name of the file which is written, no backup file is created. Both
1061 the specified file name and the full path name of the file are used.
1062 The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|.
1063 Watch out for special characters, see |option-backslash|.
1064 When $TMPDIR, $TMP or $TEMP is not defined, it is not used for the
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00001065 default value. "/tmp/*" is only used for Unix.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001066
Bram Moolenaar1aeaf8c2012-05-18 13:46:39 +02001067 WARNING: Not having a backup file means that when Vim fails to write
1068 your buffer correctly and then, for whatever reason, Vim exits, you
1069 lose both the original file and what you were writing. Only disable
1070 backups if you don't care about losing the file.
1071
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001072 Note that environment variables are not expanded. If you want to use
1073 $HOME you must expand it explicitly, e.g.: >
Bram Moolenaar7c1c6db2016-04-03 22:08:05 +02001074 :let &backupskip = escape(expand('$HOME'), '\') . '/tmp/*'
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001075
1076< Note that the default also makes sure that "crontab -e" works (when a
Bram Moolenaara5792f52005-11-23 21:25:05 +00001077 backup would be made by renaming the original file crontab won't see
1078 the newly created file). Also see 'backupcopy' and |crontab|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001079
1080 *'balloondelay'* *'bdlay'*
1081'balloondelay' 'bdlay' number (default: 600)
1082 global
1083 {not in Vi}
1084 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
1085 feature}
1086 Delay in milliseconds before a balloon may pop up. See |balloon-eval|.
1087
1088 *'ballooneval'* *'beval'* *'noballooneval'* *'nobeval'*
1089'ballooneval' 'beval' boolean (default off)
1090 global
1091 {not in Vi}
1092 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001093 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001094 Switch on the |balloon-eval| functionality.
1095
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001096 *'balloonexpr'* *'bexpr'*
1097'balloonexpr' 'bexpr' string (default "")
Bram Moolenaar9b2200a2006-03-20 21:55:45 +00001098 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001099 {not in Vi}
1100 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
1101 feature}
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00001102 Expression for text to show in evaluation balloon. It is only used
1103 when 'ballooneval' is on. These variables can be used:
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001104
1105 v:beval_bufnr number of the buffer in which balloon is going to show
1106 v:beval_winnr number of the window
Bram Moolenaar82af8712016-06-04 20:20:29 +02001107 v:beval_winid ID of the window
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001108 v:beval_lnum line number
1109 v:beval_col column number (byte index)
1110 v:beval_text word under or after the mouse pointer
1111
1112 The evaluation of the expression must not have side effects!
1113 Example: >
1114 function! MyBalloonExpr()
Bram Moolenaar45360022005-07-21 21:08:21 +00001115 return 'Cursor is at line ' . v:beval_lnum .
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001116 \', column ' . v:beval_col .
1117 \ ' of file ' . bufname(v:beval_bufnr) .
1118 \ ' on word "' . v:beval_text . '"'
1119 endfunction
1120 set bexpr=MyBalloonExpr()
1121 set ballooneval
1122<
1123 NOTE: The balloon is displayed only if the cursor is on a text
1124 character. If the result of evaluating 'balloonexpr' is not empty,
1125 Vim does not try to send a message to an external debugger (Netbeans
1126 or Sun Workshop).
1127
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02001128 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
1129 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00001130
1131 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
1132 evaluating 'balloonexpr' |textlock|.
1133
Bram Moolenaar87e25fd2005-07-27 21:13:01 +00001134 To check whether line breaks in the balloon text work use this check: >
Bram Moolenaar45360022005-07-21 21:08:21 +00001135 if has("balloon_multiline")
Bram Moolenaar362e1a32006-03-06 23:29:24 +00001136< When they are supported "\n" characters will start a new line. If the
1137 expression evaluates to a |List| this is equal to using each List item
1138 as a string and putting "\n" in between them.
1139
Bram Moolenaar165bc692015-07-21 17:53:25 +02001140 *'belloff'* *'bo'*
1141'belloff' 'bo' string (default "")
1142 global
1143 {not in Vi}
1144 Specifies for which events the bell will not be rung. It is a comma
1145 separated list of items. For each item that is present, the bell
1146 will be silenced. This is most useful to specify specific events in
1147 insert mode to be silenced.
1148
1149 item meaning when present ~
1150 all All events.
1151 backspace When hitting <BS> or <Del> and deleting results in an
1152 error.
1153 cursor Fail to move around using the cursor keys or
1154 <PageUp>/<PageDown> in |Insert-mode|.
1155 complete Error occurred when using |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K| or
1156 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-T|.
1157 copy Cannot copy char from insert mode using |i_CTRL-Y| or
1158 |i_CTRL-E|.
1159 ctrlg Unknown Char after <C-G> in Insert mode.
1160 error Other Error occurred (e.g. try to join last line)
1161 (mostly used in |Normal-mode| or |Cmdline-mode|).
1162 esc hitting <Esc> in |Normal-mode|.
1163 ex In |Visual-mode|, hitting |Q| results in an error.
1164 hangul Error occurred when using hangul input.
1165 insertmode Pressing <Esc> in 'insertmode'.
1166 lang Calling the beep module for Lua/Mzscheme/TCL.
1167 mess No output available for |g<|.
1168 showmatch Error occurred for 'showmatch' function.
1169 operator Empty region error |cpo-E|.
1170 register Unknown register after <C-R> in |Insert-mode|.
1171 shell Bell from shell output |:!|.
1172 spell Error happened on spell suggest.
1173 wildmode More matches in |cmdline-completion| available
1174 (depends on the 'wildmode' setting).
1175
1176 This is most useful, to fine tune when in insert mode the bell should
1177 be rung. For normal mode and ex commands, the bell is often rung to
1178 indicate that an error occurred. It can be silenced by adding the
1179 "error" keyword.
1180
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001181 *'binary'* *'bin'* *'nobinary'* *'nobin'*
1182'binary' 'bin' boolean (default off)
1183 local to buffer
1184 {not in Vi}
1185 This option should be set before editing a binary file. You can also
1186 use the |-b| Vim argument. When this option is switched on a few
1187 options will be changed (also when it already was on):
1188 'textwidth' will be set to 0
1189 'wrapmargin' will be set to 0
1190 'modeline' will be off
1191 'expandtab' will be off
1192 Also, 'fileformat' and 'fileformats' options will not be used, the
1193 file is read and written like 'fileformat' was "unix" (a single <NL>
1194 separates lines).
1195 The 'fileencoding' and 'fileencodings' options will not be used, the
1196 file is read without conversion.
1197 NOTE: When you start editing a(nother) file while the 'bin' option is
1198 on, settings from autocommands may change the settings again (e.g.,
1199 'textwidth'), causing trouble when editing. You might want to set
1200 'bin' again when the file has been loaded.
1201 The previous values of these options are remembered and restored when
1202 'bin' is switched from on to off. Each buffer has its own set of
1203 saved option values.
1204 To edit a file with 'binary' set you can use the |++bin| argument.
1205 This avoids you have to do ":set bin", which would have effect for all
1206 files you edit.
1207 When writing a file the <EOL> for the last line is only written if
1208 there was one in the original file (normally Vim appends an <EOL> to
1209 the last line if there is none; this would make the file longer). See
1210 the 'endofline' option.
1211
1212 *'bioskey'* *'biosk'* *'nobioskey'* *'nobiosk'*
1213'bioskey' 'biosk' boolean (default on)
1214 global
1215 {not in Vi} {only for MS-DOS}
Bram Moolenaarf3913272016-02-25 00:00:01 +01001216 This was for MS-DOS and is no longer supported.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001217
1218 *'bomb'* *'nobomb'*
1219'bomb' boolean (default off)
1220 local to buffer
1221 {not in Vi}
1222 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
1223 feature}
1224 When writing a file and the following conditions are met, a BOM (Byte
1225 Order Mark) is prepended to the file:
1226 - this option is on
1227 - the 'binary' option is off
1228 - 'fileencoding' is "utf-8", "ucs-2", "ucs-4" or one of the little/big
1229 endian variants.
1230 Some applications use the BOM to recognize the encoding of the file.
1231 Often used for UCS-2 files on MS-Windows. For other applications it
1232 causes trouble, for example: "cat file1 file2" makes the BOM of file2
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01001233 appear halfway the resulting file. Gcc doesn't accept a BOM.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001234 When Vim reads a file and 'fileencodings' starts with "ucs-bom", a
1235 check for the presence of the BOM is done and 'bomb' set accordingly.
1236 Unless 'binary' is set, it is removed from the first line, so that you
1237 don't see it when editing. When you don't change the options, the BOM
1238 will be restored when writing the file.
1239
1240 *'breakat'* *'brk'*
1241'breakat' 'brk' string (default " ^I!@*-+;:,./?")
1242 global
1243 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02001244 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001245 feature}
1246 This option lets you choose which characters might cause a line
Bram Moolenaarac6e65f2005-08-29 22:25:38 +00001247 break if 'linebreak' is on. Only works for ASCII and also for 8-bit
1248 characters when 'encoding' is an 8-bit encoding.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001249
Bram Moolenaar7c1c6db2016-04-03 22:08:05 +02001250 *'breakindent'* *'bri'* *'nobreakindent'* *'nobri'*
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001251'breakindent' 'bri' boolean (default off)
1252 local to window
1253 {not in Vi}
1254 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
1255 feature}
1256 Every wrapped line will continue visually indented (same amount of
1257 space as the beginning of that line), thus preserving horizontal blocks
1258 of text.
1259
1260 *'breakindentopt'* *'briopt'*
1261'breakindentopt' 'briopt' string (default empty)
1262 local to window
1263 {not in Vi}
1264 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
1265 feature}
1266 Settings for 'breakindent'. It can consist of the following optional
Bram Moolenaar86b17e92014-07-02 20:00:47 +02001267 items and must be separated by a comma:
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001268 min:{n} Minimum text width that will be kept after
1269 applying 'breakindent', even if the resulting
1270 text should normally be narrower. This prevents
1271 text indented almost to the right window border
1272 occupying lot of vertical space when broken.
Bram Moolenaar86b17e92014-07-02 20:00:47 +02001273 shift:{n} After applying 'breakindent', the wrapped line's
1274 beginning will be shifted by the given number of
1275 characters. It permits dynamic French paragraph
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001276 indentation (negative) or emphasizing the line
1277 continuation (positive).
1278 sbr Display the 'showbreak' value before applying the
1279 additional indent.
1280 The default value for min is 20 and shift is 0.
1281
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001282 *'browsedir'* *'bsdir'*
Bram Moolenaar7b0294c2004-10-11 10:16:09 +00001283'browsedir' 'bsdir' string (default: "last")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001284 global
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00001285 {not in Vi} {only for Motif, Athena, GTK, Mac and
1286 Win32 GUI}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001287 Which directory to use for the file browser:
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00001288 last Use same directory as with last file browser, where a
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02001289 file was opened or saved.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001290 buffer Use the directory of the related buffer.
1291 current Use the current directory.
1292 {path} Use the specified directory
1293
1294 *'bufhidden'* *'bh'*
1295'bufhidden' 'bh' string (default: "")
1296 local to buffer
1297 {not in Vi}
1298 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
1299 feature}
1300 This option specifies what happens when a buffer is no longer
1301 displayed in a window:
1302 <empty> follow the global 'hidden' option
1303 hide hide the buffer (don't unload it), also when 'hidden'
1304 is not set
1305 unload unload the buffer, also when 'hidden' is set or using
1306 |:hide|
1307 delete delete the buffer from the buffer list, also when
1308 'hidden' is set or using |:hide|, like using
1309 |:bdelete|
1310 wipe wipe out the buffer from the buffer list, also when
1311 'hidden' is set or using |:hide|, like using
1312 |:bwipeout|
1313
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00001314 CAREFUL: when "unload", "delete" or "wipe" is used changes in a buffer
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01001315 are lost without a warning. Also, these values may break autocommands
1316 that switch between buffers temporarily.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001317 This option is used together with 'buftype' and 'swapfile' to specify
1318 special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
1319
1320 *'buflisted'* *'bl'* *'nobuflisted'* *'nobl'* *E85*
1321'buflisted' 'bl' boolean (default: on)
1322 local to buffer
1323 {not in Vi}
1324 When this option is set, the buffer shows up in the buffer list. If
1325 it is reset it is not used for ":bnext", "ls", the Buffers menu, etc.
1326 This option is reset by Vim for buffers that are only used to remember
1327 a file name or marks. Vim sets it when starting to edit a buffer.
1328 But not when moving to a buffer with ":buffer".
1329
1330 *'buftype'* *'bt'* *E382*
1331'buftype' 'bt' string (default: "")
1332 local to buffer
1333 {not in Vi}
1334 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
1335 feature}
1336 The value of this option specifies the type of a buffer:
1337 <empty> normal buffer
1338 nofile buffer which is not related to a file and will not be
1339 written
1340 nowrite buffer which will not be written
Bram Moolenaar21cf8232004-07-16 20:18:37 +00001341 acwrite buffer which will always be written with BufWriteCmd
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00001342 autocommands. {not available when compiled without the
Bram Moolenaar21cf8232004-07-16 20:18:37 +00001343 |+autocmd| feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001344 quickfix quickfix buffer, contains list of errors |:cwindow|
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00001345 or list of locations |:lwindow|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001346 help help buffer (you are not supposed to set this
1347 manually)
1348
1349 This option is used together with 'bufhidden' and 'swapfile' to
1350 specify special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
1351
1352 Be careful with changing this option, it can have many side effects!
1353
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00001354 A "quickfix" buffer is only used for the error list and the location
1355 list. This value is set by the |:cwindow| and |:lwindow| commands and
1356 you are not supposed to change it.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001357
1358 "nofile" and "nowrite" buffers are similar:
1359 both: The buffer is not to be written to disk, ":w" doesn't
1360 work (":w filename" does work though).
1361 both: The buffer is never considered to be |'modified'|.
1362 There is no warning when the changes will be lost, for
1363 example when you quit Vim.
1364 both: A swap file is only created when using too much memory
1365 (when 'swapfile' has been reset there is never a swap
1366 file).
1367 nofile only: The buffer name is fixed, it is not handled like a
1368 file name. It is not modified in response to a |:cd|
1369 command.
Bram Moolenaar2b8388b2015-02-28 13:11:45 +01001370 both: When using ":e bufname" and already editing "bufname"
1371 the buffer is made empty and autocommands are
1372 triggered as usual for |:edit|.
Bram Moolenaar21cf8232004-07-16 20:18:37 +00001373 *E676*
1374 "acwrite" implies that the buffer name is not related to a file, like
1375 "nofile", but it will be written. Thus, in contrast to "nofile" and
1376 "nowrite", ":w" does work and a modified buffer can't be abandoned
1377 without saving. For writing there must be matching |BufWriteCmd|,
1378 |FileWriteCmd| or |FileAppendCmd| autocommands.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001379
1380 *'casemap'* *'cmp'*
1381'casemap' 'cmp' string (default: "internal,keepascii")
1382 global
1383 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar2217cae2006-03-25 21:55:52 +00001384 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
1385 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001386 Specifies details about changing the case of letters. It may contain
1387 these words, separated by a comma:
1388 internal Use internal case mapping functions, the current
1389 locale does not change the case mapping. This only
Bram Moolenaar6f16eb82005-08-23 21:02:42 +00001390 matters when 'encoding' is a Unicode encoding,
1391 "latin1" or "iso-8859-15". When "internal" is
1392 omitted, the towupper() and towlower() system library
1393 functions are used when available.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001394 keepascii For the ASCII characters (0x00 to 0x7f) use the US
1395 case mapping, the current locale is not effective.
1396 This probably only matters for Turkish.
1397
1398 *'cdpath'* *'cd'* *E344* *E346*
1399'cdpath' 'cd' string (default: equivalent to $CDPATH or ",,")
1400 global
1401 {not in Vi}
1402 {not available when compiled without the
1403 |+file_in_path| feature}
1404 This is a list of directories which will be searched when using the
1405 |:cd| and |:lcd| commands, provided that the directory being searched
Bram Moolenaarc236c162008-07-13 17:41:49 +00001406 for has a relative path, not an absolute part starting with "/", "./"
1407 or "../", the 'cdpath' option is not used then.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001408 The 'cdpath' option's value has the same form and semantics as
1409 |'path'|. Also see |file-searching|.
1410 The default value is taken from $CDPATH, with a "," prepended to look
1411 in the current directory first.
1412 If the default value taken from $CDPATH is not what you want, include
1413 a modified version of the following command in your vimrc file to
1414 override it: >
1415 :let &cdpath = ',' . substitute(substitute($CDPATH, '[, ]', '\\\0', 'g'), ':', ',', 'g')
1416< This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
1417 security reasons.
1418 (parts of 'cdpath' can be passed to the shell to expand file names).
1419
1420 *'cedit'*
1421'cedit' string (Vi default: "", Vim default: CTRL-F)
1422 global
1423 {not in Vi}
1424 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
1425 feature}
1426 The key used in Command-line Mode to open the command-line window.
1427 The default is CTRL-F when 'compatible' is off.
1428 Only non-printable keys are allowed.
1429 The key can be specified as a single character, but it is difficult to
1430 type. The preferred way is to use the <> notation. Examples: >
Bram Moolenaare18dbe82016-07-02 21:42:23 +02001431 :exe "set cedit=\<C-Y>"
1432 :exe "set cedit=\<Esc>"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001433< |Nvi| also has this option, but it only uses the first character.
1434 See |cmdwin|.
1435
1436 *'charconvert'* *'ccv'* *E202* *E214* *E513*
1437'charconvert' 'ccv' string (default "")
1438 global
1439 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02001440 and |+eval| features}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001441 {not in Vi}
1442 An expression that is used for character encoding conversion. It is
1443 evaluated when a file that is to be read or has been written has a
1444 different encoding from what is desired.
1445 'charconvert' is not used when the internal iconv() function is
1446 supported and is able to do the conversion. Using iconv() is
1447 preferred, because it is much faster.
1448 'charconvert' is not used when reading stdin |--|, because there is no
1449 file to convert from. You will have to save the text in a file first.
1450 The expression must return zero or an empty string for success,
1451 non-zero for failure.
1452 The possible encoding names encountered are in 'encoding'.
1453 Additionally, names given in 'fileencodings' and 'fileencoding' are
1454 used.
1455 Conversion between "latin1", "unicode", "ucs-2", "ucs-4" and "utf-8"
1456 is done internally by Vim, 'charconvert' is not used for this.
1457 'charconvert' is also used to convert the viminfo file, if the 'c'
1458 flag is present in 'viminfo'. Also used for Unicode conversion.
1459 Example: >
1460 set charconvert=CharConvert()
1461 fun CharConvert()
1462 system("recode "
1463 \ . v:charconvert_from . ".." . v:charconvert_to
1464 \ . " <" . v:fname_in . " >" v:fname_out)
1465 return v:shell_error
1466 endfun
1467< The related Vim variables are:
1468 v:charconvert_from name of the current encoding
1469 v:charconvert_to name of the desired encoding
1470 v:fname_in name of the input file
1471 v:fname_out name of the output file
1472 Note that v:fname_in and v:fname_out will never be the same.
1473 Note that v:charconvert_from and v:charconvert_to may be different
1474 from 'encoding'. Vim internally uses UTF-8 instead of UCS-2 or UCS-4.
1475 Encryption is not done by Vim when using 'charconvert'. If you want
1476 to encrypt the file after conversion, 'charconvert' should take care
1477 of this.
1478 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
1479 security reasons.
1480
1481 *'cindent'* *'cin'* *'nocindent'* *'nocin'*
1482'cindent' 'cin' boolean (default off)
1483 local to buffer
1484 {not in Vi}
1485 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
1486 feature}
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00001487 Enables automatic C program indenting. See 'cinkeys' to set the keys
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001488 that trigger reindenting in insert mode and 'cinoptions' to set your
1489 preferred indent style.
1490 If 'indentexpr' is not empty, it overrules 'cindent'.
1491 If 'lisp' is not on and both 'indentexpr' and 'equalprg' are empty,
1492 the "=" operator indents using this algorithm rather than calling an
1493 external program.
1494 See |C-indenting|.
1495 When you don't like the way 'cindent' works, try the 'smartindent'
1496 option or 'indentexpr'.
1497 This option is not used when 'paste' is set.
1498 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
1499
1500 *'cinkeys'* *'cink'*
1501'cinkeys' 'cink' string (default "0{,0},0),:,0#,!^F,o,O,e")
1502 local to buffer
1503 {not in Vi}
1504 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
1505 feature}
1506 A list of keys that, when typed in Insert mode, cause reindenting of
1507 the current line. Only used if 'cindent' is on and 'indentexpr' is
1508 empty.
1509 For the format of this option see |cinkeys-format|.
1510 See |C-indenting|.
1511
1512 *'cinoptions'* *'cino'*
1513'cinoptions' 'cino' string (default "")
1514 local to buffer
1515 {not in Vi}
1516 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
1517 feature}
1518 The 'cinoptions' affect the way 'cindent' reindents lines in a C
1519 program. See |cinoptions-values| for the values of this option, and
1520 |C-indenting| for info on C indenting in general.
1521
1522
1523 *'cinwords'* *'cinw'*
1524'cinwords' 'cinw' string (default "if,else,while,do,for,switch")
1525 local to buffer
1526 {not in Vi}
1527 {not available when compiled without both the
1528 |+cindent| and the |+smartindent| features}
1529 These keywords start an extra indent in the next line when
1530 'smartindent' or 'cindent' is set. For 'cindent' this is only done at
1531 an appropriate place (inside {}).
1532 Note that 'ignorecase' isn't used for 'cinwords'. If case doesn't
1533 matter, include the keyword both the uppercase and lowercase:
1534 "if,If,IF".
1535
1536 *'clipboard'* *'cb'*
1537'clipboard' 'cb' string (default "autoselect,exclude:cons\|linux"
1538 for X-windows, "" otherwise)
1539 global
1540 {not in Vi}
1541 {only in GUI versions or when the |+xterm_clipboard|
1542 feature is included}
1543 This option is a list of comma separated names.
1544 These names are recognized:
1545
Bram Moolenaarc0885aa2012-07-10 16:49:23 +02001546 *clipboard-unnamed*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001547 unnamed When included, Vim will use the clipboard register '*'
1548 for all yank, delete, change and put operations which
1549 would normally go to the unnamed register. When a
1550 register is explicitly specified, it will always be
1551 used regardless of whether "unnamed" is in 'clipboard'
1552 or not. The clipboard register can always be
1553 explicitly accessed using the "* notation. Also see
1554 |gui-clipboard|.
1555
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02001556 *clipboard-unnamedplus*
Bram Moolenaar00154502013-02-13 16:15:55 +01001557 unnamedplus A variant of the "unnamed" flag which uses the
1558 clipboard register '+' (|quoteplus|) instead of
1559 register '*' for all yank, delete, change and put
1560 operations which would normally go to the unnamed
1561 register. When "unnamed" is also included to the
1562 option, yank operations (but not delete, change or
1563 put) will additionally copy the text into register
1564 '*'.
Bram Moolenaar81af9252010-12-10 20:35:50 +01001565 Only available with the |+X11| feature.
Bram Moolenaarbf9680e2010-12-02 21:43:16 +01001566 Availability can be checked with: >
1567 if has('unnamedplus')
1568<
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02001569 *clipboard-autoselect*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001570 autoselect Works like the 'a' flag in 'guioptions': If present,
1571 then whenever Visual mode is started, or the Visual
1572 area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of the
1573 windowing system's global selection or put the
1574 selected text on the clipboard used by the selection
1575 register "*. See |guioptions_a| and |quotestar| for
1576 details. When the GUI is active, the 'a' flag in
1577 'guioptions' is used, when the GUI is not active, this
1578 "autoselect" flag is used.
1579 Also applies to the modeless selection.
1580
Bram Moolenaarc0885aa2012-07-10 16:49:23 +02001581 *clipboard-autoselectplus*
1582 autoselectplus Like "autoselect" but using the + register instead of
1583 the * register. Compare to the 'P' flag in
1584 'guioptions'.
1585
1586 *clipboard-autoselectml*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001587 autoselectml Like "autoselect", but for the modeless selection
1588 only. Compare to the 'A' flag in 'guioptions'.
1589
Bram Moolenaarc0885aa2012-07-10 16:49:23 +02001590 *clipboard-html*
Bram Moolenaar3a6eaa52009-06-16 13:23:06 +00001591 html When the clipboard contains HTML, use this when
1592 pasting. When putting text on the clipboard, mark it
1593 as HTML. This works to copy rendered HTML from
1594 Firefox, paste it as raw HTML in Vim, select the HTML
1595 in Vim and paste it in a rich edit box in Firefox.
Bram Moolenaar20a825a2010-05-31 21:27:30 +02001596 You probably want to add this only temporarily,
1597 possibly use BufEnter autocommands.
Bram Moolenaar3a6eaa52009-06-16 13:23:06 +00001598 Only supported for GTK version 2 and later.
1599 Only available with the |+multi_byte| feature.
1600
Bram Moolenaarc0885aa2012-07-10 16:49:23 +02001601 *clipboard-exclude*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001602 exclude:{pattern}
1603 Defines a pattern that is matched against the name of
1604 the terminal 'term'. If there is a match, no
1605 connection will be made to the X server. This is
1606 useful in this situation:
1607 - Running Vim in a console.
1608 - $DISPLAY is set to start applications on another
1609 display.
1610 - You do not want to connect to the X server in the
1611 console, but do want this in a terminal emulator.
1612 To never connect to the X server use: >
1613 exclude:.*
1614< This has the same effect as using the |-X| argument.
1615 Note that when there is no connection to the X server
1616 the window title won't be restored and the clipboard
1617 cannot be accessed.
1618 The value of 'magic' is ignored, {pattern} is
1619 interpreted as if 'magic' was on.
1620 The rest of the option value will be used for
1621 {pattern}, this must be the last entry.
1622
1623 *'cmdheight'* *'ch'*
1624'cmdheight' 'ch' number (default 1)
1625 global
1626 {not in Vi}
1627 Number of screen lines to use for the command-line. Helps avoiding
1628 |hit-enter| prompts.
Bram Moolenaarc6fe9192006-04-09 21:54:49 +00001629 The value of this option is stored with the tab page, so that each tab
1630 page can have a different value.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001631
1632 *'cmdwinheight'* *'cwh'*
1633'cmdwinheight' 'cwh' number (default 7)
1634 global
1635 {not in Vi}
1636 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
1637 feature}
1638 Number of screen lines to use for the command-line window. |cmdwin|
1639
Bram Moolenaar483c5d82010-10-20 18:45:33 +02001640 *'colorcolumn'* *'cc'*
1641'colorcolumn' 'cc' string (default "")
1642 local to window
1643 {not in Vi}
1644 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
1645 feature}
1646 'colorcolumn' is a comma separated list of screen columns that are
1647 highlighted with ColorColumn |hl-ColorColumn|. Useful to align
1648 text. Will make screen redrawing slower.
1649 The screen column can be an absolute number, or a number preceded with
1650 '+' or '-', which is added to or subtracted from 'textwidth'. >
1651
1652 :set cc=+1 " highlight column after 'textwidth'
1653 :set cc=+1,+2,+3 " highlight three columns after 'textwidth'
1654 :hi ColorColumn ctermbg=lightgrey guibg=lightgrey
1655<
1656 When 'textwidth' is zero then the items with '-' and '+' are not used.
1657 A maximum of 256 columns are highlighted.
1658
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001659 *'columns'* *'co'* *E594*
1660'columns' 'co' number (default 80 or terminal width)
1661 global
1662 {not in Vi}
1663 Number of columns of the screen. Normally this is set by the terminal
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00001664 initialization and does not have to be set by hand. Also see
1665 |posix-screen-size|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001666 When Vim is running in the GUI or in a resizable window, setting this
1667 option will cause the window size to be changed. When you only want
1668 to use the size for the GUI, put the command in your |gvimrc| file.
1669 When you set this option and Vim is unable to change the physical
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001670 number of columns of the display, the display may be messed up. For
1671 the GUI it is always possible and Vim limits the number of columns to
1672 what fits on the screen. You can use this command to get the widest
1673 window possible: >
1674 :set columns=9999
1675< Minimum value is 12, maximum value is 10000.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001676
1677 *'comments'* *'com'* *E524* *E525*
1678'comments' 'com' string (default
1679 "s1:/*,mb:*,ex:*/,://,b:#,:%,:XCOMM,n:>,fb:-")
1680 local to buffer
1681 {not in Vi}
1682 {not available when compiled without the |+comments|
1683 feature}
1684 A comma separated list of strings that can start a comment line. See
1685 |format-comments|. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes to
1686 insert a space.
1687
1688 *'commentstring'* *'cms'* *E537*
1689'commentstring' 'cms' string (default "/*%s*/")
1690 local to buffer
1691 {not in Vi}
1692 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
1693 feature}
1694 A template for a comment. The "%s" in the value is replaced with the
1695 comment text. Currently only used to add markers for folding, see
1696 |fold-marker|.
1697
1698 *'compatible'* *'cp'* *'nocompatible'* *'nocp'*
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00001699'compatible' 'cp' boolean (default on, off when a |vimrc| or |gvimrc|
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02001700 file is found, reset in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001701 global
1702 {not in Vi}
1703 This option has the effect of making Vim either more Vi-compatible, or
1704 make Vim behave in a more useful way.
1705 This is a special kind of option, because when it's set or reset,
1706 other options are also changed as a side effect. CAREFUL: Setting or
1707 resetting this option can have a lot of unexpected effects: Mappings
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00001708 are interpreted in another way, undo behaves differently, etc. If you
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001709 set this option in your vimrc file, you should probably put it at the
1710 very start.
1711 By default this option is on and the Vi defaults are used for the
1712 options. This default was chosen for those people who want to use Vim
1713 just like Vi, and don't even (want to) know about the 'compatible'
1714 option.
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00001715 When a |vimrc| or |gvimrc| file is found while Vim is starting up,
Bram Moolenaard042c562005-06-30 22:04:15 +00001716 this option is switched off, and all options that have not been
1717 modified will be set to the Vim defaults. Effectively, this means
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00001718 that when a |vimrc| or |gvimrc| file exists, Vim will use the Vim
Bram Moolenaard042c562005-06-30 22:04:15 +00001719 defaults, otherwise it will use the Vi defaults. (Note: This doesn't
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001720 happen for the system-wide vimrc or gvimrc file, nor for a file given
1721 with the |-u| argument). Also see |compatible-default| and
1722 |posix-compliance|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001723 You can also set this option with the "-C" argument, and reset it with
1724 "-N". See |-C| and |-N|.
1725 Switching this option off makes the Vim defaults be used for options
1726 that have a different Vi and Vim default value. See the options
1727 marked with a '+' below. Other options are not modified.
1728 At the moment this option is set, several other options will be set
1729 or reset to make Vim as Vi-compatible as possible. See the table
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00001730 below. This can be used if you want to revert to Vi compatible
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001731 editing.
1732 See also 'cpoptions'.
1733
1734 option + set value effect ~
1735
1736 'allowrevins' off no CTRL-_ command
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001737 'backspace' "" normal backspace
Bram Moolenaar2ec618c2016-10-01 14:47:05 +02001738 'backupcopy' Unix: "yes" backup file is a copy
1739 else: "auto" copy or rename backup file
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001740 'backup' off no backup file
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001741 'cedit' + "" no key to open the |cmdwin|
Bram Moolenaar2ec618c2016-10-01 14:47:05 +02001742 'cindent' off no C code indentation
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001743 'cpoptions' + (all flags) Vi-compatible flags
1744 'cscopetag' off don't use cscope for ":tag"
1745 'cscopetagorder' 0 see |cscopetagorder|
1746 'cscopeverbose' off see |cscopeverbose|
1747 'digraph' off no digraphs
1748 'esckeys' + off no <Esc>-keys in Insert mode
1749 'expandtab' off tabs not expanded to spaces
1750 'fileformats' + "" no automatic file format detection,
1751 "dos,unix" except for DOS, Windows and OS/2
1752 'formatoptions' + "vt" Vi compatible formatting
1753 'gdefault' off no default 'g' flag for ":s"
1754 'history' + 0 no commandline history
1755 'hkmap' off no Hebrew keyboard mapping
1756 'hkmapp' off no phonetic Hebrew keyboard mapping
1757 'hlsearch' off no highlighting of search matches
1758 'incsearch' off no incremental searching
1759 'indentexpr' "" no indenting by expression
1760 'insertmode' off do not start in Insert mode
1761 'iskeyword' + "@,48-57,_" keywords contain alphanumeric
1762 characters and '_'
1763 'joinspaces' on insert 2 spaces after period
1764 'modeline' + off no modelines
1765 'more' + off no pauses in listings
1766 'revins' off no reverse insert
1767 'ruler' off no ruler
1768 'scrolljump' 1 no jump scroll
1769 'scrolloff' 0 no scroll offset
1770 'shiftround' off indent not rounded to shiftwidth
1771 'shortmess' + "" no shortening of messages
1772 'showcmd' + off command characters not shown
1773 'showmode' + off current mode not shown
1774 'smartcase' off no automatic ignore case switch
1775 'smartindent' off no smart indentation
1776 'smarttab' off no smart tab size
1777 'softtabstop' 0 tabs are always 'tabstop' positions
1778 'startofline' on goto startofline with some commands
1779 'tagrelative' + off tag file names are not relative
1780 'textauto' + off no automatic textmode detection
1781 'textwidth' 0 no automatic line wrap
1782 'tildeop' off tilde is not an operator
1783 'ttimeout' off no terminal timeout
Bram Moolenaar2ec618c2016-10-01 14:47:05 +02001784 'viminfo' + {unchanged} no viminfo file
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001785 'whichwrap' + "" left-right movements don't wrap
1786 'wildchar' + CTRL-E only when the current value is <Tab>
1787 use CTRL-E for cmdline completion
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02001788 'writebackup' on or off depends on the |+writebackup| feature
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001789
1790 *'complete'* *'cpt'* *E535*
1791'complete' 'cpt' string (default: ".,w,b,u,t,i")
1792 local to buffer
1793 {not in Vi}
1794 This option specifies how keyword completion |ins-completion| works
1795 when CTRL-P or CTRL-N are used. It is also used for whole-line
1796 completion |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-L|. It indicates the type of completion
1797 and the places to scan. It is a comma separated list of flags:
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01001798 . scan the current buffer ('wrapscan' is ignored)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001799 w scan buffers from other windows
1800 b scan other loaded buffers that are in the buffer list
1801 u scan the unloaded buffers that are in the buffer list
1802 U scan the buffers that are not in the buffer list
1803 k scan the files given with the 'dictionary' option
Bram Moolenaar0b238792006-03-02 22:49:12 +00001804 kspell use the currently active spell checking |spell|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001805 k{dict} scan the file {dict}. Several "k" flags can be given,
1806 patterns are valid too. For example: >
1807 :set cpt=k/usr/dict/*,k~/spanish
1808< s scan the files given with the 'thesaurus' option
1809 s{tsr} scan the file {tsr}. Several "s" flags can be given, patterns
1810 are valid too.
1811 i scan current and included files
1812 d scan current and included files for defined name or macro
1813 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-D|
1814 ] tag completion
1815 t same as "]"
1816
1817 Unloaded buffers are not loaded, thus their autocmds |:autocmd| are
1818 not executed, this may lead to unexpected completions from some files
1819 (gzipped files for example). Unloaded buffers are not scanned for
1820 whole-line completion.
1821
1822 The default is ".,w,b,u,t,i", which means to scan:
1823 1. the current buffer
1824 2. buffers in other windows
1825 3. other loaded buffers
1826 4. unloaded buffers
1827 5. tags
1828 6. included files
1829
1830 As you can see, CTRL-N and CTRL-P can be used to do any 'iskeyword'-
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00001831 based expansion (e.g., dictionary |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|, included patterns
1832 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-I|, tags |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-]| and normal expansions).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001833
Bram Moolenaarcfbc5ee2004-07-02 15:38:35 +00001834 *'completefunc'* *'cfu'*
1835'completefunc' 'cfu' string (default: empty)
1836 local to buffer
1837 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02001838 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
1839 or |+insert_expand| features}
Bram Moolenaarc7486e02005-12-29 22:48:26 +00001840 This option specifies a function to be used for Insert mode completion
1841 with CTRL-X CTRL-U. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-U|
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00001842 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of how the function is
1843 invoked and what it should return.
Bram Moolenaar166af9b2010-11-16 20:34:40 +01001844 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
1845 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar325b7a22004-07-05 15:58:32 +00001846
Bram Moolenaar1c7715d2005-10-03 22:02:18 +00001847 *'completeopt'* *'cot'*
Bram Moolenaar96d2c5b2006-03-11 21:27:59 +00001848'completeopt' 'cot' string (default: "menu,preview")
Bram Moolenaar1c7715d2005-10-03 22:02:18 +00001849 global
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00001850 {not available when compiled without the
1851 |+insert_expand| feature}
Bram Moolenaar1c7715d2005-10-03 22:02:18 +00001852 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarc7453f52006-02-10 23:20:28 +00001853 A comma separated list of options for Insert mode completion
1854 |ins-completion|. The supported values are:
Bram Moolenaar1c7715d2005-10-03 22:02:18 +00001855
1856 menu Use a popup menu to show the possible completions. The
1857 menu is only shown when there is more than one match and
1858 sufficient colors are available. |ins-completion-menu|
1859
Bram Moolenaar65c923a2006-03-03 22:56:30 +00001860 menuone Use the popup menu also when there is only one match.
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00001861 Useful when there is additional information about the
Bram Moolenaar65c923a2006-03-03 22:56:30 +00001862 match, e.g., what file it comes from.
1863
Bram Moolenaarc1e37902006-04-18 21:55:01 +00001864 longest Only insert the longest common text of the matches. If
1865 the menu is displayed you can use CTRL-L to add more
1866 characters. Whether case is ignored depends on the kind
1867 of completion. For buffer text the 'ignorecase' option is
1868 used.
Bram Moolenaarc7453f52006-02-10 23:20:28 +00001869
Bram Moolenaar96d2c5b2006-03-11 21:27:59 +00001870 preview Show extra information about the currently selected
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001871 completion in the preview window. Only works in
1872 combination with "menu" or "menuone".
1873
Bram Moolenaarb6be1e22015-07-10 18:18:40 +02001874 noinsert Do not insert any text for a match until the user selects
1875 a match from the menu. Only works in combination with
1876 "menu" or "menuone". No effect if "longest" is present.
1877
1878 noselect Do not select a match in the menu, force the user to
1879 select one from the menu. Only works in combination with
1880 "menu" or "menuone".
1881
Bram Moolenaar96d2c5b2006-03-11 21:27:59 +00001882
Bram Moolenaarf5963f72010-07-23 22:10:27 +02001883 *'concealcursor'* *'cocu'*
1884'concealcursor' 'cocu' string (default: "")
1885 local to window
1886 {not in Vi}
1887 {not available when compiled without the |+conceal|
1888 feature}
1889 Sets the modes in which text in the cursor line can also be concealed.
1890 When the current mode is listed then concealing happens just like in
1891 other lines.
1892 n Normal mode
1893 v Visual mode
1894 i Insert mode
Bram Moolenaarca8c9862010-07-24 15:00:38 +02001895 c Command line editing, for 'incsearch'
Bram Moolenaarf5963f72010-07-23 22:10:27 +02001896
Bram Moolenaare6dc5732010-07-24 23:52:26 +02001897 'v' applies to all lines in the Visual area, not only the cursor.
Bram Moolenaarca8c9862010-07-24 15:00:38 +02001898 A useful value is "nc". This is used in help files. So long as you
Bram Moolenaarf5963f72010-07-23 22:10:27 +02001899 are moving around text is concealed, but when starting to insert text
1900 or selecting a Visual area the concealed text is displayed, so that
1901 you can see what you are doing.
Bram Moolenaarf70e3d62010-07-24 13:15:07 +02001902 Keep in mind that the cursor position is not always where it's
1903 displayed. E.g., when moving vertically it may change column.
Bram Moolenaarf5963f72010-07-23 22:10:27 +02001904
1905
1906'conceallevel' 'cole' *'conceallevel'* *'cole'*
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02001907 number (default 0)
1908 local to window
1909 {not in Vi}
1910 {not available when compiled without the |+conceal|
1911 feature}
Bram Moolenaar6df6f472010-07-18 18:04:50 +02001912 Determine how text with the "conceal" syntax attribute |:syn-conceal|
1913 is shown:
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02001914
Bram Moolenaar6df6f472010-07-18 18:04:50 +02001915 Value Effect ~
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02001916 0 Text is shown normally
Bram Moolenaar477db062010-07-28 18:17:41 +02001917 1 Each block of concealed text is replaced with one
1918 character. If the syntax item does not have a custom
1919 replacement character defined (see |:syn-cchar|) the
1920 character defined in 'listchars' is used (default is a
1921 space).
1922 It is highlighted with the "Conceal" highlight group.
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02001923 2 Concealed text is completely hidden unless it has a
1924 custom replacement character defined (see
Bram Moolenaar477db062010-07-28 18:17:41 +02001925 |:syn-cchar|).
Bram Moolenaara7781e02010-07-19 20:13:22 +02001926 3 Concealed text is completely hidden.
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02001927
Bram Moolenaara7781e02010-07-19 20:13:22 +02001928 Note: in the cursor line concealed text is not hidden, so that you can
Bram Moolenaarf5963f72010-07-23 22:10:27 +02001929 edit and copy the text. This can be changed with the 'concealcursor'
1930 option.
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02001931
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001932 *'confirm'* *'cf'* *'noconfirm'* *'nocf'*
1933'confirm' 'cf' boolean (default off)
1934 global
1935 {not in Vi}
1936 When 'confirm' is on, certain operations that would normally
1937 fail because of unsaved changes to a buffer, e.g. ":q" and ":e",
1938 instead raise a |dialog| asking if you wish to save the current
1939 file(s). You can still use a ! to unconditionally |abandon| a buffer.
1940 If 'confirm' is off you can still activate confirmation for one
1941 command only (this is most useful in mappings) with the |:confirm|
1942 command.
1943 Also see the |confirm()| function and the 'v' flag in 'guioptions'.
1944
1945 *'conskey'* *'consk'* *'noconskey'* *'noconsk'*
1946'conskey' 'consk' boolean (default off)
1947 global
1948 {not in Vi} {only for MS-DOS}
Bram Moolenaarf3913272016-02-25 00:00:01 +01001949 This was for MS-DOS and is no longer supported.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001950
1951 *'copyindent'* *'ci'* *'nocopyindent'* *'noci'*
1952'copyindent' 'ci' boolean (default off)
1953 local to buffer
1954 {not in Vi}
1955 Copy the structure of the existing lines indent when autoindenting a
1956 new line. Normally the new indent is reconstructed by a series of
1957 tabs followed by spaces as required (unless |'expandtab'| is enabled,
1958 in which case only spaces are used). Enabling this option makes the
1959 new line copy whatever characters were used for indenting on the
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00001960 existing line. 'expandtab' has no effect on these characters, a Tab
1961 remains a Tab. If the new indent is greater than on the existing
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001962 line, the remaining space is filled in the normal manner.
1963 NOTE: 'copyindent' is reset when 'compatible' is set.
1964 Also see 'preserveindent'.
1965
Bram Moolenaare0fa3742016-02-20 15:47:01 +01001966 *'cpoptions'* *'cpo'* *cpo*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001967'cpoptions' 'cpo' string (Vim default: "aABceFs",
1968 Vi default: all flags)
1969 global
1970 {not in Vi}
1971 A sequence of single character flags. When a character is present
Bram Moolenaar7cba6c02013-09-05 22:13:31 +02001972 this indicates Vi-compatible behavior. This is used for things where
1973 not being Vi-compatible is mostly or sometimes preferred.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001974 'cpoptions' stands for "compatible-options".
1975 Commas can be added for readability.
1976 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
1977 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
1978 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
1979 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00001980 NOTE: This option is set to the POSIX default value at startup when
1981 the Vi default value would be used and the $VIM_POSIX environment
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01001982 variable exists |posix|. This means Vim tries to behave like the
1983 POSIX specification.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001984
1985 contains behavior ~
1986 *cpo-a*
1987 a When included, a ":read" command with a file name
1988 argument will set the alternate file name for the
1989 current window.
1990 *cpo-A*
1991 A When included, a ":write" command with a file name
1992 argument will set the alternate file name for the
1993 current window.
1994 *cpo-b*
1995 b "\|" in a ":map" command is recognized as the end of
1996 the map command. The '\' is included in the mapping,
1997 the text after the '|' is interpreted as the next
1998 command. Use a CTRL-V instead of a backslash to
1999 include the '|' in the mapping. Applies to all
2000 mapping, abbreviation, menu and autocmd commands.
2001 See also |map_bar|.
2002 *cpo-B*
2003 B A backslash has no special meaning in mappings,
2004 abbreviations and the "to" part of the menu commands.
2005 Remove this flag to be able to use a backslash like a
2006 CTRL-V. For example, the command ":map X \<Esc>"
2007 results in X being mapped to:
2008 'B' included: "\^[" (^[ is a real <Esc>)
2009 'B' excluded: "<Esc>" (5 characters)
2010 ('<' excluded in both cases)
2011 *cpo-c*
2012 c Searching continues at the end of any match at the
2013 cursor position, but not further than the start of the
2014 next line. When not present searching continues
2015 one character from the cursor position. With 'c'
2016 "abababababab" only gets three matches when repeating
2017 "/abab", without 'c' there are five matches.
2018 *cpo-C*
2019 C Do not concatenate sourced lines that start with a
2020 backslash. See |line-continuation|.
2021 *cpo-d*
2022 d Using "./" in the 'tags' option doesn't mean to use
2023 the tags file relative to the current file, but the
2024 tags file in the current directory.
2025 *cpo-D*
2026 D Can't use CTRL-K to enter a digraph after Normal mode
2027 commands with a character argument, like |r|, |f| and
2028 |t|.
2029 *cpo-e*
2030 e When executing a register with ":@r", always add a
2031 <CR> to the last line, also when the register is not
2032 linewise. If this flag is not present, the register
2033 is not linewise and the last line does not end in a
2034 <CR>, then the last line is put on the command-line
2035 and can be edited before hitting <CR>.
2036 *cpo-E*
2037 E It is an error when using "y", "d", "c", "g~", "gu" or
2038 "gU" on an Empty region. The operators only work when
2039 at least one character is to be operate on. Example:
2040 This makes "y0" fail in the first column.
2041 *cpo-f*
2042 f When included, a ":read" command with a file name
2043 argument will set the file name for the current buffer,
2044 if the current buffer doesn't have a file name yet.
2045 *cpo-F*
2046 F When included, a ":write" command with a file name
2047 argument will set the file name for the current
2048 buffer, if the current buffer doesn't have a file name
Bram Moolenaarb3480382005-12-11 21:33:32 +00002049 yet. Also see |cpo-P|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002050 *cpo-g*
2051 g Goto line 1 when using ":edit" without argument.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002052 *cpo-H*
2053 H When using "I" on a line with only blanks, insert
2054 before the last blank. Without this flag insert after
2055 the last blank.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002056 *cpo-i*
2057 i When included, interrupting the reading of a file will
2058 leave it modified.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002059 *cpo-I*
2060 I When moving the cursor up or down just after inserting
2061 indent for 'autoindent', do not delete the indent.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002062 *cpo-j*
2063 j When joining lines, only add two spaces after a '.',
2064 not after '!' or '?'. Also see 'joinspaces'.
2065 *cpo-J*
2066 J A |sentence| has to be followed by two spaces after
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00002067 the '.', '!' or '?'. A <Tab> is not recognized as
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002068 white space.
2069 *cpo-k*
2070 k Disable the recognition of raw key codes in
2071 mappings, abbreviations, and the "to" part of menu
2072 commands. For example, if <Key> sends ^[OA (where ^[
2073 is <Esc>), the command ":map X ^[OA" results in X
2074 being mapped to:
2075 'k' included: "^[OA" (3 characters)
2076 'k' excluded: "<Key>" (one key code)
2077 Also see the '<' flag below.
2078 *cpo-K*
2079 K Don't wait for a key code to complete when it is
2080 halfway a mapping. This breaks mapping <F1><F1> when
2081 only part of the second <F1> has been read. It
2082 enables cancelling the mapping by typing <F1><Esc>.
2083 *cpo-l*
2084 l Backslash in a [] range in a search pattern is taken
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00002085 literally, only "\]", "\^", "\-" and "\\" are special.
2086 See |/[]|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002087 'l' included: "/[ \t]" finds <Space>, '\' and 't'
2088 'l' excluded: "/[ \t]" finds <Space> and <Tab>
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00002089 Also see |cpo-\|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002090 *cpo-L*
2091 L When the 'list' option is set, 'wrapmargin',
2092 'textwidth', 'softtabstop' and Virtual Replace mode
2093 (see |gR|) count a <Tab> as two characters, instead of
2094 the normal behavior of a <Tab>.
2095 *cpo-m*
2096 m When included, a showmatch will always wait half a
2097 second. When not included, a showmatch will wait half
2098 a second or until a character is typed. |'showmatch'|
2099 *cpo-M*
2100 M When excluded, "%" matching will take backslashes into
2101 account. Thus in "( \( )" and "\( ( \)" the outer
2102 parenthesis match. When included "%" ignores
2103 backslashes, which is Vi compatible.
2104 *cpo-n*
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02002105 n When included, the column used for 'number' and
2106 'relativenumber' will also be used for text of wrapped
2107 lines.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002108 *cpo-o*
2109 o Line offset to search command is not remembered for
2110 next search.
2111 *cpo-O*
2112 O Don't complain if a file is being overwritten, even
2113 when it didn't exist when editing it. This is a
2114 protection against a file unexpectedly created by
2115 someone else. Vi didn't complain about this.
2116 *cpo-p*
2117 p Vi compatible Lisp indenting. When not present, a
2118 slightly better algorithm is used.
Bram Moolenaarb3480382005-12-11 21:33:32 +00002119 *cpo-P*
2120 P When included, a ":write" command that appends to a
2121 file will set the file name for the current buffer, if
2122 the current buffer doesn't have a file name yet and
2123 the 'F' flag is also included |cpo-F|.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002124 *cpo-q*
2125 q When joining multiple lines leave the cursor at the
2126 position where it would be when joining two lines.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002127 *cpo-r*
2128 r Redo ("." command) uses "/" to repeat a search
2129 command, instead of the actually used search string.
2130 *cpo-R*
2131 R Remove marks from filtered lines. Without this flag
2132 marks are kept like |:keepmarks| was used.
2133 *cpo-s*
2134 s Set buffer options when entering the buffer for the
2135 first time. This is like it is in Vim version 3.0.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002136 And it is the default. If not present the options are
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002137 set when the buffer is created.
2138 *cpo-S*
2139 S Set buffer options always when entering a buffer
2140 (except 'readonly', 'fileformat', 'filetype' and
2141 'syntax'). This is the (most) Vi compatible setting.
2142 The options are set to the values in the current
2143 buffer. When you change an option and go to another
2144 buffer, the value is copied. Effectively makes the
2145 buffer options global to all buffers.
2146
2147 's' 'S' copy buffer options
2148 no no when buffer created
2149 yes no when buffer first entered (default)
2150 X yes each time when buffer entered (vi comp.)
2151 *cpo-t*
2152 t Search pattern for the tag command is remembered for
2153 "n" command. Otherwise Vim only puts the pattern in
2154 the history for search pattern, but doesn't change the
2155 last used search pattern.
2156 *cpo-u*
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002157 u Undo is Vi compatible. See |undo-two-ways|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002158 *cpo-v*
2159 v Backspaced characters remain visible on the screen in
2160 Insert mode. Without this flag the characters are
2161 erased from the screen right away. With this flag the
2162 screen newly typed text overwrites backspaced
2163 characters.
2164 *cpo-w*
2165 w When using "cw" on a blank character, only change one
2166 character and not all blanks until the start of the
2167 next word.
2168 *cpo-W*
2169 W Don't overwrite a readonly file. When omitted, ":w!"
2170 overwrites a readonly file, if possible.
2171 *cpo-x*
2172 x <Esc> on the command-line executes the command-line.
2173 The default in Vim is to abandon the command-line,
2174 because <Esc> normally aborts a command. |c_<Esc>|
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002175 *cpo-X*
2176 X When using a count with "R" the replaced text is
2177 deleted only once. Also when repeating "R" with "."
2178 and a count.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002179 *cpo-y*
2180 y A yank command can be redone with ".".
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002181 *cpo-Z*
2182 Z When using "w!" while the 'readonly' option is set,
2183 don't reset 'readonly'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002184 *cpo-!*
2185 ! When redoing a filter command, use the last used
2186 external command, whatever it was. Otherwise the last
2187 used -filter- command is used.
2188 *cpo-$*
2189 $ When making a change to one line, don't redisplay the
2190 line, but put a '$' at the end of the changed text.
2191 The changed text will be overwritten when you type the
2192 new text. The line is redisplayed if you type any
2193 command that moves the cursor from the insertion
2194 point.
2195 *cpo-%*
2196 % Vi-compatible matching is done for the "%" command.
2197 Does not recognize "#if", "#endif", etc.
2198 Does not recognize "/*" and "*/".
2199 Parens inside single and double quotes are also
2200 counted, causing a string that contains a paren to
2201 disturb the matching. For example, in a line like
2202 "if (strcmp("foo(", s))" the first paren does not
2203 match the last one. When this flag is not included,
2204 parens inside single and double quotes are treated
2205 specially. When matching a paren outside of quotes,
2206 everything inside quotes is ignored. When matching a
2207 paren inside quotes, it will find the matching one (if
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002208 there is one). This works very well for C programs.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00002209 This flag is also used for other features, such as
2210 C-indenting.
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00002211 *cpo--*
2212 - When included, a vertical movement command fails when
Bram Moolenaar8ada17c2006-01-19 22:16:24 +00002213 it would go above the first line or below the last
2214 line. Without it the cursor moves to the first or
2215 last line, unless it already was in that line.
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00002216 Applies to the commands "-", "k", CTRL-P, "+", "j",
Bram Moolenaar8ada17c2006-01-19 22:16:24 +00002217 CTRL-N, CTRL-J and ":1234".
Bram Moolenaar1cd871b2004-12-19 22:46:22 +00002218 *cpo-+*
2219 + When included, a ":write file" command will reset the
2220 'modified' flag of the buffer, even though the buffer
2221 itself may still be different from its file.
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00002222 *cpo-star*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002223 * Use ":*" in the same way as ":@". When not included,
2224 ":*" is an alias for ":'<,'>", select the Visual area.
2225 *cpo-<*
2226 < Disable the recognition of special key codes in |<>|
2227 form in mappings, abbreviations, and the "to" part of
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002228 menu commands. For example, the command
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002229 ":map X <Tab>" results in X being mapped to:
2230 '<' included: "<Tab>" (5 characters)
2231 '<' excluded: "^I" (^I is a real <Tab>)
2232 Also see the 'k' flag above.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002233 *cpo->*
2234 > When appending to a register, put a line break before
2235 the appended text.
Bram Moolenaar8b3e0332011-06-26 05:36:34 +02002236 *cpo-;*
2237 ; When using |,| or |;| to repeat the last |t| search
2238 and the cursor is right in front of the searched
2239 character, the cursor won't move. When not included,
2240 the cursor would skip over it and jump to the
Bram Moolenaarc8734422012-06-01 22:38:45 +02002241 following occurrence.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002242
2243 POSIX flags. These are not included in the Vi default value, except
2244 when $VIM_POSIX was set on startup. |posix|
2245
2246 contains behavior ~
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00002247 *cpo-#*
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002248 # A count before "D", "o" and "O" has no effect.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002249 *cpo-&*
2250 & When ":preserve" was used keep the swap file when
2251 exiting normally while this buffer is still loaded.
2252 This flag is tested when exiting.
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00002253 *cpo-\*
2254 \ Backslash in a [] range in a search pattern is taken
2255 literally, only "\]" is special See |/[]|
Bram Moolenaar90915b52005-08-21 22:17:52 +00002256 '\' included: "/[ \-]" finds <Space>, '\' and '-'
2257 '\' excluded: "/[ \-]" finds <Space> and '-'
2258 Also see |cpo-l|.
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00002259 *cpo-/*
2260 / When "%" is used as the replacement string in a |:s|
2261 command, use the previous replacement string. |:s%|
2262 *cpo-{*
2263 { The |{| and |}| commands also stop at a "{" character
2264 at the start of a line.
2265 *cpo-.*
2266 . The ":chdir" and ":cd" commands fail if the current
2267 buffer is modified, unless ! is used. Vim doesn't
2268 need this, since it remembers the full path of an
2269 opened file.
2270 *cpo-bar*
2271 | The value of the $LINES and $COLUMNS environment
2272 variables overrule the terminal size values obtained
2273 with system specific functions.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002274
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002275
Bram Moolenaar40e6a712010-05-16 22:32:54 +02002276 *'cryptmethod'* *'cm'*
Bram Moolenaar32efaf62014-11-05 17:02:17 +01002277'cryptmethod' 'cm' string (default "zip")
Bram Moolenaar49771f42010-07-20 17:32:38 +02002278 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar40e6a712010-05-16 22:32:54 +02002279 {not in Vi}
2280 Method used for encryption when the buffer is written to a file:
Bram Moolenaar0bbabe82010-05-17 20:32:55 +02002281 *pkzip*
Bram Moolenaar49771f42010-07-20 17:32:38 +02002282 zip PkZip compatible method. A weak kind of encryption.
Bram Moolenaarf50a2532010-05-21 15:36:08 +02002283 Backwards compatible with Vim 7.2 and older.
Bram Moolenaar0bbabe82010-05-17 20:32:55 +02002284 *blowfish*
Bram Moolenaar8f4ac012014-08-10 13:38:34 +02002285 blowfish Blowfish method. Medium strong encryption but it has
2286 an implementation flaw. Requires Vim 7.3 or later,
2287 files can NOT be read by Vim 7.2 and older. This adds
2288 a "seed" to the file, every time you write the file
2289 the encrypted bytes will be different.
2290 *blowfish2*
2291 blowfish2 Blowfish method. Medium strong encryption. Requires
Bram Moolenaar5e9b2fa2016-02-01 22:37:05 +01002292 Vim 7.4.401 or later, files can NOT be read by Vim 7.3
Bram Moolenaar8f4ac012014-08-10 13:38:34 +02002293 and older. This adds a "seed" to the file, every time
2294 you write the file the encrypted bytes will be
2295 different. The whole undo file is encrypted, not just
2296 the pieces of text.
Bram Moolenaarf50a2532010-05-21 15:36:08 +02002297
Bram Moolenaar4f3f6682016-03-26 23:01:59 +01002298 You should use "blowfish2", also to re-encrypt older files.
2299
Bram Moolenaar40e6a712010-05-16 22:32:54 +02002300 When reading an encrypted file 'cryptmethod' will be set automatically
Bram Moolenaarf50a2532010-05-21 15:36:08 +02002301 to the detected method of the file being read. Thus if you write it
2302 without changing 'cryptmethod' the same method will be used.
2303 Changing 'cryptmethod' does not mark the file as modified, you have to
Bram Moolenaar49771f42010-07-20 17:32:38 +02002304 explicitly write it, you don't get a warning unless there are other
2305 modifications. Also see |:X|.
2306
2307 When setting the global value to an empty string, it will end up with
2308 the value "zip". When setting the local value to an empty string the
2309 buffer will use the global value.
2310
Bram Moolenaarf50a2532010-05-21 15:36:08 +02002311 When a new encryption method is added in a later version of Vim, and
2312 the current version does not recognize it, you will get *E821* .
Bram Moolenaar49771f42010-07-20 17:32:38 +02002313 You need to edit this file with the later version of Vim.
Bram Moolenaar40e6a712010-05-16 22:32:54 +02002314
2315
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002316 *'cscopepathcomp'* *'cspc'*
2317'cscopepathcomp' 'cspc' number (default 0)
2318 global
2319 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2320 feature}
2321 {not in Vi}
2322 Determines how many components of the path to show in a list of tags.
2323 See |cscopepathcomp|.
2324
2325 *'cscopeprg'* *'csprg'*
2326'cscopeprg' 'csprg' string (default "cscope")
2327 global
2328 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2329 feature}
2330 {not in Vi}
2331 Specifies the command to execute cscope. See |cscopeprg|.
2332 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2333 security reasons.
2334
2335 *'cscopequickfix'* *'csqf'*
2336'cscopequickfix' 'csqf' string (default "")
2337 global
2338 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2339 or |+quickfix| features}
2340 {not in Vi}
2341 Specifies whether to use quickfix window to show cscope results.
2342 See |cscopequickfix|.
2343
Bram Moolenaarec7944a2013-06-12 21:29:15 +02002344 *'cscoperelative'* *'csre'* *'nocscoperelative'* *'nocsre'*
Bram Moolenaar2f982e42011-06-12 20:42:22 +02002345'cscoperelative' 'csre' boolean (default off)
2346 global
2347 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2348 feature}
2349 {not in Vi}
2350 In the absence of a prefix (-P) for cscope. setting this option enables
2351 to use the basename of cscope.out path as the prefix.
2352 See |cscoperelative|.
2353
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002354 *'cscopetag'* *'cst'* *'nocscopetag'* *'nocst'*
2355'cscopetag' 'cst' boolean (default off)
2356 global
2357 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2358 feature}
2359 {not in Vi}
2360 Use cscope for tag commands. See |cscope-options|.
2361 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
2362
2363 *'cscopetagorder'* *'csto'*
2364'cscopetagorder' 'csto' number (default 0)
2365 global
2366 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2367 feature}
2368 {not in Vi}
2369 Determines the order in which ":cstag" performs a search. See
2370 |cscopetagorder|.
2371 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
2372
2373 *'cscopeverbose'* *'csverb'*
2374 *'nocscopeverbose'* *'nocsverb'*
2375'cscopeverbose' 'csverb' boolean (default off)
2376 global
2377 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2378 feature}
2379 {not in Vi}
2380 Give messages when adding a cscope database. See |cscopeverbose|.
2381 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
2382
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002383 *'cursorbind'* *'crb'* *'nocursorbind'* *'nocrb'*
2384'cursorbind' 'crb' boolean (default off)
2385 local to window
2386 {not in Vi}
2387 {not available when compiled without the |+cursorbind|
2388 feature}
2389 When this option is set, as the cursor in the current
2390 window moves other cursorbound windows (windows that also have
2391 this option set) move their cursors to the corresponding line and
2392 column. This option is useful for viewing the
2393 differences between two versions of a file (see 'diff'); in diff mode,
2394 inserted and deleted lines (though not characters within a line) are
Bram Moolenaar1a384422010-07-14 19:53:30 +02002395 taken into account.
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002396
Bram Moolenaar600dddc2006-03-12 22:05:10 +00002397
2398 *'cursorcolumn'* *'cuc'* *'nocursorcolumn'* *'nocuc'*
2399'cursorcolumn' 'cuc' boolean (default off)
2400 local to window
2401 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02002402 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
Bram Moolenaar600dddc2006-03-12 22:05:10 +00002403 feature}
2404 Highlight the screen column of the cursor with CursorColumn
2405 |hl-CursorColumn|. Useful to align text. Will make screen redrawing
2406 slower.
Bram Moolenaar4c3f5362006-04-11 21:38:50 +00002407 If you only want the highlighting in the current window you can use
2408 these autocommands: >
2409 au WinLeave * set nocursorline nocursorcolumn
2410 au WinEnter * set cursorline cursorcolumn
2411<
Bram Moolenaar600dddc2006-03-12 22:05:10 +00002412
2413 *'cursorline'* *'cul'* *'nocursorline'* *'nocul'*
2414'cursorline' 'cul' boolean (default off)
2415 local to window
2416 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02002417 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
Bram Moolenaar600dddc2006-03-12 22:05:10 +00002418 feature}
2419 Highlight the screen line of the cursor with CursorLine
2420 |hl-CursorLine|. Useful to easily spot the cursor. Will make screen
2421 redrawing slower.
Bram Moolenaare2f98b92006-03-29 21:18:24 +00002422 When Visual mode is active the highlighting isn't used to make it
Bram Moolenaar779b74b2006-04-10 14:55:34 +00002423 easier to see the selected text.
Bram Moolenaar600dddc2006-03-12 22:05:10 +00002424
2425
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002426 *'debug'*
2427'debug' string (default "")
2428 global
2429 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00002430 These values can be used:
2431 msg Error messages that would otherwise be omitted will be given
2432 anyway.
2433 throw Error messages that would otherwise be omitted will be given
2434 anyway and also throw an exception and set |v:errmsg|.
2435 beep A message will be given when otherwise only a beep would be
2436 produced.
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00002437 The values can be combined, separated by a comma.
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00002438 "msg" and "throw" are useful for debugging 'foldexpr', 'formatexpr' or
2439 'indentexpr'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002440
2441 *'define'* *'def'*
2442'define' 'def' string (default "^\s*#\s*define")
2443 global or local to buffer |global-local|
2444 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002445 Pattern to be used to find a macro definition. It is a search
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002446 pattern, just like for the "/" command. This option is used for the
2447 commands like "[i" and "[d" |include-search|. The 'isident' option is
2448 used to recognize the defined name after the match:
2449 {match with 'define'}{non-ID chars}{defined name}{non-ID char}
2450 See |option-backslash| about inserting backslashes to include a space
2451 or backslash.
2452 The default value is for C programs. For C++ this value would be
2453 useful, to include const type declarations: >
2454 ^\(#\s*define\|[a-z]*\s*const\s*[a-z]*\)
2455< When using the ":set" command, you need to double the backslashes!
2456
2457 *'delcombine'* *'deco'* *'nodelcombine'* *'nodeco'*
2458'delcombine' 'deco' boolean (default off)
2459 global
2460 {not in Vi}
2461 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
2462 feature}
2463 If editing Unicode and this option is set, backspace and Normal mode
2464 "x" delete each combining character on its own. When it is off (the
2465 default) the character along with its combining characters are
2466 deleted.
2467 Note: When 'delcombine' is set "xx" may work different from "2x"!
2468
2469 This is useful for Arabic, Hebrew and many other languages where one
2470 may have combining characters overtop of base characters, and want
2471 to remove only the combining ones.
2472
2473 *'dictionary'* *'dict'*
2474'dictionary' 'dict' string (default "")
2475 global or local to buffer |global-local|
2476 {not in Vi}
2477 List of file names, separated by commas, that are used to lookup words
2478 for keyword completion commands |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|. Each file should
2479 contain a list of words. This can be one word per line, or several
2480 words per line, separated by non-keyword characters (white space is
2481 preferred). Maximum line length is 510 bytes.
Bram Moolenaar0b238792006-03-02 22:49:12 +00002482 When this option is empty, or an entry "spell" is present, spell
2483 checking is enabled the currently active spelling is used. |spell|
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002484 To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002485 after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file
2486 name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes.
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +00002487 This has nothing to do with the |Dictionary| variable type.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002488 Where to find a list of words?
2489 - On FreeBSD, there is the file "/usr/share/dict/words".
2490 - In the Simtel archive, look in the "msdos/linguist" directory.
2491 - In "miscfiles" of the GNU collection.
2492 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
2493 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
2494 uses another default.
2495 Backticks cannot be used in this option for security reasons.
2496
2497 *'diff'* *'nodiff'*
2498'diff' boolean (default off)
2499 local to window
2500 {not in Vi}
2501 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
2502 feature}
2503 Join the current window in the group of windows that shows differences
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002504 between files. See |vimdiff|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002505
2506 *'dex'* *'diffexpr'*
2507'diffexpr' 'dex' string (default "")
2508 global
2509 {not in Vi}
2510 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
2511 feature}
2512 Expression which is evaluated to obtain an ed-style diff file from two
2513 versions of a file. See |diff-diffexpr|.
2514 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2515 security reasons.
2516
2517 *'dip'* *'diffopt'*
2518'diffopt' 'dip' string (default "filler")
2519 global
2520 {not in Vi}
2521 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
2522 feature}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002523 Option settings for diff mode. It can consist of the following items.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002524 All are optional. Items must be separated by a comma.
2525
2526 filler Show filler lines, to keep the text
2527 synchronized with a window that has inserted
2528 lines at the same position. Mostly useful
2529 when windows are side-by-side and 'scrollbind'
2530 is set.
2531
2532 context:{n} Use a context of {n} lines between a change
2533 and a fold that contains unchanged lines.
2534 When omitted a context of six lines is used.
2535 See |fold-diff|.
2536
2537 icase Ignore changes in case of text. "a" and "A"
2538 are considered the same. Adds the "-i" flag
2539 to the "diff" command if 'diffexpr' is empty.
2540
2541 iwhite Ignore changes in amount of white space. Adds
2542 the "-b" flag to the "diff" command if
2543 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation
2544 of the "diff" command for what this does
2545 exactly. It should ignore adding trailing
2546 white space, but not leading white space.
2547
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00002548 horizontal Start diff mode with horizontal splits (unless
2549 explicitly specified otherwise).
2550
2551 vertical Start diff mode with vertical splits (unless
2552 explicitly specified otherwise).
2553
2554 foldcolumn:{n} Set the 'foldcolumn' option to {n} when
2555 starting diff mode. Without this 2 is used.
2556
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002557 Examples: >
2558
2559 :set diffopt=filler,context:4
2560 :set diffopt=
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00002561 :set diffopt=filler,foldcolumn:3
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002562<
2563 *'digraph'* *'dg'* *'nodigraph'* *'nodg'*
2564'digraph' 'dg' boolean (default off)
2565 global
2566 {not in Vi}
2567 {not available when compiled without the |+digraphs|
2568 feature}
2569 Enable the entering of digraphs in Insert mode with {char1} <BS>
2570 {char2}. See |digraphs|.
2571 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
2572
2573 *'directory'* *'dir'*
2574'directory' 'dir' string (default for Amiga: ".,t:",
Bram Moolenaardfb18412013-12-11 18:53:29 +01002575 for MS-DOS and Win32: ".,$TEMP,c:\tmp,c:\temp"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002576 for Unix: ".,~/tmp,/var/tmp,/tmp")
2577 global
2578 List of directory names for the swap file, separated with commas.
2579 - The swap file will be created in the first directory where this is
2580 possible.
2581 - Empty means that no swap file will be used (recovery is
2582 impossible!).
2583 - A directory "." means to put the swap file in the same directory as
2584 the edited file. On Unix, a dot is prepended to the file name, so
2585 it doesn't show in a directory listing. On MS-Windows the "hidden"
2586 attribute is set and a dot prepended if possible.
Bram Moolenaar009b2592004-10-24 19:18:58 +00002587 - A directory starting with "./" (or ".\" for MS-DOS et al.) means to
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002588 put the swap file relative to where the edited file is. The leading
2589 "." is replaced with the path name of the edited file.
Bram Moolenaar83bab712005-08-01 21:58:57 +00002590 - For Unix and Win32, if a directory ends in two path separators "//"
2591 or "\\", the swap file name will be built from the complete path to
2592 the file with all path separators substituted to percent '%' signs.
2593 This will ensure file name uniqueness in the preserve directory.
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00002594 On Win32, when a separating comma is following, you must use "//",
2595 since "\\" will include the comma in the file name.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002596 - Spaces after the comma are ignored, other spaces are considered part
2597 of the directory name. To have a space at the start of a directory
2598 name, precede it with a backslash.
2599 - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with a backslash.
2600 - A directory name may end in an ':' or '/'.
2601 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
2602 - Careful with '\' characters, type one before a space, type two to
2603 get one in the option (see |option-backslash|), for example: >
2604 :set dir=c:\\tmp,\ dir\\,with\\,commas,\\\ dir\ with\ spaces
2605< - For backwards compatibility with Vim version 3.0 a '>' at the start
2606 of the option is removed.
2607 Using "." first in the list is recommended. This means that editing
2608 the same file twice will result in a warning. Using "/tmp" on Unix is
2609 discouraged: When the system crashes you lose the swap file.
2610 "/var/tmp" is often not cleared when rebooting, thus is a better
2611 choice than "/tmp". But it can contain a lot of files, your swap
2612 files get lost in the crowd. That is why a "tmp" directory in your
2613 home directory is tried first.
2614 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
2615 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
2616 uses another default.
2617 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2618 security reasons.
2619 {Vi: directory to put temp file in, defaults to "/tmp"}
2620
2621 *'display'* *'dy'*
Bram Moolenaarbc8801c2016-08-02 21:04:33 +02002622'display' 'dy' string (default "", set to "truncate" in
2623 |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002624 global
2625 {not in Vi}
2626 Change the way text is displayed. This is comma separated list of
2627 flags:
2628 lastline When included, as much as possible of the last line
Bram Moolenaarad9c2a02016-07-27 23:26:04 +02002629 in a window will be displayed. "@@@" is put in the
2630 last columns of the last screen line to indicate the
2631 rest of the line is not displayed.
2632 truncate Like "lastline", but "@@@" is displayed in the first
2633 column of the last screen line. Overrules "lastline".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002634 uhex Show unprintable characters hexadecimal as <xx>
2635 instead of using ^C and ~C.
2636
Bram Moolenaard0796902016-09-16 20:02:31 +02002637 When neither "lastline" nor "truncate" is included, a last line that
Bram Moolenaarad9c2a02016-07-27 23:26:04 +02002638 doesn't fit is replaced with "@" lines.
2639
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002640 *'eadirection'* *'ead'*
2641'eadirection' 'ead' string (default "both")
2642 global
2643 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02002644 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002645 feature}
2646 Tells when the 'equalalways' option applies:
2647 ver vertically, width of windows is not affected
2648 hor horizontally, height of windows is not affected
2649 both width and height of windows is affected
2650
2651 *'ed'* *'edcompatible'* *'noed'* *'noedcompatible'*
2652'edcompatible' 'ed' boolean (default off)
2653 global
2654 Makes the 'g' and 'c' flags of the ":substitute" command to be
2655 toggled each time the flag is given. See |complex-change|. See
2656 also 'gdefault' option.
2657 Switching this option on is discouraged!
2658
Bram Moolenaar03413f42016-04-12 21:07:15 +02002659 *'emoji'* *'emo'* *'noemoji'* *'noemo'*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01002660'emoji' 'emo' boolean (default: on)
2661 global
2662 {not in Vi}
2663 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
2664 feature}
2665 When on all Unicode emoji characters are considered to be full width.
2666
2667
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002668 *'encoding'* *'enc'* *E543*
2669'encoding' 'enc' string (default: "latin1" or value from $LANG)
2670 global
2671 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
2672 feature}
2673 {not in Vi}
2674 Sets the character encoding used inside Vim. It applies to text in
2675 the buffers, registers, Strings in expressions, text stored in the
2676 viminfo file, etc. It sets the kind of characters which Vim can work
2677 with. See |encoding-names| for the possible values.
2678
2679 NOTE: Changing this option will not change the encoding of the
Bram Moolenaar1cd871b2004-12-19 22:46:22 +00002680 existing text in Vim. It may cause non-ASCII text to become invalid.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002681 It should normally be kept at its default value, or set when Vim
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00002682 starts up. See |multibyte|. To reload the menus see |:menutrans|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002683
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02002684 This option cannot be set from a |modeline|. It would most likely
2685 corrupt the text.
2686
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002687 NOTE: For GTK+ 2 it is highly recommended to set 'encoding' to
2688 "utf-8". Although care has been taken to allow different values of
2689 'encoding', "utf-8" is the natural choice for the environment and
2690 avoids unnecessary conversion overhead. "utf-8" has not been made
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002691 the default to prevent different behavior of the GUI and terminal
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002692 versions, and to avoid changing the encoding of newly created files
2693 without your knowledge (in case 'fileencodings' is empty).
2694
2695 The character encoding of files can be different from 'encoding'.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002696 This is specified with 'fileencoding'. The conversion is done with
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002697 iconv() or as specified with 'charconvert'.
2698
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01002699 If you need to know whether 'encoding' is a multi-byte encoding, you
2700 can use: >
2701 if has("multi_byte_encoding")
2702<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002703 Normally 'encoding' will be equal to your current locale. This will
2704 be the default if Vim recognizes your environment settings. If
2705 'encoding' is not set to the current locale, 'termencoding' must be
2706 set to convert typed and displayed text. See |encoding-table|.
2707
2708 When you set this option, it fires the |EncodingChanged| autocommand
2709 event so that you can set up fonts if necessary.
2710
2711 When the option is set, the value is converted to lowercase. Thus
2712 you can set it with uppercase values too. Underscores are translated
2713 to '-' signs.
2714 When the encoding is recognized, it is changed to the standard name.
2715 For example "Latin-1" becomes "latin1", "ISO_88592" becomes
2716 "iso-8859-2" and "utf8" becomes "utf-8".
2717
2718 Note: "latin1" is also used when the encoding could not be detected.
2719 This only works when editing files in the same encoding! When the
2720 actual character set is not latin1, make sure 'fileencoding' and
2721 'fileencodings' are empty. When conversion is needed, switch to using
2722 utf-8.
2723
2724 When "unicode", "ucs-2" or "ucs-4" is used, Vim internally uses utf-8.
2725 You don't notice this while editing, but it does matter for the
2726 |viminfo-file|. And Vim expects the terminal to use utf-8 too. Thus
2727 setting 'encoding' to one of these values instead of utf-8 only has
2728 effect for encoding used for files when 'fileencoding' is empty.
2729
Bram Moolenaar661b1822005-07-28 22:36:45 +00002730 When 'encoding' is set to a Unicode encoding, and 'fileencodings' was
2731 not set yet, the default for 'fileencodings' is changed.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002732
2733 *'endofline'* *'eol'* *'noendofline'* *'noeol'*
2734'endofline' 'eol' boolean (default on)
2735 local to buffer
2736 {not in Vi}
2737 When writing a file and this option is off and the 'binary' option
Bram Moolenaar34d72d42015-07-17 14:18:08 +02002738 is on, or 'fixeol' option is off, no <EOL> will be written for the
2739 last line in the file. This option is automatically set or reset when
2740 starting to edit a new file, depending on whether file has an <EOL>
2741 for the last line in the file. Normally you don't have to set or
2742 reset this option.
2743 When 'binary' is off and 'fixeol' is on the value is not used when
2744 writing the file. When 'binary' is on or 'fixeol' is off it is used
2745 to remember the presence of a <EOL> for the last line in the file, so
2746 that when you write the file the situation from the original file can
2747 be kept. But you can change it if you want to.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002748
2749 *'equalalways'* *'ea'* *'noequalalways'* *'noea'*
2750'equalalways' 'ea' boolean (default on)
2751 global
2752 {not in Vi}
2753 When on, all the windows are automatically made the same size after
Bram Moolenaar009b2592004-10-24 19:18:58 +00002754 splitting or closing a window. This also happens the moment the
2755 option is switched on. When off, splitting a window will reduce the
2756 size of the current window and leave the other windows the same. When
2757 closing a window the extra lines are given to the window next to it
2758 (depending on 'splitbelow' and 'splitright').
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002759 When mixing vertically and horizontally split windows, a minimal size
2760 is computed and some windows may be larger if there is room. The
2761 'eadirection' option tells in which direction the size is affected.
Bram Moolenaar67f71312007-08-12 14:55:56 +00002762 Changing the height and width of a window can be avoided by setting
2763 'winfixheight' and 'winfixwidth', respectively.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01002764 If a window size is specified when creating a new window sizes are
2765 currently not equalized (it's complicated, but may be implemented in
2766 the future).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002767
2768 *'equalprg'* *'ep'*
2769'equalprg' 'ep' string (default "")
2770 global or local to buffer |global-local|
2771 {not in Vi}
2772 External program to use for "=" command. When this option is empty
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00002773 the internal formatting functions are used; either 'lisp', 'cindent'
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01002774 or 'indentexpr'. When Vim was compiled without internal formatting,
2775 the "indent" program is used.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002776 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002777 about including spaces and backslashes.
2778 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2779 security reasons.
2780
2781 *'errorbells'* *'eb'* *'noerrorbells'* *'noeb'*
2782'errorbells' 'eb' boolean (default off)
2783 global
2784 Ring the bell (beep or screen flash) for error messages. This only
2785 makes a difference for error messages, the bell will be used always
2786 for a lot of errors without a message (e.g., hitting <Esc> in Normal
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002787 mode). See 'visualbell' on how to make the bell behave like a beep,
Bram Moolenaar165bc692015-07-21 17:53:25 +02002788 screen flash or do nothing. See 'belloff' to finetune when to ring the
2789 bell.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002790
2791 *'errorfile'* *'ef'*
2792'errorfile' 'ef' string (Amiga default: "AztecC.Err",
2793 others: "errors.err")
2794 global
2795 {not in Vi}
2796 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
2797 feature}
2798 Name of the errorfile for the QuickFix mode (see |:cf|).
2799 When the "-q" command-line argument is used, 'errorfile' is set to the
2800 following argument. See |-q|.
2801 NOT used for the ":make" command. See 'makeef' for that.
2802 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
2803 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
2804 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2805 security reasons.
2806
2807 *'errorformat'* *'efm'*
2808'errorformat' 'efm' string (default is very long)
2809 global or local to buffer |global-local|
2810 {not in Vi}
2811 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
2812 feature}
2813 Scanf-like description of the format for the lines in the error file
2814 (see |errorformat|).
2815
2816 *'esckeys'* *'ek'* *'noesckeys'* *'noek'*
2817'esckeys' 'ek' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
2818 global
2819 {not in Vi}
2820 Function keys that start with an <Esc> are recognized in Insert
2821 mode. When this option is off, the cursor and function keys cannot be
2822 used in Insert mode if they start with an <Esc>. The advantage of
2823 this is that the single <Esc> is recognized immediately, instead of
2824 after one second. Instead of resetting this option, you might want to
2825 try changing the values for 'timeoutlen' and 'ttimeoutlen'. Note that
2826 when 'esckeys' is off, you can still map anything, but the cursor keys
2827 won't work by default.
2828 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
2829 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
2830
2831 *'eventignore'* *'ei'*
2832'eventignore' 'ei' string (default "")
2833 global
2834 {not in Vi}
2835 {not available when compiled without the |+autocmd|
2836 feature}
2837 A list of autocommand event names, which are to be ignored.
Bram Moolenaarf193fff2006-04-27 00:02:13 +00002838 When set to "all" or when "all" is one of the items, all autocommand
2839 events are ignored, autocommands will not be executed.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002840 Otherwise this is a comma separated list of event names. Example: >
2841 :set ei=WinEnter,WinLeave
2842<
2843 *'expandtab'* *'et'* *'noexpandtab'* *'noet'*
2844'expandtab' 'et' boolean (default off)
2845 local to buffer
2846 {not in Vi}
2847 In Insert mode: Use the appropriate number of spaces to insert a
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002848 <Tab>. Spaces are used in indents with the '>' and '<' commands and
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002849 when 'autoindent' is on. To insert a real tab when 'expandtab' is
2850 on, use CTRL-V<Tab>. See also |:retab| and |ins-expandtab|.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02002851 This option is reset when the 'paste' option is set and restored when
2852 the 'paste' option is reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002853 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
2854
2855 *'exrc'* *'ex'* *'noexrc'* *'noex'*
2856'exrc' 'ex' boolean (default off)
2857 global
2858 {not in Vi}
2859 Enables the reading of .vimrc, .exrc and .gvimrc in the current
Bram Moolenaar36f44c22016-08-28 18:17:20 +02002860 directory.
2861
2862 Setting this option is a potential security leak. E.g., consider
2863 unpacking a package or fetching files from github, a .vimrc in there
2864 might be a trojan horse. BETTER NOT SET THIS OPTION!
2865 Instead, define an autocommand in your .vimrc to set options for a
2866 matching directory.
2867
2868 If you do switch this option on you should also consider setting the
2869 'secure' option (see |initialization|).
2870 Also see |.vimrc| and |gui-init|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002871 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2872 security reasons.
2873
2874 *'fileencoding'* *'fenc'* *E213*
2875'fileencoding' 'fenc' string (default: "")
2876 local to buffer
2877 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
2878 feature}
2879 {not in Vi}
2880 Sets the character encoding for the file of this buffer.
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02002881
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002882 When 'fileencoding' is different from 'encoding', conversion will be
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01002883 done when writing the file. For reading see below.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002884 When 'fileencoding' is empty, the same value as 'encoding' will be
2885 used (no conversion when reading or writing a file).
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01002886 Conversion will also be done when 'encoding' and 'fileencoding' are
2887 both a Unicode encoding and 'fileencoding' is not utf-8. That's
2888 because internally Unicode is always stored as utf-8.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002889 WARNING: Conversion can cause loss of information! When
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01002890 'encoding' is "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding, conversion
2891 is most likely done in a way that the reverse conversion
2892 results in the same text. When 'encoding' is not "utf-8" some
2893 characters may be lost!
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02002894
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002895 See 'encoding' for the possible values. Additionally, values may be
2896 specified that can be handled by the converter, see
2897 |mbyte-conversion|.
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02002898
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002899 When reading a file 'fileencoding' will be set from 'fileencodings'.
2900 To read a file in a certain encoding it won't work by setting
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00002901 'fileencoding', use the |++enc| argument. One exception: when
2902 'fileencodings' is empty the value of 'fileencoding' is used.
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00002903 For a new file the global value of 'fileencoding' is used.
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02002904
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002905 Prepending "8bit-" and "2byte-" has no meaning here, they are ignored.
2906 When the option is set, the value is converted to lowercase. Thus
2907 you can set it with uppercase values too. '_' characters are
2908 replaced with '-'. If a name is recognized from the list for
2909 'encoding', it is replaced by the standard name. For example
2910 "ISO8859-2" becomes "iso-8859-2".
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02002911
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002912 When this option is set, after starting to edit a file, the 'modified'
2913 option is set, because the file would be different when written.
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02002914
2915 Keep in mind that changing 'fenc' from a modeline happens
2916 AFTER the text has been read, thus it applies to when the file will be
2917 written. If you do set 'fenc' in a modeline, you might want to set
2918 'nomodified' to avoid not being able to ":q".
2919
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002920 This option can not be changed when 'modifiable' is off.
2921
2922 *'fe'*
2923 NOTE: Before version 6.0 this option specified the encoding for the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002924 whole of Vim, this was a mistake. Now use 'encoding' instead. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002925 old short name was 'fe', which is no longer used.
2926
2927 *'fileencodings'* *'fencs'*
Bram Moolenaar1cd871b2004-12-19 22:46:22 +00002928'fileencodings' 'fencs' string (default: "ucs-bom",
2929 "ucs-bom,utf-8,default,latin1" when
2930 'encoding' is set to a Unicode value)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002931 global
2932 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
2933 feature}
2934 {not in Vi}
2935 This is a list of character encodings considered when starting to edit
2936 an existing file. When a file is read, Vim tries to use the first
2937 mentioned character encoding. If an error is detected, the next one
2938 in the list is tried. When an encoding is found that works,
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002939 'fileencoding' is set to it. If all fail, 'fileencoding' is set to
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002940 an empty string, which means the value of 'encoding' is used.
2941 WARNING: Conversion can cause loss of information! When
2942 'encoding' is "utf-8" (or one of the other Unicode variants)
2943 conversion is most likely done in a way that the reverse
2944 conversion results in the same text. When 'encoding' is not
Bram Moolenaarc6d8db72005-12-13 20:04:55 +00002945 "utf-8" some non-ASCII characters may be lost! You can use
2946 the |++bad| argument to specify what is done with characters
2947 that can't be converted.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002948 For an empty file or a file with only ASCII characters most encodings
2949 will work and the first entry of 'fileencodings' will be used (except
2950 "ucs-bom", which requires the BOM to be present). If you prefer
2951 another encoding use an BufReadPost autocommand event to test if your
2952 preferred encoding is to be used. Example: >
2953 au BufReadPost * if search('\S', 'w') == 0 |
2954 \ set fenc=iso-2022-jp | endif
2955< This sets 'fileencoding' to "iso-2022-jp" if the file does not contain
2956 non-blank characters.
Bram Moolenaarc6d8db72005-12-13 20:04:55 +00002957 When the |++enc| argument is used then the value of 'fileencodings' is
2958 not used.
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00002959 Note that 'fileencodings' is not used for a new file, the global value
2960 of 'fileencoding' is used instead. You can set it with: >
2961 :setglobal fenc=iso-8859-2
2962< This means that a non-existing file may get a different encoding than
2963 an empty file.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002964 The special value "ucs-bom" can be used to check for a Unicode BOM
2965 (Byte Order Mark) at the start of the file. It must not be preceded
2966 by "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding for this to work properly.
2967 An entry for an 8-bit encoding (e.g., "latin1") should be the last,
2968 because Vim cannot detect an error, thus the encoding is always
2969 accepted.
Bram Moolenaar1cd871b2004-12-19 22:46:22 +00002970 The special value "default" can be used for the encoding from the
2971 environment. This is the default value for 'encoding'. It is useful
2972 when 'encoding' is set to "utf-8" and your environment uses a
2973 non-latin1 encoding, such as Russian.
Bram Moolenaarca003e12006-03-17 23:19:38 +00002974 When 'encoding' is "utf-8" and a file contains an illegal byte
2975 sequence it won't be recognized as UTF-8. You can use the |8g8|
2976 command to find the illegal byte sequence.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002977 WRONG VALUES: WHAT'S WRONG:
2978 latin1,utf-8 "latin1" will always be used
2979 utf-8,ucs-bom,latin1 BOM won't be recognized in an utf-8
2980 file
2981 cp1250,latin1 "cp1250" will always be used
2982 If 'fileencodings' is empty, 'fileencoding' is not modified.
2983 See 'fileencoding' for the possible values.
2984 Setting this option does not have an effect until the next time a file
2985 is read.
2986
2987 *'fileformat'* *'ff'*
2988'fileformat' 'ff' string (MS-DOS, MS-Windows, OS/2 default: "dos",
2989 Unix default: "unix",
2990 Macintosh default: "mac")
2991 local to buffer
2992 {not in Vi}
2993 This gives the <EOL> of the current buffer, which is used for
2994 reading/writing the buffer from/to a file:
2995 dos <CR> <NL>
2996 unix <NL>
2997 mac <CR>
2998 When "dos" is used, CTRL-Z at the end of a file is ignored.
2999 See |file-formats| and |file-read|.
3000 For the character encoding of the file see 'fileencoding'.
3001 When 'binary' is set, the value of 'fileformat' is ignored, file I/O
Bram Moolenaarbf884932013-04-05 22:26:15 +02003002 works like it was set to "unix".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003003 This option is set automatically when starting to edit a file and
3004 'fileformats' is not empty and 'binary' is off.
3005 When this option is set, after starting to edit a file, the 'modified'
3006 option is set, because the file would be different when written.
3007 This option can not be changed when 'modifiable' is off.
3008 For backwards compatibility: When this option is set to "dos",
3009 'textmode' is set, otherwise 'textmode' is reset.
3010
3011 *'fileformats'* *'ffs'*
3012'fileformats' 'ffs' string (default:
3013 Vim+Vi MS-DOS, MS-Windows OS/2: "dos,unix",
3014 Vim Unix: "unix,dos",
3015 Vim Mac: "mac,unix,dos",
3016 Vi Cygwin: "unix,dos",
3017 Vi others: "")
3018 global
3019 {not in Vi}
3020 This gives the end-of-line (<EOL>) formats that will be tried when
3021 starting to edit a new buffer and when reading a file into an existing
3022 buffer:
3023 - When empty, the format defined with 'fileformat' will be used
3024 always. It is not set automatically.
3025 - When set to one name, that format will be used whenever a new buffer
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003026 is opened. 'fileformat' is set accordingly for that buffer. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003027 'fileformats' name will be used when a file is read into an existing
3028 buffer, no matter what 'fileformat' for that buffer is set to.
3029 - When more than one name is present, separated by commas, automatic
3030 <EOL> detection will be done when reading a file. When starting to
3031 edit a file, a check is done for the <EOL>:
3032 1. If all lines end in <CR><NL>, and 'fileformats' includes "dos",
3033 'fileformat' is set to "dos".
3034 2. If a <NL> is found and 'fileformats' includes "unix", 'fileformat'
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003035 is set to "unix". Note that when a <NL> is found without a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003036 preceding <CR>, "unix" is preferred over "dos".
Bram Moolenaar2b8388b2015-02-28 13:11:45 +01003037 3. If 'fileformat' has not yet been set, and if a <CR> is found, and
3038 if 'fileformats' includes "mac", 'fileformat' is set to "mac".
Bram Moolenaar00659062010-09-21 22:34:02 +02003039 This means that "mac" is only chosen when:
3040 "unix" is not present or no <NL> is found in the file, and
3041 "dos" is not present or no <CR><NL> is found in the file.
3042 Except: if "unix" was chosen, but there is a <CR> before
3043 the first <NL>, and there appear to be more <CR>s than <NL>s in
Bram Moolenaar166af9b2010-11-16 20:34:40 +01003044 the first few lines, "mac" is used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003045 4. If 'fileformat' is still not set, the first name from
3046 'fileformats' is used.
3047 When reading a file into an existing buffer, the same is done, but
3048 this happens like 'fileformat' has been set appropriately for that
3049 file only, the option is not changed.
3050 When 'binary' is set, the value of 'fileformats' is not used.
3051
Bram Moolenaar4f3f6682016-03-26 23:01:59 +01003052 When Vim starts up with an empty buffer the first item is used. You
3053 can overrule this by setting 'fileformat' in your .vimrc.
Bram Moolenaar81af9252010-12-10 20:35:50 +01003054
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003055 For systems with a Dos-like <EOL> (<CR><NL>), when reading files that
3056 are ":source"ed and for vimrc files, automatic <EOL> detection may be
3057 done:
3058 - When 'fileformats' is empty, there is no automatic detection. Dos
3059 format will be used.
3060 - When 'fileformats' is set to one or more names, automatic detection
3061 is done. This is based on the first <NL> in the file: If there is a
3062 <CR> in front of it, Dos format is used, otherwise Unix format is
3063 used.
3064 Also see |file-formats|.
3065 For backwards compatibility: When this option is set to an empty
3066 string or one format (no comma is included), 'textauto' is reset,
3067 otherwise 'textauto' is set.
3068 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3069 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3070
Bram Moolenaarbf884932013-04-05 22:26:15 +02003071 *'fileignorecase'* *'fic'* *'nofileignorecase'* *'nofic'*
3072'fileignorecase' 'fic' boolean (default on for systems where case in file
3073 names is normally ignored)
Bram Moolenaar71afbfe2013-03-19 16:49:16 +01003074 global
3075 {not in Vi}
3076 When set case is ignored when using file names and directories.
3077 See 'wildignorecase' for only ignoring case when doing completion.
3078
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003079 *'filetype'* *'ft'*
3080'filetype' 'ft' string (default: "")
3081 local to buffer
3082 {not in Vi}
3083 {not available when compiled without the |+autocmd|
3084 feature}
3085 When this option is set, the FileType autocommand event is triggered.
3086 All autocommands that match with the value of this option will be
3087 executed. Thus the value of 'filetype' is used in place of the file
3088 name.
3089 Otherwise this option does not always reflect the current file type.
3090 This option is normally set when the file type is detected. To enable
3091 this use the ":filetype on" command. |:filetype|
3092 Setting this option to a different value is most useful in a modeline,
3093 for a file for which the file type is not automatically recognized.
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00003094 Example, for in an IDL file:
3095 /* vim: set filetype=idl : */ ~
3096 |FileType| |filetypes|
3097 When a dot appears in the value then this separates two filetype
3098 names. Example:
3099 /* vim: set filetype=c.doxygen : */ ~
3100 This will use the "c" filetype first, then the "doxygen" filetype.
3101 This works both for filetype plugins and for syntax files. More than
3102 one dot may appear.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003103 This option is not copied to another buffer, independent of the 's' or
3104 'S' flag in 'cpoptions'.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00003105 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003106
3107 *'fillchars'* *'fcs'*
3108'fillchars' 'fcs' string (default "vert:|,fold:-")
3109 global
3110 {not in Vi}
3111 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
3112 and |+folding| features}
3113 Characters to fill the statuslines and vertical separators.
3114 It is a comma separated list of items:
3115
3116 item default Used for ~
3117 stl:c ' ' or '^' statusline of the current window
Bram Moolenaar38a55632016-02-15 22:07:32 +01003118 stlnc:c ' ' or '=' statusline of the non-current windows
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003119 vert:c '|' vertical separators |:vsplit|
3120 fold:c '-' filling 'foldtext'
3121 diff:c '-' deleted lines of the 'diff' option
3122
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003123 Any one that is omitted will fall back to the default. For "stl" and
Bram Moolenaar38a55632016-02-15 22:07:32 +01003124 "stlnc" the space will be used when there is highlighting, '^' or '='
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003125 otherwise.
3126
3127 Example: >
Bram Moolenaar38a55632016-02-15 22:07:32 +01003128 :set fillchars=stl:^,stlnc:=,vert:\|,fold:-,diff:-
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003129< This is similar to the default, except that these characters will also
3130 be used when there is highlighting.
3131
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003132 for "stl" and "stlnc" only single-byte values are supported.
3133
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003134 The highlighting used for these items:
3135 item highlight group ~
3136 stl:c StatusLine |hl-StatusLine|
3137 stlnc:c StatusLineNC |hl-StatusLineNC|
3138 vert:c VertSplit |hl-VertSplit|
3139 fold:c Folded |hl-Folded|
3140 diff:c DiffDelete |hl-DiffDelete|
3141
Bram Moolenaar34d72d42015-07-17 14:18:08 +02003142 *'fixendofline'* *'fixeol'* *'nofixendofline'* *'nofixeol'*
3143'fixendofline' 'fixeol' boolean (default on)
3144 local to buffer
3145 {not in Vi}
3146 When writing a file and this option is on, <EOL> at the end of file
3147 will be restored if missing. Turn this option off if you want to
3148 preserve the situation from the original file.
3149 When the 'binary' option is set the value of this option doesn't
3150 matter.
3151 See the 'endofline' option.
3152
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003153 *'fkmap'* *'fk'* *'nofkmap'* *'nofk'*
3154'fkmap' 'fk' boolean (default off) *E198*
3155 global
3156 {not in Vi}
3157 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3158 feature}
3159 When on, the keyboard is mapped for the Farsi character set.
3160 Normally you would set 'allowrevins' and use CTRL-_ in insert mode to
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003161 toggle this option |i_CTRL-_|. See |farsi.txt|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003162
3163 *'foldclose'* *'fcl'*
3164'foldclose' 'fcl' string (default "")
3165 global
3166 {not in Vi}
3167 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3168 feature}
3169 When set to "all", a fold is closed when the cursor isn't in it and
3170 its level is higher than 'foldlevel'. Useful if you want folds to
3171 automatically close when moving out of them.
3172
3173 *'foldcolumn'* *'fdc'*
3174'foldcolumn' 'fdc' number (default 0)
3175 local to window
3176 {not in Vi}
3177 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3178 feature}
3179 When non-zero, a column with the specified width is shown at the side
3180 of the window which indicates open and closed folds. The maximum
3181 value is 12.
3182 See |folding|.
3183
3184 *'foldenable'* *'fen'* *'nofoldenable'* *'nofen'*
3185'foldenable' 'fen' boolean (default on)
3186 local to window
3187 {not in Vi}
3188 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3189 feature}
3190 When off, all folds are open. This option can be used to quickly
3191 switch between showing all text unfolded and viewing the text with
3192 folds (including manually opened or closed folds). It can be toggled
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003193 with the |zi| command. The 'foldcolumn' will remain blank when
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003194 'foldenable' is off.
3195 This option is set by commands that create a new fold or close a fold.
3196 See |folding|.
3197
3198 *'foldexpr'* *'fde'*
3199'foldexpr' 'fde' string (default: "0")
3200 local to window
3201 {not in Vi}
3202 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02003203 or |+eval| features}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003204 The expression used for when 'foldmethod' is "expr". It is evaluated
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00003205 for each line to obtain its fold level. See |fold-expr|.
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00003206
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02003207 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from a
3208 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01003209 This option can't be set from a |modeline| when the 'diff' option is
3210 on.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00003211
3212 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
3213 evaluating 'foldexpr' |textlock|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003214
3215 *'foldignore'* *'fdi'*
3216'foldignore' 'fdi' string (default: "#")
3217 local to window
3218 {not in Vi}
3219 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3220 feature}
3221 Used only when 'foldmethod' is "indent". Lines starting with
3222 characters in 'foldignore' will get their fold level from surrounding
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003223 lines. White space is skipped before checking for this character.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003224 The default "#" works well for C programs. See |fold-indent|.
3225
3226 *'foldlevel'* *'fdl'*
3227'foldlevel' 'fdl' number (default: 0)
3228 local to window
3229 {not in Vi}
3230 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3231 feature}
3232 Sets the fold level: Folds with a higher level will be closed.
3233 Setting this option to zero will close all folds. Higher numbers will
3234 close fewer folds.
3235 This option is set by commands like |zm|, |zM| and |zR|.
3236 See |fold-foldlevel|.
3237
3238 *'foldlevelstart'* *'fdls'*
3239'foldlevelstart' 'fdls' number (default: -1)
3240 global
3241 {not in Vi}
3242 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3243 feature}
3244 Sets 'foldlevel' when starting to edit another buffer in a window.
3245 Useful to always start editing with all folds closed (value zero),
3246 some folds closed (one) or no folds closed (99).
3247 This is done before reading any modeline, thus a setting in a modeline
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003248 overrules this option. Starting to edit a file for |diff-mode| also
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003249 ignores this option and closes all folds.
3250 It is also done before BufReadPre autocommands, to allow an autocmd to
3251 overrule the 'foldlevel' value for specific files.
3252 When the value is negative, it is not used.
3253
3254 *'foldmarker'* *'fmr'* *E536*
3255'foldmarker' 'fmr' string (default: "{{{,}}}")
3256 local to window
3257 {not in Vi}
3258 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3259 feature}
3260 The start and end marker used when 'foldmethod' is "marker". There
3261 must be one comma, which separates the start and end marker. The
3262 marker is a literal string (a regular expression would be too slow).
3263 See |fold-marker|.
3264
3265 *'foldmethod'* *'fdm'*
3266'foldmethod' 'fdm' string (default: "manual")
3267 local to window
3268 {not in Vi}
3269 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3270 feature}
3271 The kind of folding used for the current window. Possible values:
3272 |fold-manual| manual Folds are created manually.
3273 |fold-indent| indent Lines with equal indent form a fold.
3274 |fold-expr| expr 'foldexpr' gives the fold level of a line.
3275 |fold-marker| marker Markers are used to specify folds.
3276 |fold-syntax| syntax Syntax highlighting items specify folds.
3277 |fold-diff| diff Fold text that is not changed.
3278
3279 *'foldminlines'* *'fml'*
3280'foldminlines' 'fml' number (default: 1)
3281 local to window
3282 {not in Vi}
3283 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3284 feature}
Bram Moolenaar00654022011-02-25 14:42:19 +01003285 Sets the number of screen lines above which a fold can be displayed
3286 closed. Also for manually closed folds. With the default value of
3287 one a fold can only be closed if it takes up two or more screen lines.
3288 Set to zero to be able to close folds of just one screen line.
Bram Moolenaar446beb42011-05-10 17:18:44 +02003289 Note that this only has an effect on what is displayed. After using
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003290 "zc" to close a fold, which is displayed open because it's smaller
3291 than 'foldminlines', a following "zc" may close a containing fold.
3292
3293 *'foldnestmax'* *'fdn'*
3294'foldnestmax' 'fdn' number (default: 20)
3295 local to window
3296 {not in Vi}
3297 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3298 feature}
3299 Sets the maximum nesting of folds for the "indent" and "syntax"
3300 methods. This avoids that too many folds will be created. Using more
3301 than 20 doesn't work, because the internal limit is 20.
3302
3303 *'foldopen'* *'fdo'*
3304'foldopen' 'fdo' string (default: "block,hor,mark,percent,quickfix,
3305 search,tag,undo")
3306 global
3307 {not in Vi}
3308 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3309 feature}
3310 Specifies for which type of commands folds will be opened, if the
3311 command moves the cursor into a closed fold. It is a comma separated
3312 list of items.
Bram Moolenaar05365702010-10-27 18:34:44 +02003313 NOTE: When the command is part of a mapping this option is not used.
3314 Add the |zv| command to the mapping to get the same effect.
3315 (rationale: the mapping may want to control opening folds itself)
3316
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003317 item commands ~
3318 all any
3319 block "(", "{", "[[", "[{", etc.
3320 hor horizontal movements: "l", "w", "fx", etc.
3321 insert any command in Insert mode
3322 jump far jumps: "G", "gg", etc.
3323 mark jumping to a mark: "'m", CTRL-O, etc.
3324 percent "%"
3325 quickfix ":cn", ":crew", ":make", etc.
3326 search search for a pattern: "/", "n", "*", "gd", etc.
3327 (not for a search pattern in a ":" command)
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003328 Also for |[s| and |]s|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003329 tag jumping to a tag: ":ta", CTRL-T, etc.
3330 undo undo or redo: "u" and CTRL-R
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003331 When a movement command is used for an operator (e.g., "dl" or "y%")
3332 this option is not used. This means the operator will include the
3333 whole closed fold.
3334 Note that vertical movements are not here, because it would make it
3335 very difficult to move onto a closed fold.
3336 In insert mode the folds containing the cursor will always be open
3337 when text is inserted.
3338 To close folds you can re-apply 'foldlevel' with the |zx| command or
3339 set the 'foldclose' option to "all".
3340
3341 *'foldtext'* *'fdt'*
3342'foldtext' 'fdt' string (default: "foldtext()")
3343 local to window
3344 {not in Vi}
3345 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3346 feature}
3347 An expression which is used to specify the text displayed for a closed
3348 fold. See |fold-foldtext|.
3349
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02003350 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from a
3351 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00003352
3353 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
3354 evaluating 'foldtext' |textlock|.
3355
Bram Moolenaarc95a3022016-06-12 23:01:46 +02003356 *'formatexpr'* *'fex'*
3357'formatexpr' 'fex' string (default "")
3358 local to buffer
3359 {not in Vi}
3360 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
3361 feature}
3362 Expression which is evaluated to format a range of lines for the |gq|
3363 operator or automatic formatting (see 'formatoptions'). When this
3364 option is empty 'formatprg' is used.
3365
3366 The |v:lnum| variable holds the first line to be formatted.
3367 The |v:count| variable holds the number of lines to be formatted.
3368 The |v:char| variable holds the character that is going to be
3369 inserted if the expression is being evaluated due to
3370 automatic formatting. This can be empty. Don't insert
3371 it yet!
3372
3373 Example: >
3374 :set formatexpr=mylang#Format()
3375< This will invoke the mylang#Format() function in the
3376 autoload/mylang.vim file in 'runtimepath'. |autoload|
3377
3378 The expression is also evaluated when 'textwidth' is set and adding
3379 text beyond that limit. This happens under the same conditions as
3380 when internal formatting is used. Make sure the cursor is kept in the
3381 same spot relative to the text then! The |mode()| function will
3382 return "i" or "R" in this situation.
3383
3384 When the expression evaluates to non-zero Vim will fall back to using
3385 the internal format mechanism.
3386
3387 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
3388 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. That stops the option from working,
3389 since changing the buffer text is not allowed.
3390
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003391 *'formatoptions'* *'fo'*
3392'formatoptions' 'fo' string (Vim default: "tcq", Vi default: "vt")
3393 local to buffer
3394 {not in Vi}
3395 This is a sequence of letters which describes how automatic
3396 formatting is to be done. See |fo-table|. When the 'paste' option is
3397 on, no formatting is done (like 'formatoptions' is empty). Commas can
3398 be inserted for readability.
3399 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
3400 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
3401 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3402 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3403
Bram Moolenaar86b68352004-12-27 21:59:20 +00003404 *'formatlistpat'* *'flp'*
3405'formatlistpat' 'flp' string (default: "^\s*\d\+[\]:.)}\t ]\s*")
3406 local to buffer
3407 {not in Vi}
3408 A pattern that is used to recognize a list header. This is used for
3409 the "n" flag in 'formatoptions'.
3410 The pattern must match exactly the text that will be the indent for
Bram Moolenaar677ee682005-01-27 14:41:15 +00003411 the line below it. You can use |/\ze| to mark the end of the match
Bram Moolenaar86b68352004-12-27 21:59:20 +00003412 while still checking more characters. There must be a character
3413 following the pattern, when it matches the whole line it is handled
3414 like there is no match.
3415 The default recognizes a number, followed by an optional punctuation
3416 character and white space.
3417
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003418 *'formatprg'* *'fp'*
3419'formatprg' 'fp' string (default "")
3420 global
3421 {not in Vi}
3422 The name of an external program that will be used to format the lines
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00003423 selected with the |gq| operator. The program must take the input on
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003424 stdin and produce the output on stdout. The Unix program "fmt" is
Bram Moolenaara5792f52005-11-23 21:25:05 +00003425 such a program.
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00003426 If the 'formatexpr' option is not empty it will be used instead.
3427 Otherwise, if 'formatprg' option is an empty string, the internal
3428 format function will be used |C-indenting|.
Bram Moolenaara5792f52005-11-23 21:25:05 +00003429 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash|
3430 about including spaces and backslashes.
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02003431 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3432 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003433
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01003434 *'fsync'* *'fs'* *'nofsync'* *'nofs'*
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00003435'fsync' 'fs' boolean (default on)
3436 global
3437 {not in Vi}
3438 When on, the library function fsync() will be called after writing a
3439 file. This will flush a file to disk, ensuring that it is safely
3440 written even on filesystems which do metadata-only journaling. This
3441 will force the harddrive to spin up on Linux systems running in laptop
3442 mode, so it may be undesirable in some situations. Be warned that
3443 turning this off increases the chances of data loss after a crash. On
3444 systems without an fsync() implementation, this variable is always
3445 off.
3446 Also see 'swapsync' for controlling fsync() on swap files.
3447
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003448 *'gdefault'* *'gd'* *'nogdefault'* *'nogd'*
3449'gdefault' 'gd' boolean (default off)
3450 global
3451 {not in Vi}
3452 When on, the ":substitute" flag 'g' is default on. This means that
3453 all matches in a line are substituted instead of one. When a 'g' flag
3454 is given to a ":substitute" command, this will toggle the substitution
3455 of all or one match. See |complex-change|.
3456
3457 command 'gdefault' on 'gdefault' off ~
3458 :s/// subst. all subst. one
3459 :s///g subst. one subst. all
3460 :s///gg subst. all subst. one
3461
3462 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3463
3464 *'grepformat'* *'gfm'*
Bram Moolenaar6e932462014-09-09 18:48:09 +02003465'grepformat' 'gfm' string (default "%f:%l:%m,%f:%l%m,%f %l%m")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003466 global
3467 {not in Vi}
3468 Format to recognize for the ":grep" command output.
3469 This is a scanf-like string that uses the same format as the
3470 'errorformat' option: see |errorformat|.
3471
3472 *'grepprg'* *'gp'*
3473'grepprg' 'gp' string (default "grep -n ",
3474 Unix: "grep -n $* /dev/null",
3475 Win32: "findstr /n" or "grep -n",
3476 VMS: "SEARCH/NUMBERS ")
3477 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3478 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00003479 Program to use for the |:grep| command. This option may contain '%'
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003480 and '#' characters, which are expanded like when used in a command-
3481 line. The placeholder "$*" is allowed to specify where the arguments
3482 will be included. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See
3483 |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3484 When your "grep" accepts the "-H" argument, use this to make ":grep"
3485 also work well with a single file: >
3486 :set grepprg=grep\ -nH
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00003487< Special value: When 'grepprg' is set to "internal" the |:grep| command
Bram Moolenaara6557602006-02-04 22:43:20 +00003488 works like |:vimgrep|, |:lgrep| like |:lvimgrep|, |:grepadd| like
3489 |:vimgrepadd| and |:lgrepadd| like |:lvimgrepadd|.
Bram Moolenaar86b68352004-12-27 21:59:20 +00003490 See also the section |:make_makeprg|, since most of the comments there
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003491 apply equally to 'grepprg'.
3492 For Win32, the default is "findstr /n" if "findstr.exe" can be found,
3493 otherwise it's "grep -n".
3494 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3495 security reasons.
3496
3497 *'guicursor'* *'gcr'* *E545* *E546* *E548* *E549*
3498'guicursor' 'gcr' string (default "n-v-c:block-Cursor/lCursor,
3499 ve:ver35-Cursor,
3500 o:hor50-Cursor,
3501 i-ci:ver25-Cursor/lCursor,
3502 r-cr:hor20-Cursor/lCursor,
3503 sm:block-Cursor
3504 -blinkwait175-blinkoff150-blinkon175",
3505 for MS-DOS and Win32 console:
3506 "n-v-c:block,o:hor50,i-ci:hor15,
3507 r-cr:hor30,sm:block")
3508 global
3509 {not in Vi}
3510 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled, and
3511 for MS-DOS and Win32 console}
3512 This option tells Vim what the cursor should look like in different
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003513 modes. It fully works in the GUI. In an MSDOS or Win32 console, only
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003514 the height of the cursor can be changed. This can be done by
3515 specifying a block cursor, or a percentage for a vertical or
3516 horizontal cursor.
Bram Moolenaar1e7813a2015-03-31 18:31:03 +02003517 For a console the 't_SI', 't_SR', and 't_EI' escape sequences are
3518 used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003519
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003520 The option is a comma separated list of parts. Each part consist of a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003521 mode-list and an argument-list:
3522 mode-list:argument-list,mode-list:argument-list,..
3523 The mode-list is a dash separated list of these modes:
3524 n Normal mode
3525 v Visual mode
3526 ve Visual mode with 'selection' "exclusive" (same as 'v',
3527 if not specified)
3528 o Operator-pending mode
3529 i Insert mode
3530 r Replace mode
3531 c Command-line Normal (append) mode
3532 ci Command-line Insert mode
3533 cr Command-line Replace mode
3534 sm showmatch in Insert mode
3535 a all modes
3536 The argument-list is a dash separated list of these arguments:
3537 hor{N} horizontal bar, {N} percent of the character height
3538 ver{N} vertical bar, {N} percent of the character width
3539 block block cursor, fills the whole character
3540 [only one of the above three should be present]
3541 blinkwait{N} *cursor-blinking*
3542 blinkon{N}
3543 blinkoff{N}
3544 blink times for cursor: blinkwait is the delay before
3545 the cursor starts blinking, blinkon is the time that
3546 the cursor is shown and blinkoff is the time that the
3547 cursor is not shown. The times are in msec. When one
3548 of the numbers is zero, there is no blinking. The
3549 default is: "blinkwait700-blinkon400-blinkoff250".
3550 These numbers are used for a missing entry. This
3551 means that blinking is enabled by default. To switch
3552 blinking off you can use "blinkon0". The cursor only
3553 blinks when Vim is waiting for input, not while
3554 executing a command.
3555 To make the cursor blink in an xterm, see
3556 |xterm-blink|.
3557 {group-name}
3558 a highlight group name, that sets the color and font
3559 for the cursor
3560 {group-name}/{group-name}
3561 Two highlight group names, the first is used when
3562 no language mappings are used, the other when they
3563 are. |language-mapping|
3564
3565 Examples of parts:
3566 n-c-v:block-nCursor in Normal, Command-line and Visual mode, use a
3567 block cursor with colors from the "nCursor"
3568 highlight group
3569 i-ci:ver30-iCursor-blinkwait300-blinkon200-blinkoff150
3570 In Insert and Command-line Insert mode, use a
3571 30% vertical bar cursor with colors from the
3572 "iCursor" highlight group. Blink a bit
3573 faster.
3574
3575 The 'a' mode is different. It will set the given argument-list for
3576 all modes. It does not reset anything to defaults. This can be used
3577 to do a common setting for all modes. For example, to switch off
3578 blinking: "a:blinkon0"
3579
3580 Examples of cursor highlighting: >
3581 :highlight Cursor gui=reverse guifg=NONE guibg=NONE
3582 :highlight Cursor gui=NONE guifg=bg guibg=fg
3583<
3584 *'guifont'* *'gfn'*
Bram Moolenaar251e1912011-06-19 05:09:16 +02003585 *E235* *E596*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003586'guifont' 'gfn' string (default "")
3587 global
3588 {not in Vi}
3589 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
3590 This is a list of fonts which will be used for the GUI version of Vim.
3591 In its simplest form the value is just one font name. When
3592 the font cannot be found you will get an error message. To try other
3593 font names a list can be specified, font names separated with commas.
3594 The first valid font is used.
Bram Moolenaared203462004-06-16 11:19:22 +00003595
Bram Moolenaar05159a02005-02-26 23:04:13 +00003596 On systems where 'guifontset' is supported (X11) and 'guifontset' is
3597 not empty, then 'guifont' is not used.
Bram Moolenaared203462004-06-16 11:19:22 +00003598
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003599 Spaces after a comma are ignored. To include a comma in a font name
3600 precede it with a backslash. Setting an option requires an extra
3601 backslash before a space and a backslash. See also
3602 |option-backslash|. For example: >
3603 :set guifont=Screen15,\ 7x13,font\\,with\\,commas
Bram Moolenaared203462004-06-16 11:19:22 +00003604< will make Vim try to use the font "Screen15" first, and if it fails it
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003605 will try to use "7x13" and then "font,with,commas" instead.
Bram Moolenaared203462004-06-16 11:19:22 +00003606
3607 If none of the fonts can be loaded, Vim will keep the current setting.
3608 If an empty font list is given, Vim will try using other resource
3609 settings (for X, it will use the Vim.font resource), and finally it
3610 will try some builtin default which should always be there ("7x13" in
3611 the case of X). The font names given should be "normal" fonts. Vim
3612 will try to find the related bold and italic fonts.
3613
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01003614 For Win32, GTK, Motif, Mac OS and Photon: >
Bram Moolenaared203462004-06-16 11:19:22 +00003615 :set guifont=*
3616< will bring up a font requester, where you can pick the font you want.
3617
3618 The font name depends on the GUI used. See |setting-guifont| for a
3619 way to set 'guifont' for various systems.
3620
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003621 For the GTK+ 2 GUI the font name looks like this: >
3622 :set guifont=Andale\ Mono\ 11
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01003623< That's all. XLFDs are not used. For Chinese this is reported to work
3624 well: >
3625 if has("gui_gtk2")
3626 set guifont=Bitstream\ Vera\ Sans\ Mono\ 12,Fixed\ 12
3627 set guifontwide=Microsoft\ Yahei\ 12,WenQuanYi\ Zen\ Hei\ 12
3628 endif
3629<
Bram Moolenaar05159a02005-02-26 23:04:13 +00003630 For Mac OSX you can use something like this: >
3631 :set guifont=Monaco:h10
Bram Moolenaar06a89a52006-04-29 22:01:03 +00003632< Also see 'macatsui', it can help fix display problems.
3633 *E236*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003634 Note that the fonts must be mono-spaced (all characters have the same
Bram Moolenaared203462004-06-16 11:19:22 +00003635 width). An exception is GTK 2: all fonts are accepted, but
3636 mono-spaced fonts look best.
3637
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003638 To preview a font on X11, you might be able to use the "xfontsel"
3639 program. The "xlsfonts" program gives a list of all available fonts.
Bram Moolenaared203462004-06-16 11:19:22 +00003640
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003641 For the Win32 GUI *E244* *E245*
3642 - takes these options in the font name:
3643 hXX - height is XX (points, can be floating-point)
3644 wXX - width is XX (points, can be floating-point)
3645 b - bold
3646 i - italic
3647 u - underline
3648 s - strikeout
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00003649 cXX - character set XX. Valid charsets are: ANSI, ARABIC,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003650 BALTIC, CHINESEBIG5, DEFAULT, EASTEUROPE, GB2312, GREEK,
3651 HANGEUL, HEBREW, JOHAB, MAC, OEM, RUSSIAN, SHIFTJIS,
3652 SYMBOL, THAI, TURKISH, VIETNAMESE ANSI and BALTIC.
Bram Moolenaard4755bb2004-09-02 19:12:26 +00003653 Normally you would use "cDEFAULT".
Bram Moolenaar03413f42016-04-12 21:07:15 +02003654 qXX - quality XX. Valid quality names are: PROOF, DRAFT,
Bram Moolenaar06d2d382016-05-20 17:24:11 +02003655 ANTIALIASED, NONANTIALIASED, CLEARTYPE, DEFAULT.
Bram Moolenaar7c1c6db2016-04-03 22:08:05 +02003656 Normally you would use "qDEFAULT".
Bram Moolenaardc1f1642016-08-16 18:33:43 +02003657 Some quality values are not supported in legacy OSs.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003658
3659 Use a ':' to separate the options.
3660 - A '_' can be used in the place of a space, so you don't need to use
3661 backslashes to escape the spaces.
3662 - Examples: >
3663 :set guifont=courier_new:h12:w5:b:cRUSSIAN
3664 :set guifont=Andale_Mono:h7.5:w4.5
3665< See also |font-sizes|.
3666
3667 *'guifontset'* *'gfs'*
3668 *E250* *E252* *E234* *E597* *E598*
3669'guifontset' 'gfs' string (default "")
3670 global
3671 {not in Vi}
3672 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and
3673 with the |+xfontset| feature}
3674 {not available in the GTK+ 2 GUI}
3675 When not empty, specifies two (or more) fonts to be used. The first
3676 one for normal English, the second one for your special language. See
3677 |xfontset|.
3678 Setting this option also means that all font names will be handled as
3679 a fontset name. Also the ones used for the "font" argument of the
3680 |:highlight| command.
3681 The fonts must match with the current locale. If fonts for the
3682 character sets that the current locale uses are not included, setting
3683 'guifontset' will fail.
3684 Note the difference between 'guifont' and 'guifontset': In 'guifont'
3685 the comma-separated names are alternative names, one of which will be
3686 used. In 'guifontset' the whole string is one fontset name,
3687 including the commas. It is not possible to specify alternative
3688 fontset names.
3689 This example works on many X11 systems: >
3690 :set guifontset=-*-*-medium-r-normal--16-*-*-*-c-*-*-*
3691<
3692 *'guifontwide'* *'gfw'* *E231* *E533* *E534*
3693'guifontwide' 'gfw' string (default "")
3694 global
3695 {not in Vi}
3696 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
3697 When not empty, specifies a comma-separated list of fonts to be used
3698 for double-width characters. The first font that can be loaded is
3699 used.
3700 Note: The size of these fonts must be exactly twice as wide as the one
3701 specified with 'guifont' and the same height.
3702
3703 All GUI versions but GTK+ 2:
3704
3705 'guifontwide' is only used when 'encoding' is set to "utf-8" and
3706 'guifontset' is empty or invalid.
3707 When 'guifont' is set and a valid font is found in it and
3708 'guifontwide' is empty Vim will attempt to find a matching
3709 double-width font and set 'guifontwide' to it.
3710
3711 GTK+ 2 GUI only: *guifontwide_gtk2*
3712
3713 If set and valid, 'guifontwide' is always used for double width
3714 characters, even if 'encoding' is not set to "utf-8".
3715 Vim does not attempt to find an appropriate value for 'guifontwide'
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003716 automatically. If 'guifontwide' is empty Pango/Xft will choose the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003717 font for characters not available in 'guifont'. Thus you do not need
3718 to set 'guifontwide' at all unless you want to override the choice
3719 made by Pango/Xft.
3720
Bram Moolenaar0f272122013-01-23 18:37:40 +01003721 Windows +multibyte only: *guifontwide_win_mbyte*
3722
Bram Moolenaara3e6bc92013-01-30 14:18:00 +01003723 If set and valid, 'guifontwide' is used for IME instead of 'guifont'.
Bram Moolenaar0f272122013-01-23 18:37:40 +01003724
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003725 *'guiheadroom'* *'ghr'*
3726'guiheadroom' 'ghr' number (default 50)
3727 global
3728 {not in Vi} {only for GTK and X11 GUI}
3729 The number of pixels subtracted from the screen height when fitting
3730 the GUI window on the screen. Set this before the GUI is started,
3731 e.g., in your |gvimrc| file. When zero, the whole screen height will
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003732 be used by the window. When positive, the specified number of pixel
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003733 lines will be left for window decorations and other items on the
3734 screen. Set it to a negative value to allow windows taller than the
3735 screen.
3736
3737 *'guioptions'* *'go'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02003738'guioptions' 'go' string (default "egmrLtT" (MS-Windows, "t" is
3739 removed in |defaults.vim|),
3740 "aegimrLtT" (GTK, Motif and Athena),
3741 )
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003742 global
3743 {not in Vi}
3744 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
Bram Moolenaared203462004-06-16 11:19:22 +00003745 This option only has an effect in the GUI version of Vim. It is a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003746 sequence of letters which describes what components and options of the
3747 GUI should be used.
3748 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
3749 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
3750
3751 Valid letters are as follows:
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003752 *guioptions_a* *'go-a'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003753 'a' Autoselect: If present, then whenever VISUAL mode is started,
3754 or the Visual area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of
3755 the windowing system's global selection. This means that the
3756 Visually highlighted text is available for pasting into other
3757 applications as well as into Vim itself. When the Visual mode
3758 ends, possibly due to an operation on the text, or when an
3759 application wants to paste the selection, the highlighted text
3760 is automatically yanked into the "* selection register.
3761 Thus the selection is still available for pasting into other
3762 applications after the VISUAL mode has ended.
3763 If not present, then Vim won't become the owner of the
3764 windowing system's global selection unless explicitly told to
3765 by a yank or delete operation for the "* register.
3766 The same applies to the modeless selection.
Bram Moolenaarc0885aa2012-07-10 16:49:23 +02003767 *'go-P'*
3768 'P' Like autoselect but using the "+ register instead of the "*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01003769 register.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003770 *'go-A'*
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003771 'A' Autoselect for the modeless selection. Like 'a', but only
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003772 applies to the modeless selection.
3773
3774 'guioptions' autoselect Visual autoselect modeless ~
3775 "" - -
3776 "a" yes yes
3777 "A" - yes
3778 "aA" yes yes
3779
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003780 *'go-c'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003781 'c' Use console dialogs instead of popup dialogs for simple
3782 choices.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003783 *'go-e'*
Bram Moolenaare224ffa2006-03-01 00:01:28 +00003784 'e' Add tab pages when indicated with 'showtabline'.
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00003785 'guitablabel' can be used to change the text in the labels.
3786 When 'e' is missing a non-GUI tab pages line may be used.
Bram Moolenaard68071d2006-05-02 22:08:30 +00003787 The GUI tabs are only supported on some systems, currently
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00003788 GTK, Motif, Mac OS/X and MS-Windows.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003789 *'go-f'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003790 'f' Foreground: Don't use fork() to detach the GUI from the shell
3791 where it was started. Use this for programs that wait for the
3792 editor to finish (e.g., an e-mail program). Alternatively you
3793 can use "gvim -f" or ":gui -f" to start the GUI in the
3794 foreground. |gui-fork|
3795 Note: Set this option in the vimrc file. The forking may have
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003796 happened already when the |gvimrc| file is read.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003797 *'go-i'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003798 'i' Use a Vim icon. For GTK with KDE it is used in the left-upper
3799 corner of the window. It's black&white on non-GTK, because of
3800 limitations of X11. For a color icon, see |X11-icon|.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003801 *'go-m'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003802 'm' Menu bar is present.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003803 *'go-M'*
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003804 'M' The system menu "$VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim" is not sourced. Note
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003805 that this flag must be added in the .vimrc file, before
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003806 switching on syntax or filetype recognition (when the |gvimrc|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003807 file is sourced the system menu has already been loaded; the
3808 ":syntax on" and ":filetype on" commands load the menu too).
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003809 *'go-g'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003810 'g' Grey menu items: Make menu items that are not active grey. If
3811 'g' is not included inactive menu items are not shown at all.
3812 Exception: Athena will always use grey menu items.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003813 *'go-t'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003814 't' Include tearoff menu items. Currently only works for Win32,
3815 GTK+, and Motif 1.2 GUI.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003816 *'go-T'*
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00003817 'T' Include Toolbar. Currently only in Win32, GTK+, Motif, Photon
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00003818 and Athena GUIs.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003819 *'go-r'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003820 'r' Right-hand scrollbar is always present.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003821 *'go-R'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003822 'R' Right-hand scrollbar is present when there is a vertically
3823 split window.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003824 *'go-l'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003825 'l' Left-hand scrollbar is always present.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003826 *'go-L'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003827 'L' Left-hand scrollbar is present when there is a vertically
3828 split window.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003829 *'go-b'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003830 'b' Bottom (horizontal) scrollbar is present. Its size depends on
3831 the longest visible line, or on the cursor line if the 'h'
3832 flag is included. |gui-horiz-scroll|
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003833 *'go-h'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003834 'h' Limit horizontal scrollbar size to the length of the cursor
3835 line. Reduces computations. |gui-horiz-scroll|
3836
3837 And yes, you may even have scrollbars on the left AND the right if
3838 you really want to :-). See |gui-scrollbars| for more information.
3839
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003840 *'go-v'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003841 'v' Use a vertical button layout for dialogs. When not included,
3842 a horizontal layout is preferred, but when it doesn't fit a
3843 vertical layout is used anyway.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003844 *'go-p'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003845 'p' Use Pointer callbacks for X11 GUI. This is required for some
3846 window managers. If the cursor is not blinking or hollow at
3847 the right moment, try adding this flag. This must be done
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003848 before starting the GUI. Set it in your |gvimrc|. Adding or
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003849 removing it after the GUI has started has no effect.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003850 *'go-F'*
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003851 'F' Add a footer. Only for Motif. See |gui-footer|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003852
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003853
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003854 *'guipty'* *'noguipty'*
3855'guipty' boolean (default on)
3856 global
3857 {not in Vi}
3858 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
3859 Only in the GUI: If on, an attempt is made to open a pseudo-tty for
3860 I/O to/from shell commands. See |gui-pty|.
3861
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00003862 *'guitablabel'* *'gtl'*
3863'guitablabel' 'gtl' string (default empty)
3864 global
3865 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00003866 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02003867 with the |+windows| feature}
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00003868 When nonempty describes the text to use in a label of the GUI tab
Bram Moolenaard68071d2006-05-02 22:08:30 +00003869 pages line. When empty and when the result is empty Vim will use a
3870 default label. See |setting-guitablabel| for more info.
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00003871
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00003872 The format of this option is like that of 'statusline'.
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00003873 'guitabtooltip' is used for the tooltip, see below.
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00003874
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00003875 Only used when the GUI tab pages line is displayed. 'e' must be
3876 present in 'guioptions'. For the non-GUI tab pages line 'tabline' is
3877 used.
3878
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00003879 *'guitabtooltip'* *'gtt'*
3880'guitabtooltip' 'gtt' string (default empty)
3881 global
3882 {not in Vi}
3883 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02003884 with the |+windows| feature}
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00003885 When nonempty describes the text to use in a tooltip for the GUI tab
3886 pages line. When empty Vim will use a default tooltip.
3887 This option is otherwise just like 'guitablabel' above.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01003888 You can include a line break. Simplest method is to use |:let|: >
3889 :let &guitabtooltip = "line one\nline two"
3890<
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00003891
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003892 *'helpfile'* *'hf'*
3893'helpfile' 'hf' string (default (MSDOS) "$VIMRUNTIME\doc\help.txt"
3894 (others) "$VIMRUNTIME/doc/help.txt")
3895 global
3896 {not in Vi}
3897 Name of the main help file. All distributed help files should be
3898 placed together in one directory. Additionally, all "doc" directories
3899 in 'runtimepath' will be used.
3900 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. For example:
3901 "$VIMRUNTIME/doc/help.txt". If $VIMRUNTIME is not set, $VIM is also
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003902 tried. Also see |$VIMRUNTIME| and |option-backslash| about including
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003903 spaces and backslashes.
3904 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3905 security reasons.
3906
3907 *'helpheight'* *'hh'*
3908'helpheight' 'hh' number (default 20)
3909 global
3910 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02003911 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003912 feature}
3913 Minimal initial height of the help window when it is opened with the
3914 ":help" command. The initial height of the help window is half of the
3915 current window, or (when the 'ea' option is on) the same as other
3916 windows. When the height is less than 'helpheight', the height is
3917 set to 'helpheight'. Set to zero to disable.
3918
3919 *'helplang'* *'hlg'*
3920'helplang' 'hlg' string (default: messages language or empty)
3921 global
3922 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_lang|
3923 feature}
3924 {not in Vi}
3925 Comma separated list of languages. Vim will use the first language
3926 for which the desired help can be found. The English help will always
3927 be used as a last resort. You can add "en" to prefer English over
3928 another language, but that will only find tags that exist in that
3929 language and not in the English help.
3930 Example: >
3931 :set helplang=de,it
3932< This will first search German, then Italian and finally English help
3933 files.
3934 When using |CTRL-]| and ":help!" in a non-English help file Vim will
3935 try to find the tag in the current language before using this option.
3936 See |help-translated|.
3937
3938 *'hidden'* *'hid'* *'nohidden'* *'nohid'*
3939'hidden' 'hid' boolean (default off)
3940 global
3941 {not in Vi}
3942 When off a buffer is unloaded when it is |abandon|ed. When on a
3943 buffer becomes hidden when it is |abandon|ed. If the buffer is still
3944 displayed in another window, it does not become hidden, of course.
3945 The commands that move through the buffer list sometimes make a buffer
3946 hidden although the 'hidden' option is off: When the buffer is
3947 modified, 'autowrite' is off or writing is not possible, and the '!'
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003948 flag was used. See also |windows.txt|.
Bram Moolenaarcfbc5ee2004-07-02 15:38:35 +00003949 To only make one buffer hidden use the 'bufhidden' option.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003950 This option is set for one command with ":hide {command}" |:hide|.
3951 WARNING: It's easy to forget that you have changes in hidden buffers.
3952 Think twice when using ":q!" or ":qa!".
3953
3954 *'highlight'* *'hl'*
3955'highlight' 'hl' string (default (as a single string):
Bram Moolenaar58b85342016-08-14 19:54:54 +02003956 "8:SpecialKey,~:EndOfBuffer,@:NonText,
3957 d:Directory,e:ErrorMsg,i:IncSearch,
3958 l:Search,m:MoreMsg,M:ModeMsg,n:LineNr,
3959 N:CursorLineNr,r:Question,s:StatusLine,
3960 S:StatusLineNC,c:VertSplit,t:Title,
3961 v:Visual,w:WarningMsg,W:WildMenu,f:Folded,
3962 F:FoldColumn,A:DiffAdd,C:DiffChange,
3963 D:DiffDelete,T:DiffText,>:SignColumn,
3964 B:SpellBad,P:SpellCap,R:SpellRare,
3965 L:SpellLocal,-:Conceal,+:Pmenu,=:PmenuSel,
Bram Moolenaar1c7715d2005-10-03 22:02:18 +00003966 x:PmenuSbar,X:PmenuThumb")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003967 global
3968 {not in Vi}
3969 This option can be used to set highlighting mode for various
3970 occasions. It is a comma separated list of character pairs. The
3971 first character in a pair gives the occasion, the second the mode to
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003972 use for that occasion. The occasions are:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003973 |hl-SpecialKey| 8 Meta and special keys listed with ":map"
Bram Moolenaar58b85342016-08-14 19:54:54 +02003974 |hl-EndOfBuffer| ~ lines after the last line in the buffer
3975 |hl-NonText| @ '@' at the end of the window and
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003976 characters from 'showbreak'
3977 |hl-Directory| d directories in CTRL-D listing and other special
3978 things in listings
3979 |hl-ErrorMsg| e error messages
3980 h (obsolete, ignored)
3981 |hl-IncSearch| i 'incsearch' highlighting
3982 |hl-Search| l last search pattern highlighting (see 'hlsearch')
3983 |hl-MoreMsg| m |more-prompt|
3984 |hl-ModeMsg| M Mode (e.g., "-- INSERT --")
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02003985 |hl-LineNr| n line number for ":number" and ":#" commands, and
3986 when 'number' or 'relativenumber' option is set.
Bram Moolenaara3e6bc92013-01-30 14:18:00 +01003987 |hl-CursorLineNr| N like n for when 'cursorline' or 'relativenumber' is
3988 set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003989 |hl-Question| r |hit-enter| prompt and yes/no questions
3990 |hl-StatusLine| s status line of current window |status-line|
3991 |hl-StatusLineNC| S status lines of not-current windows
3992 |hl-Title| t Titles for output from ":set all", ":autocmd" etc.
3993 |hl-VertSplit| c column used to separate vertically split windows
3994 |hl-Visual| v Visual mode
3995 |hl-VisualNOS| V Visual mode when Vim does is "Not Owning the
3996 Selection" Only X11 Gui's |gui-x11| and
3997 |xterm-clipboard|.
3998 |hl-WarningMsg| w warning messages
3999 |hl-WildMenu| W wildcard matches displayed for 'wildmenu'
4000 |hl-Folded| f line used for closed folds
4001 |hl-FoldColumn| F 'foldcolumn'
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00004002 |hl-DiffAdd| A added line in diff mode
4003 |hl-DiffChange| C changed line in diff mode
4004 |hl-DiffDelete| D deleted line in diff mode
4005 |hl-DiffText| T inserted text in diff mode
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004006 |hl-SignColumn| > column used for |signs|
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00004007 |hl-SpellBad| B misspelled word |spell|
Bram Moolenaar9855d6b2010-07-18 14:34:51 +02004008 |hl-SpellCap| P word that should start with capital |spell|
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00004009 |hl-SpellRare| R rare word |spell|
4010 |hl-SpellLocal| L word from other region |spell|
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02004011 |hl-Conceal| - the placeholders used for concealed characters
4012 (see 'conceallevel')
Bram Moolenaar1c7715d2005-10-03 22:02:18 +00004013 |hl-Pmenu| + popup menu normal line
4014 |hl-PmenuSel| = popup menu normal line
4015 |hl-PmenuSbar| x popup menu scrollbar
4016 |hl-PmenuThumb| X popup menu scrollbar thumb
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004017
4018 The display modes are:
4019 r reverse (termcap entry "mr" and "me")
4020 i italic (termcap entry "ZH" and "ZR")
4021 b bold (termcap entry "md" and "me")
4022 s standout (termcap entry "so" and "se")
4023 u underline (termcap entry "us" and "ue")
Bram Moolenaare2cc9702005-03-15 22:43:58 +00004024 c undercurl (termcap entry "Cs" and "Ce")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004025 n no highlighting
4026 - no highlighting
4027 : use a highlight group
4028 The default is used for occasions that are not included.
4029 If you want to change what the display modes do, see |dos-colors|
4030 for an example.
4031 When using the ':' display mode, this must be followed by the name of
4032 a highlight group. A highlight group can be used to define any type
4033 of highlighting, including using color. See |:highlight| on how to
4034 define one. The default uses a different group for each occasion.
4035 See |highlight-default| for the default highlight groups.
4036
4037 *'hlsearch'* *'hls'* *'nohlsearch'* *'nohls'*
4038'hlsearch' 'hls' boolean (default off)
4039 global
4040 {not in Vi}
4041 {not available when compiled without the
4042 |+extra_search| feature}
4043 When there is a previous search pattern, highlight all its matches.
4044 The type of highlighting used can be set with the 'l' occasion in the
4045 'highlight' option. This uses the "Search" highlight group by
4046 default. Note that only the matching text is highlighted, any offsets
4047 are not applied.
4048 See also: 'incsearch' and |:match|.
4049 When you get bored looking at the highlighted matches, you can turn it
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01004050 off with |:nohlsearch|. This does not change the option value, as
4051 soon as you use a search command, the highlighting comes back.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00004052 'redrawtime' specifies the maximum time spent on finding matches.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004053 When the search pattern can match an end-of-line, Vim will try to
4054 highlight all of the matched text. However, this depends on where the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004055 search starts. This will be the first line in the window or the first
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004056 line below a closed fold. A match in a previous line which is not
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00004057 drawn may not continue in a newly drawn line.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01004058 You can specify whether the highlight status is restored on startup
4059 with the 'h' flag in 'viminfo' |viminfo-h|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004060 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
4061
4062 *'history'* *'hi'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02004063'history' 'hi' number (Vim default: 50, Vi default: 0,
4064 set to 200 in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004065 global
4066 {not in Vi}
4067 A history of ":" commands, and a history of previous search patterns
Bram Moolenaar78159bb2014-06-25 11:48:54 +02004068 is remembered. This option decides how many entries may be stored in
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004069 each of these histories (see |cmdline-editing|).
Bram Moolenaar78159bb2014-06-25 11:48:54 +02004070 The maximum value is 10000.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004071 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
4072 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
4073
4074 *'hkmap'* *'hk'* *'nohkmap'* *'nohk'*
4075'hkmap' 'hk' boolean (default off)
4076 global
4077 {not in Vi}
4078 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
4079 feature}
4080 When on, the keyboard is mapped for the Hebrew character set.
4081 Normally you would set 'allowrevins' and use CTRL-_ in insert mode to
4082 toggle this option. See |rileft.txt|.
4083 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
4084
4085 *'hkmapp'* *'hkp'* *'nohkmapp'* *'nohkp'*
4086'hkmapp' 'hkp' boolean (default off)
4087 global
4088 {not in Vi}
4089 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
4090 feature}
4091 When on, phonetic keyboard mapping is used. 'hkmap' must also be on.
4092 This is useful if you have a non-Hebrew keyboard.
4093 See |rileft.txt|.
4094 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
4095
4096 *'icon'* *'noicon'*
4097'icon' boolean (default off, on when title can be restored)
4098 global
4099 {not in Vi}
4100 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
4101 feature}
4102 When on, the icon text of the window will be set to the value of
4103 'iconstring' (if it is not empty), or to the name of the file
4104 currently being edited. Only the last part of the name is used.
4105 Overridden by the 'iconstring' option.
4106 Only works if the terminal supports setting window icons (currently
4107 only X11 GUI and terminals with a non-empty 't_IS' option - these are
4108 Unix xterm and iris-ansi by default, where 't_IS' is taken from the
4109 builtin termcap).
4110 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original icon will be
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00004111 restored if possible |X11|. See |X11-icon| for changing the icon on
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004112 X11.
Bram Moolenaar3a991dd2014-10-02 01:41:41 +02004113 For MS-Windows the icon can be changed, see |windows-icon|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004114
4115 *'iconstring'*
4116'iconstring' string (default "")
4117 global
4118 {not in Vi}
4119 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
4120 feature}
4121 When this option is not empty, it will be used for the icon text of
4122 the window. This happens only when the 'icon' option is on.
4123 Only works if the terminal supports setting window icon text
4124 (currently only X11 GUI and terminals with a non-empty 't_IS' option).
4125 Does not work for MS Windows.
4126 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original icon will be
4127 restored if possible |X11|.
4128 When this option contains printf-style '%' items, they will be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004129 expanded according to the rules used for 'statusline'. See
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004130 'titlestring' for example settings.
4131 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| feature}
4132
4133 *'ignorecase'* *'ic'* *'noignorecase'* *'noic'*
4134'ignorecase' 'ic' boolean (default off)
4135 global
4136 Ignore case in search patterns. Also used when searching in the tags
4137 file.
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01004138 Also see 'smartcase' and 'tagcase'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004139 Can be overruled by using "\c" or "\C" in the pattern, see
4140 |/ignorecase|.
4141
Bram Moolenaarabab85a2013-06-26 19:18:05 +02004142 *'imactivatefunc'* *'imaf'*
4143'imactivatefunc' 'imaf' string (default "")
4144 global
4145 {not in Vi}
4146 {only available when compiled with |+xim| and
4147 |+GUI_GTK|}
4148 This option specifies a function that will be called to
4149 activate/inactivate Input Method.
4150
4151 Example: >
4152 function ImActivateFunc(active)
4153 if a:active
4154 ... do something
4155 else
4156 ... do something
4157 endif
4158 " return value is not used
4159 endfunction
4160 set imactivatefunc=ImActivateFunc
4161<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004162 *'imactivatekey'* *'imak'*
4163'imactivatekey' 'imak' string (default "")
4164 global
4165 {not in Vi}
4166 {only available when compiled with |+xim| and
Bram Moolenaar67c53842010-05-22 18:28:27 +02004167 |+GUI_GTK|} *E599*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004168 Specifies the key that your Input Method in X-Windows uses for
4169 activation. When this is specified correctly, vim can fully control
4170 IM with 'imcmdline', 'iminsert' and 'imsearch'.
4171 You can't use this option to change the activation key, the option
4172 tells Vim what the key is.
4173 Format:
4174 [MODIFIER_FLAG-]KEY_STRING
4175
4176 These characters can be used for MODIFIER_FLAG (case is ignored):
4177 S Shift key
4178 L Lock key
4179 C Control key
4180 1 Mod1 key
4181 2 Mod2 key
4182 3 Mod3 key
4183 4 Mod4 key
4184 5 Mod5 key
4185 Combinations are allowed, for example "S-C-space" or "SC-space" are
4186 both shift+ctrl+space.
4187 See <X11/keysymdef.h> and XStringToKeysym for KEY_STRING.
4188
4189 Example: >
4190 :set imactivatekey=S-space
4191< "S-space" means shift+space. This is the activation key for kinput2 +
4192 canna (Japanese), and ami (Korean).
4193
4194 *'imcmdline'* *'imc'* *'noimcmdline'* *'noimc'*
4195'imcmdline' 'imc' boolean (default off)
4196 global
4197 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02004198 {only available when compiled with the |+xim|,
4199 |+multi_byte_ime| or |global-ime| features}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004200 When set the Input Method is always on when starting to edit a command
4201 line, unless entering a search pattern (see 'imsearch' for that).
4202 Setting this option is useful when your input method allows entering
4203 English characters directly, e.g., when it's used to type accented
4204 characters with dead keys.
4205
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01004206 *'imdisable'* *'imd'* *'noimdisable'* *'noimd'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004207'imdisable' 'imd' boolean (default off, on for some systems (SGI))
4208 global
4209 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02004210 {only available when compiled with the |+xim|,
4211 |+multi_byte_ime| or |global-ime| features}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004212 When set the Input Method is never used. This is useful to disable
4213 the IM when it doesn't work properly.
4214 Currently this option is on by default for SGI/IRIX machines. This
4215 may change in later releases.
4216
4217 *'iminsert'* *'imi'*
4218'iminsert' 'imi' number (default 0, 2 when an input method is supported)
4219 local to buffer
4220 {not in Vi}
4221 Specifies whether :lmap or an Input Method (IM) is to be used in
4222 Insert mode. Valid values:
4223 0 :lmap is off and IM is off
4224 1 :lmap is ON and IM is off
4225 2 :lmap is off and IM is ON
4226 2 is available only when compiled with the |+multi_byte_ime|, |+xim|
4227 or |global-ime|.
4228 To always reset the option to zero when leaving Insert mode with <Esc>
4229 this can be used: >
4230 :inoremap <ESC> <ESC>:set iminsert=0<CR>
4231< This makes :lmap and IM turn off automatically when leaving Insert
4232 mode.
4233 Note that this option changes when using CTRL-^ in Insert mode
4234 |i_CTRL-^|.
4235 The value is set to 1 when setting 'keymap' to a valid keymap name.
4236 It is also used for the argument of commands like "r" and "f".
4237 The value 0 may not work correctly with Athena and Motif with some XIM
4238 methods. Use 'imdisable' to disable XIM then.
4239
4240 *'imsearch'* *'ims'*
4241'imsearch' 'ims' number (default 0, 2 when an input method is supported)
4242 local to buffer
4243 {not in Vi}
4244 Specifies whether :lmap or an Input Method (IM) is to be used when
4245 entering a search pattern. Valid values:
4246 -1 the value of 'iminsert' is used, makes it look like
4247 'iminsert' is also used when typing a search pattern
4248 0 :lmap is off and IM is off
4249 1 :lmap is ON and IM is off
4250 2 :lmap is off and IM is ON
4251 Note that this option changes when using CTRL-^ in Command-line mode
4252 |c_CTRL-^|.
4253 The value is set to 1 when it is not -1 and setting the 'keymap'
4254 option to a valid keymap name.
4255 The value 0 may not work correctly with Athena and Motif with some XIM
4256 methods. Use 'imdisable' to disable XIM then.
4257
Bram Moolenaarabab85a2013-06-26 19:18:05 +02004258 *'imstatusfunc'* *'imsf'*
4259'imstatusfunc' 'imsf' string (default "")
4260 global
4261 {not in Vi}
4262 {only available when compiled with |+xim| and
4263 |+GUI_GTK|}
4264 This option specifies a function that is called to obtain the status
4265 of Input Method. It must return a positive number when IME is active.
4266
4267 Example: >
4268 function ImStatusFunc()
4269 let is_active = ...do something
4270 return is_active ? 1 : 0
4271 endfunction
4272 set imstatusfunc=ImStatusFunc
4273<
4274 NOTE: This function is invoked very often. Keep it fast.
4275
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004276 *'include'* *'inc'*
4277'include' 'inc' string (default "^\s*#\s*include")
4278 global or local to buffer |global-local|
4279 {not in Vi}
4280 {not available when compiled without the
4281 |+find_in_path| feature}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004282 Pattern to be used to find an include command. It is a search
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004283 pattern, just like for the "/" command (See |pattern|). The default
4284 value is for C programs. This option is used for the commands "[i",
Bram Moolenaar1e015462005-09-25 22:16:38 +00004285 "]I", "[d", etc.
4286 Normally the 'isfname' option is used to recognize the file name that
Bram Moolenaar482aaeb2005-09-29 18:26:07 +00004287 comes after the matched pattern. But if "\zs" appears in the pattern
4288 then the text matched from "\zs" to the end, or until "\ze" if it
4289 appears, is used as the file name. Use this to include characters
4290 that are not in 'isfname', such as a space. You can then use
4291 'includeexpr' to process the matched text.
Bram Moolenaar1e015462005-09-25 22:16:38 +00004292 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004293
4294 *'includeexpr'* *'inex'*
4295'includeexpr' 'inex' string (default "")
4296 local to buffer
4297 {not in Vi}
4298 {not available when compiled without the
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02004299 |+find_in_path| or |+eval| features}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004300 Expression to be used to transform the string found with the 'include'
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004301 option to a file name. Mostly useful to change "." to "/" for Java: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004302 :set includeexpr=substitute(v:fname,'\\.','/','g')
4303< The "v:fname" variable will be set to the file name that was detected.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00004304
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004305 Also used for the |gf| command if an unmodified file name can't be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004306 found. Allows doing "gf" on the name after an 'include' statement.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004307 Also used for |<cfile>|.
4308
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02004309 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
4310 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00004311
4312 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
4313 evaluating 'includeexpr' |textlock|.
4314
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004315 *'incsearch'* *'is'* *'noincsearch'* *'nois'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02004316'incsearch' 'is' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim| if the
4317 +reltime feature is supported)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004318 global
4319 {not in Vi}
4320 {not available when compiled without the
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02004321 |+extra_search| features}
Bram Moolenaar21cf8232004-07-16 20:18:37 +00004322 While typing a search command, show where the pattern, as it was typed
4323 so far, matches. The matched string is highlighted. If the pattern
4324 is invalid or not found, nothing is shown. The screen will be updated
4325 often, this is only useful on fast terminals.
4326 Note that the match will be shown, but the cursor will return to its
4327 original position when no match is found and when pressing <Esc>. You
4328 still need to finish the search command with <Enter> to move the
4329 cursor to the match.
Bram Moolenaardc083282016-10-11 08:57:33 +02004330 You can use the CTRL-G and CTRL-T keys to move to the next and
4331 previous match. |c_CTRL-G| |c_CTRL-T|
Bram Moolenaar91a4e822008-01-19 14:59:58 +00004332 When compiled with the |+reltime| feature Vim only searches for about
4333 half a second. With a complicated pattern and/or a lot of text the
4334 match may not be found. This is to avoid that Vim hangs while you
4335 are typing the pattern.
Bram Moolenaar21cf8232004-07-16 20:18:37 +00004336 The highlighting can be set with the 'i' flag in 'highlight'.
4337 See also: 'hlsearch'.
Bram Moolenaarefd2bf12006-03-16 21:41:35 +00004338 CTRL-L can be used to add one character from after the current match
Bram Moolenaara9dc3752010-07-11 20:46:53 +02004339 to the command line. If 'ignorecase' and 'smartcase' are set and the
4340 command line has no uppercase characters, the added character is
4341 converted to lowercase.
Bram Moolenaarefd2bf12006-03-16 21:41:35 +00004342 CTRL-R CTRL-W can be used to add the word at the end of the current
4343 match, excluding the characters that were already typed.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004344 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
4345
4346 *'indentexpr'* *'inde'*
4347'indentexpr' 'inde' string (default "")
4348 local to buffer
4349 {not in Vi}
4350 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
4351 or |+eval| features}
4352 Expression which is evaluated to obtain the proper indent for a line.
4353 It is used when a new line is created, for the |=| operator and
4354 in Insert mode as specified with the 'indentkeys' option.
4355 When this option is not empty, it overrules the 'cindent' and
Bram Moolenaar20f90cf2011-05-19 12:22:51 +02004356 'smartindent' indenting. When 'lisp' is set, this option is
4357 overridden by the Lisp indentation algorithm.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004358 When 'paste' is set this option is not used for indenting.
4359 The expression is evaluated with |v:lnum| set to the line number for
Bram Moolenaar482aaeb2005-09-29 18:26:07 +00004360 which the indent is to be computed. The cursor is also in this line
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004361 when the expression is evaluated (but it may be moved around).
4362 The expression must return the number of spaces worth of indent. It
4363 can return "-1" to keep the current indent (this means 'autoindent' is
4364 used for the indent).
4365 Functions useful for computing the indent are |indent()|, |cindent()|
4366 and |lispindent()|.
4367 The evaluation of the expression must not have side effects! It must
4368 not change the text, jump to another window, etc. Afterwards the
4369 cursor position is always restored, thus the cursor may be moved.
4370 Normally this option would be set to call a function: >
4371 :set indentexpr=GetMyIndent()
4372< Error messages will be suppressed, unless the 'debug' option contains
4373 "msg".
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00004374 See |indent-expression|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004375 NOTE: This option is made empty when 'compatible' is set.
4376
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02004377 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
4378 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00004379
4380 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
4381 evaluating 'indentexpr' |textlock|.
4382
4383
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004384 *'indentkeys'* *'indk'*
4385'indentkeys' 'indk' string (default "0{,0},:,0#,!^F,o,O,e")
4386 local to buffer
4387 {not in Vi}
4388 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
4389 feature}
4390 A list of keys that, when typed in Insert mode, cause reindenting of
4391 the current line. Only happens if 'indentexpr' isn't empty.
4392 The format is identical to 'cinkeys', see |indentkeys-format|.
4393 See |C-indenting| and |indent-expression|.
4394
4395 *'infercase'* *'inf'* *'noinfercase'* *'noinf'*
4396'infercase' 'inf' boolean (default off)
4397 local to buffer
4398 {not in Vi}
4399 When doing keyword completion in insert mode |ins-completion|, and
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00004400 'ignorecase' is also on, the case of the match is adjusted depending
4401 on the typed text. If the typed text contains a lowercase letter
4402 where the match has an upper case letter, the completed part is made
4403 lowercase. If the typed text has no lowercase letters and the match
4404 has a lowercase letter where the typed text has an uppercase letter,
4405 and there is a letter before it, the completed part is made uppercase.
4406 With 'noinfercase' the match is used as-is.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004407
4408 *'insertmode'* *'im'* *'noinsertmode'* *'noim'*
4409'insertmode' 'im' boolean (default off)
4410 global
4411 {not in Vi}
4412 Makes Vim work in a way that Insert mode is the default mode. Useful
4413 if you want to use Vim as a modeless editor. Used for |evim|.
4414 These Insert mode commands will be useful:
4415 - Use the cursor keys to move around.
Bram Moolenaardc1f1642016-08-16 18:33:43 +02004416 - Use CTRL-O to execute one Normal mode command |i_CTRL-O|. When
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004417 this is a mapping, it is executed as if 'insertmode' was off.
4418 Normal mode remains active until the mapping is finished.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004419 - Use CTRL-L to execute a number of Normal mode commands, then use
Bram Moolenaar488c6512005-08-11 20:09:58 +00004420 <Esc> to get back to Insert mode. Note that CTRL-L moves the cursor
4421 left, like <Esc> does when 'insertmode' isn't set. |i_CTRL-L|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004422
4423 These items change when 'insertmode' is set:
4424 - when starting to edit of a file, Vim goes to Insert mode.
4425 - <Esc> in Insert mode is a no-op and beeps.
4426 - <Esc> in Normal mode makes Vim go to Insert mode.
4427 - CTRL-L in Insert mode is a command, it is not inserted.
4428 - CTRL-Z in Insert mode suspends Vim, see |CTRL-Z|. *i_CTRL-Z*
4429 However, when <Esc> is used inside a mapping, it behaves like
4430 'insertmode' was not set. This was done to be able to use the same
4431 mappings with 'insertmode' set or not set.
4432 When executing commands with |:normal| 'insertmode' is not used.
4433
4434 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
4435
4436 *'isfname'* *'isf'*
4437'isfname' 'isf' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2:
4438 "@,48-57,/,\,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,{,},[,],:,@-@,!,~,="
4439 for AMIGA: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,$,:"
4440 for VMS: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,<,>,[,],:,;,~"
4441 for OS/390: "@,240-249,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,~,="
4442 otherwise: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,~,=")
4443 global
4444 {not in Vi}
4445 The characters specified by this option are included in file names and
4446 path names. Filenames are used for commands like "gf", "[i" and in
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004447 the tags file. It is also used for "\f" in a |pattern|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004448 Multi-byte characters 256 and above are always included, only the
4449 characters up to 255 are specified with this option.
4450 For UTF-8 the characters 0xa0 to 0xff are included as well.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00004451 Think twice before adding white space to this option. Although a
4452 space may appear inside a file name, the effect will be that Vim
4453 doesn't know where a file name starts or ends when doing completion.
4454 It most likely works better without a space in 'isfname'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004455
4456 Note that on systems using a backslash as path separator, Vim tries to
4457 do its best to make it work as you would expect. That is a bit
4458 tricky, since Vi originally used the backslash to escape special
4459 characters. Vim will not remove a backslash in front of a normal file
4460 name character on these systems, but it will on Unix and alikes. The
4461 '&' and '^' are not included by default, because these are special for
4462 cmd.exe.
4463
4464 The format of this option is a list of parts, separated with commas.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004465 Each part can be a single character number or a range. A range is two
4466 character numbers with '-' in between. A character number can be a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004467 decimal number between 0 and 255 or the ASCII character itself (does
4468 not work for digits). Example:
4469 "_,-,128-140,#-43" (include '_' and '-' and the range
4470 128 to 140 and '#' to 43)
4471 If a part starts with '^', the following character number or range
4472 will be excluded from the option. The option is interpreted from left
4473 to right. Put the excluded character after the range where it is
4474 included. To include '^' itself use it as the last character of the
4475 option or the end of a range. Example:
4476 "^a-z,#,^" (exclude 'a' to 'z', include '#' and '^')
4477 If the character is '@', all characters where isalpha() returns TRUE
4478 are included. Normally these are the characters a to z and A to Z,
4479 plus accented characters. To include '@' itself use "@-@". Examples:
4480 "@,^a-z" All alphabetic characters, excluding lower
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00004481 case ASCII letters.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004482 "a-z,A-Z,@-@" All letters plus the '@' character.
4483 A comma can be included by using it where a character number is
4484 expected. Example:
4485 "48-57,,,_" Digits, comma and underscore.
4486 A comma can be excluded by prepending a '^'. Example:
4487 " -~,^,,9" All characters from space to '~', excluding
4488 comma, plus <Tab>.
4489 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
4490
4491 *'isident'* *'isi'*
4492'isident' 'isi' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2:
4493 "@,48-57,_,128-167,224-235"
4494 otherwise: "@,48-57,_,192-255")
4495 global
4496 {not in Vi}
4497 The characters given by this option are included in identifiers.
4498 Identifiers are used in recognizing environment variables and after a
4499 match of the 'define' option. It is also used for "\i" in a
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00004500 |pattern|. See 'isfname' for a description of the format of this
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004501 option.
4502 Careful: If you change this option, it might break expanding
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004503 environment variables. E.g., when '/' is included and Vim tries to
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004504 expand "$HOME/.viminfo". Maybe you should change 'iskeyword' instead.
4505
4506 *'iskeyword'* *'isk'*
4507'iskeyword' 'isk' string (Vim default for MS-DOS and Win32:
4508 "@,48-57,_,128-167,224-235"
4509 otherwise: "@,48-57,_,192-255"
4510 Vi default: "@,48-57,_")
4511 local to buffer
4512 {not in Vi}
4513 Keywords are used in searching and recognizing with many commands:
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004514 "w", "*", "[i", etc. It is also used for "\k" in a |pattern|. See
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004515 'isfname' for a description of the format of this option. For C
4516 programs you could use "a-z,A-Z,48-57,_,.,-,>".
4517 For a help file it is set to all non-blank printable characters except
4518 '*', '"' and '|' (so that CTRL-] on a command finds the help for that
4519 command).
4520 When the 'lisp' option is on the '-' character is always included.
Bram Moolenaarb8060fe2016-01-19 22:29:28 +01004521 This option also influences syntax highlighting, unless the syntax
4522 uses |:syn-iskeyword|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004523 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
4524 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
4525
4526 *'isprint'* *'isp'*
4527'isprint' 'isp' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32, OS/2 and Macintosh:
4528 "@,~-255"; otherwise: "@,161-255")
4529 global
4530 {not in Vi}
4531 The characters given by this option are displayed directly on the
4532 screen. It is also used for "\p" in a |pattern|. The characters from
4533 space (ASCII 32) to '~' (ASCII 126) are always displayed directly,
4534 even when they are not included in 'isprint' or excluded. See
4535 'isfname' for a description of the format of this option.
4536
4537 Non-printable characters are displayed with two characters:
4538 0 - 31 "^@" - "^_"
4539 32 - 126 always single characters
4540 127 "^?"
4541 128 - 159 "~@" - "~_"
4542 160 - 254 "| " - "|~"
4543 255 "~?"
4544 When 'encoding' is a Unicode one, illegal bytes from 128 to 255 are
4545 displayed as <xx>, with the hexadecimal value of the byte.
4546 When 'display' contains "uhex" all unprintable characters are
4547 displayed as <xx>.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01004548 The SpecialKey highlighting will be used for unprintable characters.
4549 |hl-SpecialKey|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004550
4551 Multi-byte characters 256 and above are always included, only the
4552 characters up to 255 are specified with this option. When a character
4553 is printable but it is not available in the current font, a
4554 replacement character will be shown.
4555 Unprintable and zero-width Unicode characters are displayed as <xxxx>.
4556 There is no option to specify these characters.
4557
4558 *'joinspaces'* *'js'* *'nojoinspaces'* *'nojs'*
4559'joinspaces' 'js' boolean (default on)
4560 global
4561 {not in Vi}
4562 Insert two spaces after a '.', '?' and '!' with a join command.
4563 When 'cpoptions' includes the 'j' flag, only do this after a '.'.
4564 Otherwise only one space is inserted.
4565 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set.
4566
4567 *'key'*
4568'key' string (default "")
4569 local to buffer
4570 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar996343d2010-07-04 22:20:21 +02004571 {only available when compiled with the |+cryptv|
4572 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004573 The key that is used for encrypting and decrypting the current buffer.
Bram Moolenaar40e6a712010-05-16 22:32:54 +02004574 See |encryption| and 'cryptmethod'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004575 Careful: Do not set the key value by hand, someone might see the typed
4576 key. Use the |:X| command. But you can make 'key' empty: >
4577 :set key=
4578< It is not possible to get the value of this option with ":set key" or
4579 "echo &key". This is to avoid showing it to someone who shouldn't
4580 know. It also means you cannot see it yourself once you have set it,
4581 be careful not to make a typing error!
Bram Moolenaard58e9292011-02-09 17:07:58 +01004582 You can use "&key" in an expression to detect whether encryption is
4583 enabled. When 'key' is set it returns "*****" (five stars).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004584
4585 *'keymap'* *'kmp'* *E544*
4586'keymap' 'kmp' string (default "")
4587 local to buffer
4588 {not in Vi}
4589 {only available when compiled with the |+keymap|
4590 feature}
4591 Name of a keyboard mapping. See |mbyte-keymap|.
4592 Setting this option to a valid keymap name has the side effect of
4593 setting 'iminsert' to one, so that the keymap becomes effective.
4594 'imsearch' is also set to one, unless it was -1
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00004595 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004596
4597 *'keymodel'* *'km'*
4598'keymodel' 'km' string (default "")
4599 global
4600 {not in Vi}
4601 List of comma separated words, which enable special things that keys
4602 can do. These values can be used:
4603 startsel Using a shifted special key starts selection (either
4604 Select mode or Visual mode, depending on "key" being
4605 present in 'selectmode').
4606 stopsel Using a not-shifted special key stops selection.
4607 Special keys in this context are the cursor keys, <End>, <Home>,
4608 <PageUp> and <PageDown>.
4609 The 'keymodel' option is set by the |:behave| command.
4610
4611 *'keywordprg'* *'kp'*
4612'keywordprg' 'kp' string (default "man" or "man -s", DOS: ":help",
Bram Moolenaar2ff8b642016-05-24 10:46:45 +02004613 VMS: "help")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004614 global or local to buffer |global-local|
4615 {not in Vi}
4616 Program to use for the |K| command. Environment variables are
4617 expanded |:set_env|. ":help" may be used to access the Vim internal
4618 help. (Note that previously setting the global option to the empty
4619 value did this, which is now deprecated.)
Bram Moolenaar2ff8b642016-05-24 10:46:45 +02004620 When the first character is ":", the command is invoked as a Vim
4621 Ex command prefixed with [count].
4622 When "man", "man -s" or an Ex command is used, Vim will automatically
4623 translate a count for the "K" command and pass it as the first
4624 argument. For "man -s" the "-s" is removed when there is no count.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004625 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
4626 Example: >
4627 :set keywordprg=man\ -s
4628< This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
4629 security reasons.
4630
4631 *'langmap'* *'lmap'* *E357* *E358*
4632'langmap' 'lmap' string (default "")
4633 global
4634 {not in Vi}
4635 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap|
4636 feature}
4637 This option allows switching your keyboard into a special language
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004638 mode. When you are typing text in Insert mode the characters are
Bram Moolenaarfa735342016-01-03 22:14:44 +01004639 inserted directly. When in Normal mode the 'langmap' option takes
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004640 care of translating these special characters to the original meaning
4641 of the key. This means you don't have to change the keyboard mode to
4642 be able to execute Normal mode commands.
4643 This is the opposite of the 'keymap' option, where characters are
4644 mapped in Insert mode.
Bram Moolenaare4a3bcf2016-08-26 19:52:37 +02004645 Also consider resetting 'langremap' to avoid 'langmap' applies to
Bram Moolenaarc2299672014-11-13 14:25:38 +01004646 characters resulting from a mapping.
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02004647 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
4648 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004649
Bram Moolenaarfd2ac762006-03-01 22:09:21 +00004650 Example (for Greek, in UTF-8): *greek* >
4651 :set langmap=ΑA,ΒB,ΨC,ΔD,ΕE,ΦF,ΓG,ΗH,ΙI,ΞJ,ΚK,ΛL,ΜM,ΝN,ΟO,ΠP,QQ,ΡR,ΣS,ΤT,ΘU,ΩV,WW,ΧX,ΥY,ΖZ,αa,βb,ψc,δd,εe,φf,γg,ηh,ιi,ξj,κk,λl,μm,νn,οo,πp,qq,ρr,σs,τt,θu,ωv,ςw,χx,υy,ζz
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004652< Example (exchanges meaning of z and y for commands): >
4653 :set langmap=zy,yz,ZY,YZ
4654<
4655 The 'langmap' option is a list of parts, separated with commas. Each
4656 part can be in one of two forms:
4657 1. A list of pairs. Each pair is a "from" character immediately
4658 followed by the "to" character. Examples: "aA", "aAbBcC".
4659 2. A list of "from" characters, a semi-colon and a list of "to"
4660 characters. Example: "abc;ABC"
4661 Example: "aA,fgh;FGH,cCdDeE"
4662 Special characters need to be preceded with a backslash. These are
4663 ";", ',' and backslash itself.
4664
4665 This will allow you to activate vim actions without having to switch
4666 back and forth between the languages. Your language characters will
4667 be understood as normal vim English characters (according to the
4668 langmap mappings) in the following cases:
4669 o Normal/Visual mode (commands, buffer/register names, user mappings)
4670 o Insert/Replace Mode: Register names after CTRL-R
4671 o Insert/Replace Mode: Mappings
4672 Characters entered in Command-line mode will NOT be affected by
4673 this option. Note that this option can be changed at any time
4674 allowing to switch between mappings for different languages/encodings.
4675 Use a mapping to avoid having to type it each time!
4676
4677 *'langmenu'* *'lm'*
4678'langmenu' 'lm' string (default "")
4679 global
4680 {not in Vi}
4681 {only available when compiled with the |+menu| and
4682 |+multi_lang| features}
4683 Language to use for menu translation. Tells which file is loaded
4684 from the "lang" directory in 'runtimepath': >
4685 "lang/menu_" . &langmenu . ".vim"
4686< (without the spaces). For example, to always use the Dutch menus, no
4687 matter what $LANG is set to: >
4688 :set langmenu=nl_NL.ISO_8859-1
4689< When 'langmenu' is empty, |v:lang| is used.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00004690 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004691 If your $LANG is set to a non-English language but you do want to use
4692 the English menus: >
4693 :set langmenu=none
4694< This option must be set before loading menus, switching on filetype
4695 detection or syntax highlighting. Once the menus are defined setting
4696 this option has no effect. But you could do this: >
4697 :source $VIMRUNTIME/delmenu.vim
4698 :set langmenu=de_DE.ISO_8859-1
4699 :source $VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim
4700< Warning: This deletes all menus that you defined yourself!
4701
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01004702 *'langnoremap'* *'lnr'* *'nolangnoremap'* *'nolnr'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02004703'langnoremap' 'lnr' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar4391cf92014-11-05 17:44:52 +01004704 global
4705 {not in Vi}
4706 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap|
4707 feature}
Bram Moolenaare4a3bcf2016-08-26 19:52:37 +02004708 This is just like 'langremap' but with the value inverted. It only
4709 exists for backwards compatibility. When setting 'langremap' then
4710 'langnoremap' is set to the inverted value, and the other way around.
4711
4712 *'langremap'* *'lrm'* *'nolangremap'* *'nolrm'*
4713'langremap' 'lrm' boolean (default on, reset in |defaults.vim|)
4714 global
4715 {not in Vi}
4716 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap|
4717 feature}
4718 When off, setting 'langmap' does not apply to characters resulting from
Bram Moolenaar4391cf92014-11-05 17:44:52 +01004719 a mapping. This basically means, if you noticed that setting
Bram Moolenaare4a3bcf2016-08-26 19:52:37 +02004720 'langmap' disables some of your mappings, try resetting this option.
4721 This option defaults to on for backwards compatibility. Set it off if
Bram Moolenaar4391cf92014-11-05 17:44:52 +01004722 that works for you to avoid mappings to break.
4723
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004724 *'laststatus'* *'ls'*
4725'laststatus' 'ls' number (default 1)
4726 global
4727 {not in Vi}
4728 The value of this option influences when the last window will have a
4729 status line:
4730 0: never
4731 1: only if there are at least two windows
4732 2: always
4733 The screen looks nicer with a status line if you have several
4734 windows, but it takes another screen line. |status-line|
4735
4736 *'lazyredraw'* *'lz'* *'nolazyredraw'* *'nolz'*
4737'lazyredraw' 'lz' boolean (default off)
4738 global
4739 {not in Vi}
4740 When this option is set, the screen will not be redrawn while
4741 executing macros, registers and other commands that have not been
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004742 typed. Also, updating the window title is postponed. To force an
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004743 update use |:redraw|.
4744
4745 *'linebreak'* *'lbr'* *'nolinebreak'* *'nolbr'*
4746'linebreak' 'lbr' boolean (default off)
4747 local to window
4748 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02004749 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004750 feature}
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02004751 If on, Vim will wrap long lines at a character in 'breakat' rather
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004752 than at the last character that fits on the screen. Unlike
4753 'wrapmargin' and 'textwidth', this does not insert <EOL>s in the file,
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02004754 it only affects the way the file is displayed, not its contents.
4755 If 'breakindent' is set, line is visually indented. Then, the value
4756 of 'showbreak' is used to put in front of wrapped lines. This option
Bram Moolenaar86b17e92014-07-02 20:00:47 +02004757 is not used when the 'wrap' option is off.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004758 Note that <Tab> characters after an <EOL> are mostly not displayed
4759 with the right amount of white space.
4760
4761 *'lines'* *E593*
4762'lines' number (default 24 or terminal height)
4763 global
4764 Number of lines of the Vim window.
4765 Normally you don't need to set this. It is done automatically by the
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00004766 terminal initialization code. Also see |posix-screen-size|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004767 When Vim is running in the GUI or in a resizable window, setting this
4768 option will cause the window size to be changed. When you only want
4769 to use the size for the GUI, put the command in your |gvimrc| file.
4770 Vim limits the number of lines to what fits on the screen. You can
4771 use this command to get the tallest window possible: >
4772 :set lines=999
Bram Moolenaarf4d11452005-12-02 00:46:37 +00004773< Minimum value is 2, maximum value is 1000.
Bram Moolenaardc1f1642016-08-16 18:33:43 +02004774 If you get fewer lines than expected, check the 'guiheadroom' option.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004775 When you set this option and Vim is unable to change the physical
4776 number of lines of the display, the display may be messed up.
4777
4778 *'linespace'* *'lsp'*
4779'linespace' 'lsp' number (default 0, 1 for Win32 GUI)
4780 global
4781 {not in Vi}
4782 {only in the GUI}
4783 Number of pixel lines inserted between characters. Useful if the font
4784 uses the full character cell height, making lines touch each other.
4785 When non-zero there is room for underlining.
Bram Moolenaarbc7aa852005-03-06 23:38:09 +00004786 With some fonts there can be too much room between lines (to have
4787 space for ascents and descents). Then it makes sense to set
4788 'linespace' to a negative value. This may cause display problems
4789 though!
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004790
4791 *'lisp'* *'nolisp'*
4792'lisp' boolean (default off)
4793 local to buffer
4794 {not available when compiled without the |+lispindent|
4795 feature}
4796 Lisp mode: When <Enter> is typed in insert mode set the indent for
4797 the next line to Lisp standards (well, sort of). Also happens with
4798 "cc" or "S". 'autoindent' must also be on for this to work. The 'p'
4799 flag in 'cpoptions' changes the method of indenting: Vi compatible or
4800 better. Also see 'lispwords'.
4801 The '-' character is included in keyword characters. Redefines the
4802 "=" operator to use this same indentation algorithm rather than
4803 calling an external program if 'equalprg' is empty.
4804 This option is not used when 'paste' is set.
4805 {Vi: Does it a little bit differently}
4806
4807 *'lispwords'* *'lw'*
4808'lispwords' 'lw' string (default is very long)
Bram Moolenaaraf6c1312014-03-12 18:55:58 +01004809 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004810 {not in Vi}
4811 {not available when compiled without the |+lispindent|
4812 feature}
4813 Comma separated list of words that influence the Lisp indenting.
4814 |'lisp'|
4815
4816 *'list'* *'nolist'*
4817'list' boolean (default off)
4818 local to window
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01004819 List mode: Show tabs as CTRL-I is displayed, display $ after end of
4820 line. Useful to see the difference between tabs and spaces and for
4821 trailing blanks. Further changed by the 'listchars' option.
4822
4823 The cursor is displayed at the start of the space a Tab character
4824 occupies, not at the end as usual in Normal mode. To get this cursor
4825 position while displaying Tabs with spaces, use: >
Bram Moolenaardd007ed2013-07-09 15:44:17 +02004826 :set list lcs=tab:\ \
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01004827<
4828 Note that list mode will also affect formatting (set with 'textwidth'
4829 or 'wrapmargin') when 'cpoptions' includes 'L'. See 'listchars' for
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004830 changing the way tabs are displayed.
4831
4832 *'listchars'* *'lcs'*
4833'listchars' 'lcs' string (default "eol:$")
4834 global
4835 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarf9d5ca12010-08-01 16:13:51 +02004836 Strings to use in 'list' mode and for the |:list| command. It is a
4837 comma separated list of string settings.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02004838 *lcs-eol*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004839 eol:c Character to show at the end of each line. When
4840 omitted, there is no extra character at the end of the
4841 line.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02004842 *lcs-tab*
Bram Moolenaarebcbd022007-05-12 14:28:25 +00004843 tab:xy Two characters to be used to show a tab. The first
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004844 char is used once. The second char is repeated to
Bram Moolenaarebcbd022007-05-12 14:28:25 +00004845 fill the space that the tab normally occupies.
4846 "tab:>-" will show a tab that takes four spaces as
4847 ">---". When omitted, a tab is show as ^I.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02004848 *lcs-space*
4849 space:c Character to show for a space. When omitted, spaces
4850 are left blank.
4851 *lcs-trail*
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004852 trail:c Character to show for trailing spaces. When omitted,
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02004853 trailing spaces are blank. Overrides the "space"
4854 setting for trailing spaces.
4855 *lcs-extends*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004856 extends:c Character to show in the last column, when 'wrap' is
4857 off and the line continues beyond the right of the
4858 screen.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02004859 *lcs-precedes*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004860 precedes:c Character to show in the first column, when 'wrap'
4861 is off and there is text preceding the character
4862 visible in the first column.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02004863 *lcs-conceal*
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02004864 conceal:c Character to show in place of concealed text, when
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02004865 'conceallevel' is set to 1.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02004866 *lcs-nbsp*
Bram Moolenaar73284b92015-05-04 17:28:22 +02004867 nbsp:c Character to show for a non-breakable space character
4868 (0xA0 (160 decimal) and U+202F). Left blank when
4869 omitted.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004870
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004871 The characters ':' and ',' should not be used. UTF-8 characters can
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004872 be used when 'encoding' is "utf-8", otherwise only printable
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00004873 characters are allowed. All characters must be single width.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004874
4875 Examples: >
4876 :set lcs=tab:>-,trail:-
Bram Moolenaarcfbc5ee2004-07-02 15:38:35 +00004877 :set lcs=tab:>-,eol:<,nbsp:%
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004878 :set lcs=extends:>,precedes:<
4879< The "NonText" highlighting will be used for "eol", "extends" and
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02004880 "precedes". "SpecialKey" for "nbsp", "space", "tab" and "trail".
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00004881 |hl-NonText| |hl-SpecialKey|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004882
4883 *'lpl'* *'nolpl'* *'loadplugins'* *'noloadplugins'*
4884'loadplugins' 'lpl' boolean (default on)
4885 global
4886 {not in Vi}
4887 When on the plugin scripts are loaded when starting up |load-plugins|.
4888 This option can be reset in your |vimrc| file to disable the loading
4889 of plugins.
4890 Note that using the "-u NONE" and "--noplugin" command line arguments
4891 reset this option. |-u| |--noplugin|
4892
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01004893 *'luadll'*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01004894'luadll' string (default depends on the build)
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01004895 global
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01004896 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01004897 {only available when compiled with the |+lua/dyn|
4898 feature}
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01004899 Specifies the name of the Lua shared library. The default is
4900 DYNAMIC_LUA_DLL, which was specified at compile time.
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02004901 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01004902 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
4903 security reasons.
4904
Bram Moolenaarf9393ef2006-04-24 19:47:27 +00004905 *'macatsui'* *'nomacatsui'*
4906'macatsui' boolean (default on)
4907 global
4908 {only available in Mac GUI version}
4909 This is a workaround for when drawing doesn't work properly. When set
4910 and compiled with multi-byte support ATSUI text drawing is used. When
4911 not set ATSUI text drawing is not used. Switch this option off when
4912 you experience drawing problems. In a future version the problems may
4913 be solved and this option becomes obsolete. Therefore use this method
4914 to unset it: >
4915 if exists('&macatsui')
4916 set nomacatsui
4917 endif
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00004918< Another option to check if you have drawing problems is
4919 'termencoding'.
4920
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004921 *'magic'* *'nomagic'*
4922'magic' boolean (default on)
4923 global
4924 Changes the special characters that can be used in search patterns.
4925 See |pattern|.
Bram Moolenaar64d8e252016-09-06 22:12:34 +02004926 WARNING: Switching this option off most likely breaks plugins! That
4927 is because many patterns assume it's on and will fail when it's off.
4928 Only switch it off when working with old Vi scripts. In any other
4929 situation write patterns that work when 'magic' is on. Include "\M"
4930 when you want to |/\M|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004931
4932 *'makeef'* *'mef'*
4933'makeef' 'mef' string (default: "")
4934 global
4935 {not in Vi}
4936 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
4937 feature}
4938 Name of the errorfile for the |:make| command (see |:make_makeprg|)
4939 and the |:grep| command.
4940 When it is empty, an internally generated temp file will be used.
4941 When "##" is included, it is replaced by a number to make the name
4942 unique. This makes sure that the ":make" command doesn't overwrite an
4943 existing file.
4944 NOT used for the ":cf" command. See 'errorfile' for that.
4945 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
4946 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
4947 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
4948 security reasons.
4949
4950 *'makeprg'* *'mp'*
4951'makeprg' 'mp' string (default "make", VMS: "MMS")
4952 global or local to buffer |global-local|
4953 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00004954 Program to use for the ":make" command. See |:make_makeprg|.
Bram Moolenaar26df0922014-02-23 23:39:13 +01004955 This option may contain '%' and '#' characters (see |:_%| and |:_#|),
4956 which are expanded to the current and alternate file name. Use |::S|
4957 to escape file names in case they contain special characters.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00004958 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash|
4959 about including spaces and backslashes.
4960 Note that a '|' must be escaped twice: once for ":set" and once for
4961 the interpretation of a command. When you use a filter called
4962 "myfilter" do it like this: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004963 :set makeprg=gmake\ \\\|\ myfilter
4964< The placeholder "$*" can be given (even multiple times) to specify
4965 where the arguments will be included, for example: >
4966 :set makeprg=latex\ \\\\nonstopmode\ \\\\input\\{$*}
4967< This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
4968 security reasons.
4969
4970 *'matchpairs'* *'mps'*
4971'matchpairs' 'mps' string (default "(:),{:},[:]")
4972 local to buffer
4973 {not in Vi}
4974 Characters that form pairs. The |%| command jumps from one to the
Bram Moolenaara3e6bc92013-01-30 14:18:00 +01004975 other.
4976 Only character pairs are allowed that are different, thus you cannot
4977 jump between two double quotes.
4978 The characters must be separated by a colon.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00004979 The pairs must be separated by a comma. Example for including '<' and
4980 '>' (HTML): >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004981 :set mps+=<:>
4982
4983< A more exotic example, to jump between the '=' and ';' in an
4984 assignment, useful for languages like C and Java: >
4985 :au FileType c,cpp,java set mps+==:;
4986
4987< For a more advanced way of using "%", see the matchit.vim plugin in
4988 the $VIMRUNTIME/macros directory. |add-local-help|
4989
4990 *'matchtime'* *'mat'*
4991'matchtime' 'mat' number (default 5)
4992 global
4993 {not in Vi}{in Nvi}
4994 Tenths of a second to show the matching paren, when 'showmatch' is
4995 set. Note that this is not in milliseconds, like other options that
4996 set a time. This is to be compatible with Nvi.
4997
Bram Moolenaar362e1a32006-03-06 23:29:24 +00004998 *'maxcombine'* *'mco'*
4999'maxcombine' 'mco' number (default 2)
5000 global
5001 {not in Vi}
5002 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
5003 feature}
5004 The maximum number of combining characters supported for displaying.
5005 Only used when 'encoding' is "utf-8".
5006 The default is OK for most languages. Hebrew may require 4.
5007 Maximum value is 6.
5008 Even when this option is set to 2 you can still edit text with more
5009 combining characters, you just can't see them. Use |g8| or |ga|.
5010 See |mbyte-combining|.
5011
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005012 *'maxfuncdepth'* *'mfd'*
5013'maxfuncdepth' 'mfd' number (default 100)
5014 global
5015 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02005016 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005017 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005018 Maximum depth of function calls for user functions. This normally
5019 catches endless recursion. When using a recursive function with
5020 more depth, set 'maxfuncdepth' to a bigger number. But this will use
5021 more memory, there is the danger of failing when memory is exhausted.
5022 See also |:function|.
5023
5024 *'maxmapdepth'* *'mmd'* *E223*
5025'maxmapdepth' 'mmd' number (default 1000)
5026 global
5027 {not in Vi}
5028 Maximum number of times a mapping is done without resulting in a
5029 character to be used. This normally catches endless mappings, like
5030 ":map x y" with ":map y x". It still does not catch ":map g wg",
5031 because the 'w' is used before the next mapping is done. See also
5032 |key-mapping|.
5033
5034 *'maxmem'* *'mm'*
5035'maxmem' 'mm' number (default between 256 to 5120 (system
5036 dependent) or half the amount of memory
5037 available)
5038 global
5039 {not in Vi}
5040 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for one buffer. When this
5041 limit is reached allocating extra memory for a buffer will cause
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01005042 other memory to be freed. The maximum usable value is about 2000000.
5043 Use this to work without a limit. Also see 'maxmemtot'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005044
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00005045 *'maxmempattern'* *'mmp'*
5046'maxmempattern' 'mmp' number (default 1000)
5047 global
5048 {not in Vi}
5049 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for pattern matching.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01005050 The maximum value is about 2000000. Use this to work without a limit.
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00005051 *E363*
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005052 When Vim runs into the limit it gives an error message and mostly
5053 behaves like CTRL-C was typed.
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00005054 Running into the limit often means that the pattern is very
5055 inefficient or too complex. This may already happen with the pattern
5056 "\(.\)*" on a very long line. ".*" works much better.
5057 Vim may run out of memory before hitting the 'maxmempattern' limit.
5058
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005059 *'maxmemtot'* *'mmt'*
5060'maxmemtot' 'mmt' number (default between 2048 and 10240 (system
5061 dependent) or half the amount of memory
5062 available)
5063 global
5064 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01005065 Maximum amount of memory in Kbyte to use for all buffers together.
5066 The maximum usable value is about 2000000 (2 Gbyte). Use this to work
Bram Moolenaarfa735342016-01-03 22:14:44 +01005067 without a limit.
5068 On 64 bit machines higher values might work. But hey, do you really
5069 need more than 2 Gbyte for text editing? Keep in mind that text is
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02005070 stored in the swap file, one can edit files > 2 Gbyte anyway. We do
Bram Moolenaarfa735342016-01-03 22:14:44 +01005071 need the memory to store undo info.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01005072 Also see 'maxmem'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005073
5074 *'menuitems'* *'mis'*
5075'menuitems' 'mis' number (default 25)
5076 global
5077 {not in Vi}
5078 {not available when compiled without the |+menu|
5079 feature}
5080 Maximum number of items to use in a menu. Used for menus that are
5081 generated from a list of items, e.g., the Buffers menu. Changing this
5082 option has no direct effect, the menu must be refreshed first.
5083
Bram Moolenaar8aff23a2005-08-19 20:40:30 +00005084 *'mkspellmem'* *'msm'*
5085'mkspellmem' 'msm' string (default "460000,2000,500")
5086 global
5087 {not in Vi}
5088 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
5089 feature}
5090 Parameters for |:mkspell|. This tunes when to start compressing the
5091 word tree. Compression can be slow when there are many words, but
5092 it's needed to avoid running out of memory. The amount of memory used
5093 per word depends very much on how similar the words are, that's why
5094 this tuning is complicated.
5095
5096 There are three numbers, separated by commas:
5097 {start},{inc},{added}
5098
5099 For most languages the uncompressed word tree fits in memory. {start}
5100 gives the amount of memory in Kbyte that can be used before any
5101 compression is done. It should be a bit smaller than the amount of
5102 memory that is available to Vim.
5103
5104 When going over the {start} limit the {inc} number specifies the
5105 amount of memory in Kbyte that can be allocated before another
5106 compression is done. A low number means compression is done after
5107 less words are added, which is slow. A high number means more memory
5108 will be allocated.
5109
5110 After doing compression, {added} times 1024 words can be added before
5111 the {inc} limit is ignored and compression is done when any extra
5112 amount of memory is needed. A low number means there is a smaller
5113 chance of hitting the {inc} limit, less memory is used but it's
5114 slower.
5115
5116 The languages for which these numbers are important are Italian and
5117 Hungarian. The default works for when you have about 512 Mbyte. If
5118 you have 1 Gbyte you could use: >
5119 :set mkspellmem=900000,3000,800
5120< If you have less than 512 Mbyte |:mkspell| may fail for some
5121 languages, no matter what you set 'mkspellmem' to.
5122
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005123 *'modeline'* *'ml'* *'nomodeline'* *'noml'*
Bram Moolenaar8243a792007-05-01 17:05:03 +00005124'modeline' 'ml' boolean (Vim default: on (off for root),
5125 Vi default: off)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005126 local to buffer
5127 *'modelines'* *'mls'*
5128'modelines' 'mls' number (default 5)
5129 global
5130 {not in Vi}
5131 If 'modeline' is on 'modelines' gives the number of lines that is
5132 checked for set commands. If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is zero
5133 no lines are checked. See |modeline|.
5134 NOTE: 'modeline' is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
5135 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
5136
5137 *'modifiable'* *'ma'* *'nomodifiable'* *'noma'*
5138'modifiable' 'ma' boolean (default on)
5139 local to buffer
5140 {not in Vi} *E21*
5141 When off the buffer contents cannot be changed. The 'fileformat' and
5142 'fileencoding' options also can't be changed.
5143 Can be reset with the |-M| command line argument.
5144
5145 *'modified'* *'mod'* *'nomodified'* *'nomod'*
5146'modified' 'mod' boolean (default off)
5147 local to buffer
5148 {not in Vi}
5149 When on, the buffer is considered to be modified. This option is set
5150 when:
5151 1. A change was made to the text since it was last written. Using the
5152 |undo| command to go back to the original text will reset the
5153 option. But undoing changes that were made before writing the
5154 buffer will set the option again, since the text is different from
5155 when it was written.
5156 2. 'fileformat' or 'fileencoding' is different from its original
5157 value. The original value is set when the buffer is read or
5158 written. A ":set nomodified" command also resets the original
5159 values to the current values and the 'modified' option will be
5160 reset.
Bram Moolenaar4f3f6682016-03-26 23:01:59 +01005161 Similarly for 'eol' and 'bomb'.
Bram Moolenaar5302d9e2011-09-14 17:55:08 +02005162 This option is not set when a change is made to the buffer as the
5163 result of a BufNewFile, BufRead/BufReadPost, BufWritePost,
5164 FileAppendPost or VimLeave autocommand event. See |gzip-example| for
5165 an explanation.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005166 When 'buftype' is "nowrite" or "nofile" this option may be set, but
5167 will be ignored.
5168
5169 *'more'* *'nomore'*
5170'more' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
5171 global
5172 {not in Vi}
5173 When on, listings pause when the whole screen is filled. You will get
5174 the |more-prompt|. When this option is off there are no pauses, the
5175 listing continues until finished.
5176 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
5177 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
5178
5179 *'mouse'* *E538*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02005180'mouse' string (default "", "a" for GUI, MS-DOS and Win32,
5181 set to "a" in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005182 global
5183 {not in Vi}
5184 Enable the use of the mouse. Only works for certain terminals
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00005185 (xterm, MS-DOS, Win32 |win32-mouse|, QNX pterm, *BSD console with
5186 sysmouse and Linux console with gpm). For using the mouse in the
5187 GUI, see |gui-mouse|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005188 The mouse can be enabled for different modes:
5189 n Normal mode
5190 v Visual mode
5191 i Insert mode
5192 c Command-line mode
5193 h all previous modes when editing a help file
5194 a all previous modes
5195 r for |hit-enter| and |more-prompt| prompt
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005196 Normally you would enable the mouse in all four modes with: >
5197 :set mouse=a
5198< When the mouse is not enabled, the GUI will still use the mouse for
5199 modeless selection. This doesn't move the text cursor.
5200
5201 See |mouse-using|. Also see |'clipboard'|.
5202
5203 Note: When enabling the mouse in a terminal, copy/paste will use the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005204 "* register if there is access to an X-server. The xterm handling of
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005205 the mouse buttons can still be used by keeping the shift key pressed.
5206 Also see the 'clipboard' option.
5207
5208 *'mousefocus'* *'mousef'* *'nomousefocus'* *'nomousef'*
5209'mousefocus' 'mousef' boolean (default off)
5210 global
5211 {not in Vi}
5212 {only works in the GUI}
5213 The window that the mouse pointer is on is automatically activated.
5214 When changing the window layout or window focus in another way, the
5215 mouse pointer is moved to the window with keyboard focus. Off is the
5216 default because it makes using the pull down menus a little goofy, as
5217 a pointer transit may activate a window unintentionally.
5218
5219 *'mousehide'* *'mh'* *'nomousehide'* *'nomh'*
5220'mousehide' 'mh' boolean (default on)
5221 global
5222 {not in Vi}
5223 {only works in the GUI}
5224 When on, the mouse pointer is hidden when characters are typed.
5225 The mouse pointer is restored when the mouse is moved.
5226
5227 *'mousemodel'* *'mousem'*
5228'mousemodel' 'mousem' string (default "extend", "popup" for MS-DOS and Win32)
5229 global
5230 {not in Vi}
5231 Sets the model to use for the mouse. The name mostly specifies what
5232 the right mouse button is used for:
5233 extend Right mouse button extends a selection. This works
5234 like in an xterm.
5235 popup Right mouse button pops up a menu. The shifted left
5236 mouse button extends a selection. This works like
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00005237 with Microsoft Windows.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005238 popup_setpos Like "popup", but the cursor will be moved to the
5239 position where the mouse was clicked, and thus the
5240 selected operation will act upon the clicked object.
5241 If clicking inside a selection, that selection will
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00005242 be acted upon, i.e. no cursor move. This implies of
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005243 course, that right clicking outside a selection will
5244 end Visual mode.
5245 Overview of what button does what for each model:
5246 mouse extend popup(_setpos) ~
5247 left click place cursor place cursor
5248 left drag start selection start selection
5249 shift-left search word extend selection
5250 right click extend selection popup menu (place cursor)
5251 right drag extend selection -
5252 middle click paste paste
5253
5254 In the "popup" model the right mouse button produces a pop-up menu.
5255 You need to define this first, see |popup-menu|.
5256
5257 Note that you can further refine the meaning of buttons with mappings.
5258 See |gui-mouse-mapping|. But mappings are NOT used for modeless
5259 selection (because that's handled in the GUI code directly).
5260
5261 The 'mousemodel' option is set by the |:behave| command.
5262
5263 *'mouseshape'* *'mouses'* *E547*
5264'mouseshape' 'mouses' string (default "i:beam,r:beam,s:updown,sd:cross,
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00005265 m:no,ml:up-arrow,v:rightup-arrow")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005266 global
5267 {not in Vi}
5268 {only available when compiled with the |+mouseshape|
5269 feature}
5270 This option tells Vim what the mouse pointer should look like in
5271 different modes. The option is a comma separated list of parts, much
5272 like used for 'guicursor'. Each part consist of a mode/location-list
5273 and an argument-list:
5274 mode-list:shape,mode-list:shape,..
5275 The mode-list is a dash separated list of these modes/locations:
5276 In a normal window: ~
5277 n Normal mode
5278 v Visual mode
5279 ve Visual mode with 'selection' "exclusive" (same as 'v',
5280 if not specified)
5281 o Operator-pending mode
5282 i Insert mode
5283 r Replace mode
5284
5285 Others: ~
5286 c appending to the command-line
5287 ci inserting in the command-line
5288 cr replacing in the command-line
5289 m at the 'Hit ENTER' or 'More' prompts
5290 ml idem, but cursor in the last line
5291 e any mode, pointer below last window
5292 s any mode, pointer on a status line
5293 sd any mode, while dragging a status line
5294 vs any mode, pointer on a vertical separator line
5295 vd any mode, while dragging a vertical separator line
5296 a everywhere
5297
5298 The shape is one of the following:
5299 avail name looks like ~
5300 w x arrow Normal mouse pointer
5301 w x blank no pointer at all (use with care!)
5302 w x beam I-beam
5303 w x updown up-down sizing arrows
5304 w x leftright left-right sizing arrows
5305 w x busy The system's usual busy pointer
5306 w x no The system's usual 'no input' pointer
5307 x udsizing indicates up-down resizing
5308 x lrsizing indicates left-right resizing
5309 x crosshair like a big thin +
5310 x hand1 black hand
5311 x hand2 white hand
5312 x pencil what you write with
5313 x question big ?
5314 x rightup-arrow arrow pointing right-up
5315 w x up-arrow arrow pointing up
5316 x <number> any X11 pointer number (see X11/cursorfont.h)
5317
5318 The "avail" column contains a 'w' if the shape is available for Win32,
5319 x for X11.
5320 Any modes not specified or shapes not available use the normal mouse
5321 pointer.
5322
5323 Example: >
5324 :set mouseshape=s:udsizing,m:no
5325< will make the mouse turn to a sizing arrow over the status lines and
5326 indicate no input when the hit-enter prompt is displayed (since
5327 clicking the mouse has no effect in this state.)
5328
5329 *'mousetime'* *'mouset'*
5330'mousetime' 'mouset' number (default 500)
5331 global
5332 {not in Vi}
5333 Only for GUI, MS-DOS, Win32 and Unix with xterm. Defines the maximum
5334 time in msec between two mouse clicks for the second click to be
5335 recognized as a multi click.
5336
Bram Moolenaar325b7a22004-07-05 15:58:32 +00005337 *'mzquantum'* *'mzq'*
5338'mzquantum' 'mzq' number (default 100)
5339 global
5340 {not in Vi}
5341 {not available when compiled without the |+mzscheme|
5342 feature}
5343 The number of milliseconds between polls for MzScheme threads.
5344 Negative or zero value means no thread scheduling.
5345
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005346 *'nrformats'* *'nf'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02005347'nrformats' 'nf' string (default "bin,octal,hex",
5348 set to "bin,hex" in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005349 local to buffer
5350 {not in Vi}
5351 This defines what bases Vim will consider for numbers when using the
5352 CTRL-A and CTRL-X commands for adding to and subtracting from a number
5353 respectively; see |CTRL-A| for more info on these commands.
Bram Moolenaar4770d092006-01-12 23:22:24 +00005354 alpha If included, single alphabetical characters will be
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005355 incremented or decremented. This is useful for a list with a
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01005356 letter index a), b), etc. *octal-nrformats*
Bram Moolenaar4770d092006-01-12 23:22:24 +00005357 octal If included, numbers that start with a zero will be considered
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005358 to be octal. Example: Using CTRL-A on "007" results in "010".
Bram Moolenaar4770d092006-01-12 23:22:24 +00005359 hex If included, numbers starting with "0x" or "0X" will be
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005360 considered to be hexadecimal. Example: Using CTRL-X on
5361 "0x100" results in "0x0ff".
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01005362 bin If included, numbers starting with "0b" or "0B" will be
5363 considered to be binary. Example: Using CTRL-X on
5364 "0b1000" subtracts one, resulting in "0b0111".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005365 Numbers which simply begin with a digit in the range 1-9 are always
5366 considered decimal. This also happens for numbers that are not
5367 recognized as octal or hex.
5368
5369 *'number'* *'nu'* *'nonumber'* *'nonu'*
5370'number' 'nu' boolean (default off)
5371 local to window
5372 Print the line number in front of each line. When the 'n' option is
5373 excluded from 'cpoptions' a wrapped line will not use the column of
5374 line numbers (this is the default when 'compatible' isn't set).
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00005375 The 'numberwidth' option can be used to set the room used for the line
5376 number.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005377 When a long, wrapped line doesn't start with the first character, '-'
5378 characters are put before the number.
Bram Moolenaar61d35bd2012-03-28 20:51:51 +02005379 See |hl-LineNr| and |hl-CursorLineNr| for the highlighting used for
5380 the number.
Bram Moolenaar203d04d2013-06-06 21:36:40 +02005381 *number_relativenumber*
5382 The 'relativenumber' option changes the displayed number to be
5383 relative to the cursor. Together with 'number' there are these
5384 four combinations (cursor in line 3):
5385
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01005386 'nonu' 'nu' 'nonu' 'nu'
Bram Moolenaar203d04d2013-06-06 21:36:40 +02005387 'nornu' 'nornu' 'rnu' 'rnu'
5388
5389 |apple | 1 apple | 2 apple | 2 apple
5390 |pear | 2 pear | 1 pear | 1 pear
5391 |nobody | 3 nobody | 0 nobody |3 nobody
5392 |there | 4 there | 1 there | 1 there
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005393
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00005394 *'numberwidth'* *'nuw'*
5395'numberwidth' 'nuw' number (Vim default: 4 Vi default: 8)
5396 local to window
Bram Moolenaar325b7a22004-07-05 15:58:32 +00005397 {not in Vi}
5398 {only available when compiled with the |+linebreak|
5399 feature}
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00005400 Minimal number of columns to use for the line number. Only relevant
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02005401 when the 'number' or 'relativenumber' option is set or printing lines
5402 with a line number. Since one space is always between the number and
5403 the text, there is one less character for the number itself.
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00005404 The value is the minimum width. A bigger width is used when needed to
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02005405 fit the highest line number in the buffer respectively the number of
5406 rows in the window, depending on whether 'number' or 'relativenumber'
5407 is set. Thus with the Vim default of 4 there is room for a line number
5408 up to 999. When the buffer has 1000 lines five columns will be used.
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00005409 The minimum value is 1, the maximum value is 10.
5410 NOTE: 'numberwidth' is reset to 8 when 'compatible' is set.
5411
Bram Moolenaarf75a9632005-09-13 21:20:47 +00005412 *'omnifunc'* *'ofu'*
5413'omnifunc' 'ofu' string (default: empty)
Bram Moolenaare344bea2005-09-01 20:46:49 +00005414 local to buffer
5415 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02005416 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
5417 or |+insert_expand| features}
Bram Moolenaarc7486e02005-12-29 22:48:26 +00005418 This option specifies a function to be used for Insert mode omni
5419 completion with CTRL-X CTRL-O. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-O|
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00005420 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of how the function is
5421 invoked and what it should return.
Bram Moolenaar043545e2006-10-10 16:44:07 +00005422 This option is usually set by a filetype plugin:
Bram Moolenaar9c102382006-05-03 21:26:49 +00005423 |:filetype-plugin-on|
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02005424 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5425 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaare344bea2005-09-01 20:46:49 +00005426
5427
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005428 *'opendevice'* *'odev'* *'noopendevice'* *'noodev'*
Bram Moolenaar043545e2006-10-10 16:44:07 +00005429'opendevice' 'odev' boolean (default off)
5430 global
5431 {not in Vi}
5432 {only for MS-DOS, MS-Windows and OS/2}
5433 Enable reading and writing from devices. This may get Vim stuck on a
5434 device that can be opened but doesn't actually do the I/O. Therefore
5435 it is off by default.
5436 Note that on MS-Windows editing "aux.h", "lpt1.txt" and the like also
5437 result in editing a device.
5438
5439
Bram Moolenaar2c7a29c2005-12-12 22:02:31 +00005440 *'operatorfunc'* *'opfunc'*
5441'operatorfunc' 'opfunc' string (default: empty)
5442 global
5443 {not in Vi}
5444 This option specifies a function to be called by the |g@| operator.
5445 See |:map-operator| for more info and an example.
5446
5447 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5448 security reasons.
5449
5450
Bram Moolenaar251e1912011-06-19 05:09:16 +02005451 *'osfiletype'* *'oft'*
5452'osfiletype' 'oft' string (default: "")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005453 local to buffer
5454 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar251e1912011-06-19 05:09:16 +02005455 This option was supported on RISC OS, which has been removed.
5456
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005457
Bram Moolenaarf6fee0e2016-02-21 23:02:49 +01005458 *'packpath'* *'pp'*
5459'packpath' 'pp' string (default: see 'runtimepath')
5460 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarf6fee0e2016-02-21 23:02:49 +01005461 Directories used to find packages. See |packages|.
5462
5463
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005464 *'paragraphs'* *'para'*
Bram Moolenaar57e48462008-03-12 16:38:55 +00005465'paragraphs' 'para' string (default "IPLPPPQPP TPHPLIPpLpItpplpipbp")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005466 global
5467 Specifies the nroff macros that separate paragraphs. These are pairs
5468 of two letters (see |object-motions|).
5469
5470 *'paste'* *'nopaste'*
5471'paste' boolean (default off)
5472 global
5473 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005474 Put Vim in Paste mode. This is useful if you want to cut or copy
5475 some text from one window and paste it in Vim. This will avoid
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005476 unexpected effects.
5477 Setting this option is useful when using Vim in a terminal, where Vim
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005478 cannot distinguish between typed text and pasted text. In the GUI, Vim
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005479 knows about pasting and will mostly do the right thing without 'paste'
5480 being set. The same is true for a terminal where Vim handles the
5481 mouse clicks itself.
Bram Moolenaar2ce06f62005-01-31 19:19:04 +00005482 This option is reset when starting the GUI. Thus if you set it in
5483 your .vimrc it will work in a terminal, but not in the GUI. Setting
5484 'paste' in the GUI has side effects: e.g., the Paste toolbar button
5485 will no longer work in Insert mode, because it uses a mapping.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005486 When the 'paste' option is switched on (also when it was already on):
5487 - mapping in Insert mode and Command-line mode is disabled
5488 - abbreviations are disabled
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005489 - 'autoindent' is reset
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02005490 - 'expandtab' is reset
5491 - 'formatoptions' is used like it is empty
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005492 - 'revins' is reset
5493 - 'ruler' is reset
5494 - 'showmatch' is reset
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02005495 - 'smartindent' is reset
5496 - 'smarttab' is reset
5497 - 'softtabstop' is set to 0
5498 - 'textwidth' is set to 0
5499 - 'wrapmargin' is set to 0
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005500 These options keep their value, but their effect is disabled:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005501 - 'cindent'
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02005502 - 'indentexpr'
5503 - 'lisp'
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005504 NOTE: When you start editing another file while the 'paste' option is
5505 on, settings from the modelines or autocommands may change the
5506 settings again, causing trouble when pasting text. You might want to
5507 set the 'paste' option again.
5508 When the 'paste' option is reset the mentioned options are restored to
5509 the value before the moment 'paste' was switched from off to on.
5510 Resetting 'paste' before ever setting it does not have any effect.
5511 Since mapping doesn't work while 'paste' is active, you need to use
5512 the 'pastetoggle' option to toggle the 'paste' option with some key.
5513
5514 *'pastetoggle'* *'pt'*
5515'pastetoggle' 'pt' string (default "")
5516 global
5517 {not in Vi}
5518 When non-empty, specifies the key sequence that toggles the 'paste'
5519 option. This is like specifying a mapping: >
5520 :map {keys} :set invpaste<CR>
5521< Where {keys} is the value of 'pastetoggle'.
5522 The difference is that it will work even when 'paste' is set.
5523 'pastetoggle' works in Insert mode and Normal mode, but not in
5524 Command-line mode.
5525 Mappings are checked first, thus overrule 'pastetoggle'. However,
5526 when 'paste' is on mappings are ignored in Insert mode, thus you can do
5527 this: >
5528 :map <F10> :set paste<CR>
5529 :map <F11> :set nopaste<CR>
5530 :imap <F10> <C-O>:set paste<CR>
5531 :imap <F11> <nop>
5532 :set pastetoggle=<F11>
5533< This will make <F10> start paste mode and <F11> stop paste mode.
5534 Note that typing <F10> in paste mode inserts "<F10>", since in paste
5535 mode everything is inserted literally, except the 'pastetoggle' key
5536 sequence.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00005537 When the value has several bytes 'ttimeoutlen' applies.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005538
5539 *'pex'* *'patchexpr'*
5540'patchexpr' 'pex' string (default "")
5541 global
5542 {not in Vi}
5543 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
5544 feature}
5545 Expression which is evaluated to apply a patch to a file and generate
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005546 the resulting new version of the file. See |diff-patchexpr|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005547
Bram Moolenaardbc28022014-07-26 13:40:44 +02005548 *'patchmode'* *'pm'* *E205* *E206*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005549'patchmode' 'pm' string (default "")
5550 global
5551 {not in Vi}
5552 When non-empty the oldest version of a file is kept. This can be used
5553 to keep the original version of a file if you are changing files in a
5554 source distribution. Only the first time that a file is written a
5555 copy of the original file will be kept. The name of the copy is the
5556 name of the original file with the string in the 'patchmode' option
5557 appended. This option should start with a dot. Use a string like
5558 ".org". 'backupdir' must not be empty for this to work (Detail: The
5559 backup file is renamed to the patchmode file after the new file has
5560 been successfully written, that's why it must be possible to write a
5561 backup file). If there was no file to be backed up, an empty file is
5562 created.
5563 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a patchmode file is not made.
5564 Using 'patchmode' for compressed files appends the extension at the
5565 end (e.g., "file.gz.orig"), thus the resulting name isn't always
5566 recognized as a compressed file.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00005567 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005568
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01005569 *'path'* *'pa'* *E343* *E345* *E347* *E854*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005570'path' 'pa' string (default on Unix: ".,/usr/include,,"
5571 on OS/2: ".,/emx/include,,"
5572 other systems: ".,,")
5573 global or local to buffer |global-local|
5574 {not in Vi}
5575 This is a list of directories which will be searched when using the
Bram Moolenaarc236c162008-07-13 17:41:49 +00005576 |gf|, [f, ]f, ^Wf, |:find|, |:sfind|, |:tabfind| and other commands,
5577 provided that the file being searched for has a relative path (not
5578 starting with "/", "./" or "../"). The directories in the 'path'
5579 option may be relative or absolute.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005580 - Use commas to separate directory names: >
5581 :set path=.,/usr/local/include,/usr/include
5582< - Spaces can also be used to separate directory names (for backwards
5583 compatibility with version 3.0). To have a space in a directory
5584 name, precede it with an extra backslash, and escape the space: >
5585 :set path=.,/dir/with\\\ space
5586< - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with an extra
5587 backslash: >
5588 :set path=.,/dir/with\\,comma
5589< - To search relative to the directory of the current file, use: >
5590 :set path=.
5591< - To search in the current directory use an empty string between two
5592 commas: >
5593 :set path=,,
5594< - A directory name may end in a ':' or '/'.
5595 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
5596 - When using |netrw.vim| URLs can be used. For example, adding
5597 "http://www.vim.org" will make ":find index.html" work.
Bram Moolenaarc236c162008-07-13 17:41:49 +00005598 - Search upwards and downwards in a directory tree using "*", "**" and
5599 ";". See |file-searching| for info and syntax.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005600 {not available when compiled without the |+path_extra| feature}
5601 - Careful with '\' characters, type two to get one in the option: >
5602 :set path=.,c:\\include
5603< Or just use '/' instead: >
5604 :set path=.,c:/include
5605< Don't forget "." or files won't even be found in the same directory as
5606 the file!
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005607 The maximum length is limited. How much depends on the system, mostly
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005608 it is something like 256 or 1024 characters.
5609 You can check if all the include files are found, using the value of
5610 'path', see |:checkpath|.
5611 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
5612 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
5613 uses another default. To remove the current directory use: >
5614 :set path-=
5615< To add the current directory use: >
5616 :set path+=
5617< To use an environment variable, you probably need to replace the
5618 separator. Here is an example to append $INCL, in which directory
5619 names are separated with a semi-colon: >
5620 :let &path = &path . "," . substitute($INCL, ';', ',', 'g')
5621< Replace the ';' with a ':' or whatever separator is used. Note that
5622 this doesn't work when $INCL contains a comma or white space.
5623
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01005624 *'perldll'*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01005625'perldll' string (default depends on the build)
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01005626 global
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01005627 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01005628 {only available when compiled with the |+perl/dyn|
5629 feature}
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01005630 Specifies the name of the Perl shared library. The default is
5631 DYNAMIC_PERL_DLL, which was specified at compile time.
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02005632 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01005633 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5634 security reasons.
5635
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005636 *'preserveindent'* *'pi'* *'nopreserveindent'* *'nopi'*
5637'preserveindent' 'pi' boolean (default off)
5638 local to buffer
5639 {not in Vi}
5640 When changing the indent of the current line, preserve as much of the
5641 indent structure as possible. Normally the indent is replaced by a
5642 series of tabs followed by spaces as required (unless |'expandtab'| is
5643 enabled, in which case only spaces are used). Enabling this option
5644 means the indent will preserve as many existing characters as possible
5645 for indenting, and only add additional tabs or spaces as required.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00005646 'expandtab' does not apply to the preserved white space, a Tab remains
5647 a Tab.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005648 NOTE: When using ">>" multiple times the resulting indent is a mix of
5649 tabs and spaces. You might not like this.
5650 NOTE: 'preserveindent' is reset when 'compatible' is set.
5651 Also see 'copyindent'.
5652 Use |:retab| to clean up white space.
5653
5654 *'previewheight'* *'pvh'*
5655'previewheight' 'pvh' number (default 12)
5656 global
5657 {not in Vi}
5658 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| or
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02005659 |+quickfix| features}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005660 Default height for a preview window. Used for |:ptag| and associated
5661 commands. Used for |CTRL-W_}| when no count is given.
5662
5663 *'previewwindow'* *'nopreviewwindow'*
5664 *'pvw'* *'nopvw'* *E590*
5665'previewwindow' 'pvw' boolean (default off)
5666 local to window
5667 {not in Vi}
5668 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| or
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02005669 |+quickfix| features}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005670 Identifies the preview window. Only one window can have this option
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005671 set. It's normally not set directly, but by using one of the commands
5672 |:ptag|, |:pedit|, etc.
5673
5674 *'printdevice'* *'pdev'*
5675'printdevice' 'pdev' string (default empty)
5676 global
5677 {not in Vi}
5678 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
5679 feature}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005680 The name of the printer to be used for |:hardcopy|.
5681 See |pdev-option|.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00005682 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5683 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005684
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005685 *'printencoding'* *'penc'*
5686'printencoding' 'penc' String (default empty, except for some systems)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005687 global
5688 {not in Vi}
5689 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
5690 and |+postscript| features}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005691 Sets the character encoding used when printing.
5692 See |penc-option|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005693
5694 *'printexpr'* *'pexpr'*
5695'printexpr' 'pexpr' String (default: see below)
5696 global
5697 {not in Vi}
5698 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
5699 and |+postscript| features}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005700 Expression used to print the PostScript produced with |:hardcopy|.
5701 See |pexpr-option|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005702
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005703 *'printfont'* *'pfn'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005704'printfont' 'pfn' string (default "courier")
5705 global
5706 {not in Vi}
5707 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
5708 feature}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005709 The name of the font that will be used for |:hardcopy|.
5710 See |pfn-option|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005711
5712 *'printheader'* *'pheader'*
5713'printheader' 'pheader' string (default "%<%f%h%m%=Page %N")
5714 global
5715 {not in Vi}
5716 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
5717 feature}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005718 The format of the header produced in |:hardcopy| output.
5719 See |pheader-option|.
5720
5721 *'printmbcharset'* *'pmbcs'*
5722'printmbcharset' 'pmbcs' string (default "")
5723 global
5724 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarbc7aa852005-03-06 23:38:09 +00005725 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|,
5726 |+postscript| and |+multi_byte| features}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005727 The CJK character set to be used for CJK output from |:hardcopy|.
5728 See |pmbcs-option|.
5729
5730 *'printmbfont'* *'pmbfn'*
5731'printmbfont' 'pmbfn' string (default "")
5732 global
5733 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarbc7aa852005-03-06 23:38:09 +00005734 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|,
5735 |+postscript| and |+multi_byte| features}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005736 List of font names to be used for CJK output from |:hardcopy|.
5737 See |pmbfn-option|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005738
5739 *'printoptions'* *'popt'*
5740'printoptions' 'popt' string (default "")
5741 global
5742 {not in Vi}
5743 {only available when compiled with |+printer| feature}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005744 List of items that control the format of the output of |:hardcopy|.
5745 See |popt-option|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005746
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00005747 *'prompt'* *'noprompt'*
5748'prompt' boolean (default on)
5749 global
5750 When on a ":" prompt is used in Ex mode.
5751
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00005752 *'pumheight'* *'ph'*
5753'pumheight' 'ph' number (default 0)
5754 global
5755 {not available when compiled without the
5756 |+insert_expand| feature}
5757 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar06a89a52006-04-29 22:01:03 +00005758 Determines the maximum number of items to show in the popup menu for
5759 Insert mode completion. When zero as much space as available is used.
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00005760 |ins-completion-menu|.
5761
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01005762 *'pythondll'*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01005763'pythondll' string (default depends on the build)
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01005764 global
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01005765 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01005766 {only available when compiled with the |+python/dyn|
5767 feature}
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01005768 Specifies the name of the Python 2.x shared library. The default is
5769 DYNAMIC_PYTHON_DLL, which was specified at compile time.
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02005770 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01005771 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5772 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00005773
Bram Moolenaarb4ff5182015-11-10 21:15:48 +01005774 *'pythonthreedll'*
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01005775'pythonthreedll' string (default depends on the build)
Bram Moolenaarb4ff5182015-11-10 21:15:48 +01005776 global
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01005777 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarb4ff5182015-11-10 21:15:48 +01005778 {only available when compiled with the |+python3/dyn|
5779 feature}
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01005780 Specifies the name of the Python 3 shared library. The default is
5781 DYNAMIC_PYTHON3_DLL, which was specified at compile time.
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02005782 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaarb4ff5182015-11-10 21:15:48 +01005783 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5784 security reasons.
5785
Bram Moolenaar677ee682005-01-27 14:41:15 +00005786 *'quoteescape'* *'qe'*
Bram Moolenaarcfbc5ee2004-07-02 15:38:35 +00005787'quoteescape' 'qe' string (default "\")
5788 local to buffer
5789 {not in Vi}
5790 The characters that are used to escape quotes in a string. Used for
5791 objects like a', a" and a` |a'|.
5792 When one of the characters in this option is found inside a string,
5793 the following character will be skipped. The default value makes the
5794 text "foo\"bar\\" considered to be one string.
5795
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005796 *'readonly'* *'ro'* *'noreadonly'* *'noro'*
5797'readonly' 'ro' boolean (default off)
5798 local to buffer
5799 If on, writes fail unless you use a '!'. Protects you from
5800 accidentally overwriting a file. Default on when Vim is started
5801 in read-only mode ("vim -R") or when the executable is called "view".
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00005802 When using ":w!" the 'readonly' option is reset for the current
5803 buffer, unless the 'Z' flag is in 'cpoptions'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005804 {not in Vi:} When using the ":view" command the 'readonly' option is
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00005805 set for the newly edited buffer.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005806
Bram Moolenaar91a4e822008-01-19 14:59:58 +00005807 *'redrawtime'* *'rdt'*
5808'redrawtime' 'rdt' number (default 2000)
5809 global
5810 {not in Vi}
5811 {only available when compiled with the |+reltime|
5812 feature}
5813 The time in milliseconds for redrawing the display. This applies to
5814 searching for patterns for 'hlsearch' and |:match| highlighting.
5815 When redrawing takes more than this many milliseconds no further
5816 matches will be highlighted. This is used to avoid that Vim hangs
5817 when using a very complicated pattern.
5818
Bram Moolenaar543b7ef2013-06-01 14:50:56 +02005819 *'regexpengine'* *'re'*
Bram Moolenaare6ae6222013-05-21 21:01:10 +02005820'regexpengine' 're' number (default 0)
5821 global
5822 {not in Vi}
5823 This selects the default regexp engine. |two-engines|
5824 The possible values are:
5825 0 automatic selection
5826 1 old engine
5827 2 NFA engine
5828 Note that when using the NFA engine and the pattern contains something
5829 that is not supported the pattern will not match. This is only useful
5830 for debugging the regexp engine.
Bram Moolenaarfda37292014-11-05 14:27:36 +01005831 Using automatic selection enables Vim to switch the engine, if the
5832 default engine becomes too costly. E.g., when the NFA engine uses too
5833 many states. This should prevent Vim from hanging on a combination of
5834 a complex pattern with long text.
Bram Moolenaare6ae6222013-05-21 21:01:10 +02005835
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02005836 *'relativenumber'* *'rnu'* *'norelativenumber'* *'nornu'*
5837'relativenumber' 'rnu' boolean (default off)
5838 local to window
5839 {not in Vi}
5840 Show the line number relative to the line with the cursor in front of
Bram Moolenaar06b5d512010-05-22 15:37:44 +02005841 each line. Relative line numbers help you use the |count| you can
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02005842 precede some vertical motion commands (e.g. j k + -) with, without
5843 having to calculate it yourself. Especially useful in combination with
5844 other commands (e.g. y d c < > gq gw =).
5845 When the 'n' option is excluded from 'cpoptions' a wrapped
5846 line will not use the column of line numbers (this is the default when
5847 'compatible' isn't set).
5848 The 'numberwidth' option can be used to set the room used for the line
5849 number.
5850 When a long, wrapped line doesn't start with the first character, '-'
5851 characters are put before the number.
Bram Moolenaar61d35bd2012-03-28 20:51:51 +02005852 See |hl-LineNr| and |hl-CursorLineNr| for the highlighting used for
5853 the number.
Bram Moolenaar203d04d2013-06-06 21:36:40 +02005854
5855 The number in front of the cursor line also depends on the value of
5856 'number', see |number_relativenumber| for all combinations of the two
5857 options.
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02005858
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005859 *'remap'* *'noremap'*
5860'remap' boolean (default on)
5861 global
5862 Allows for mappings to work recursively. If you do not want this for
5863 a single entry, use the :noremap[!] command.
Bram Moolenaara3227e22006-03-08 21:32:40 +00005864 NOTE: To avoid portability problems with Vim scripts, always keep
5865 this option at the default "on". Only switch it off when working with
5866 old Vi scripts.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005867
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02005868 *'renderoptions'* *'rop'*
5869'renderoptions' 'rop' string (default: empty)
5870 global
5871 {not in Vi}
5872 {only available when compiled with GUI and DIRECTX on
5873 MS-Windows}
5874 Select a text renderer and set its options. The options depend on the
5875 renderer.
5876
5877 Syntax: >
5878 set rop=type:{renderer}(,{name}:{value})*
5879<
5880 Currently, only one optional renderer is available.
5881
5882 render behavior ~
5883 directx Vim will draw text using DirectX (DirectWrite). It makes
5884 drawn glyphs more beautiful than default GDI.
5885 It requires 'encoding' is "utf-8", and only works on
5886 MS-Windows Vista or newer version.
5887
5888 Options:
5889 name meaning type value ~
5890 gamma gamma float 1.0 - 2.2 (maybe)
5891 contrast enhancedContrast float (unknown)
5892 level clearTypeLevel float (unknown)
5893 geom pixelGeometry int 0 - 2 (see below)
5894 renmode renderingMode int 0 - 6 (see below)
5895 taamode textAntialiasMode int 0 - 3 (see below)
5896
5897 See this URL for detail:
5898 http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368190.aspx
5899
5900 For geom: structure of a device pixel.
5901 0 - DWRITE_PIXEL_GEOMETRY_FLAT
5902 1 - DWRITE_PIXEL_GEOMETRY_RGB
5903 2 - DWRITE_PIXEL_GEOMETRY_BGR
5904
5905 See this URL for detail:
5906 http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368114.aspx
5907
5908 For renmode: method of rendering glyphs.
5909 0 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_DEFAULT
5910 1 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_ALIASED
5911 2 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_GDI_CLASSIC
5912 3 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_GDI_NATURAL
5913 4 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_NATURAL
5914 5 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_NATURAL_SYMMETRIC
5915 6 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_OUTLINE
5916
5917 See this URL for detail:
5918 http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368118.aspx
5919
5920 For taamode: antialiasing mode used for drawing text.
5921 0 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_DEFAULT
5922 1 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_CLEARTYPE
5923 2 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_GRAYSCALE
5924 3 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_ALIASED
5925
5926 See this URL for detail:
5927 http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368170.aspx
5928
5929 Example: >
5930 set encoding=utf-8
5931 set gfn=Ricty_Diminished:h12:cSHIFTJIS
5932 set rop=type:directx
5933<
5934 If select a raster font (Courier, Terminal or FixedSys) to
5935 'guifont', it fallbacks to be drawn by GDI automatically.
5936
5937 Other render types are currently not supported.
5938
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005939 *'report'*
5940'report' number (default 2)
5941 global
5942 Threshold for reporting number of lines changed. When the number of
5943 changed lines is more than 'report' a message will be given for most
5944 ":" commands. If you want it always, set 'report' to 0.
5945 For the ":substitute" command the number of substitutions is used
5946 instead of the number of lines.
5947
5948 *'restorescreen'* *'rs'* *'norestorescreen'* *'nors'*
5949'restorescreen' 'rs' boolean (default on)
5950 global
5951 {not in Vi} {only in Windows 95/NT console version}
5952 When set, the screen contents is restored when exiting Vim. This also
5953 happens when executing external commands.
5954
5955 For non-Windows Vim: You can set or reset the 't_ti' and 't_te'
5956 options in your .vimrc. To disable restoring:
5957 set t_ti= t_te=
5958 To enable restoring (for an xterm):
5959 set t_ti=^[7^[[r^[[?47h t_te=^[[?47l^[8
5960 (Where ^[ is an <Esc>, type CTRL-V <Esc> to insert it)
5961
5962 *'revins'* *'ri'* *'norevins'* *'nori'*
5963'revins' 'ri' boolean (default off)
5964 global
5965 {not in Vi}
5966 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
5967 feature}
5968 Inserting characters in Insert mode will work backwards. See "typing
5969 backwards" |ins-reverse|. This option can be toggled with the CTRL-_
5970 command in Insert mode, when 'allowrevins' is set.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02005971 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
5972 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is
5973 reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005974
5975 *'rightleft'* *'rl'* *'norightleft'* *'norl'*
5976'rightleft' 'rl' boolean (default off)
5977 local to window
5978 {not in Vi}
5979 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
5980 feature}
5981 When on, display orientation becomes right-to-left, i.e., characters
5982 that are stored in the file appear from the right to the left.
5983 Using this option, it is possible to edit files for languages that
5984 are written from the right to the left such as Hebrew and Arabic.
5985 This option is per window, so it is possible to edit mixed files
5986 simultaneously, or to view the same file in both ways (this is
5987 useful whenever you have a mixed text file with both right-to-left
5988 and left-to-right strings so that both sets are displayed properly
5989 in different windows). Also see |rileft.txt|.
5990
Bram Moolenaar607cc1e2010-07-18 18:47:44 +02005991 *'rightleftcmd'* *'rlc'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005992'rightleftcmd' 'rlc' string (default "search")
5993 local to window
5994 {not in Vi}
5995 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
5996 feature}
5997 Each word in this option enables the command line editing to work in
5998 right-to-left mode for a group of commands:
5999
6000 search "/" and "?" commands
6001
6002 This is useful for languages such as Hebrew, Arabic and Farsi.
6003 The 'rightleft' option must be set for 'rightleftcmd' to take effect.
6004
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006005 *'rubydll'*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01006006'rubydll' string (default: depends on the build)
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006007 global
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01006008 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006009 {only available when compiled with the |+ruby/dyn|
6010 feature}
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01006011 Specifies the name of the Ruby shared library. The default is
6012 DYNAMIC_RUBY_DLL, which was specified at compile time.
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02006013 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006014 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6015 security reasons.
6016
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006017 *'ruler'* *'ru'* *'noruler'* *'noru'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02006018'ruler' 'ru' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006019 global
6020 {not in Vi}
6021 {not available when compiled without the
6022 |+cmdline_info| feature}
6023 Show the line and column number of the cursor position, separated by a
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006024 comma. When there is room, the relative position of the displayed
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006025 text in the file is shown on the far right:
6026 Top first line is visible
6027 Bot last line is visible
6028 All first and last line are visible
6029 45% relative position in the file
6030 If 'rulerformat' is set, it will determine the contents of the ruler.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006031 Each window has its own ruler. If a window has a status line, the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006032 ruler is shown there. Otherwise it is shown in the last line of the
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00006033 screen. If the statusline is given by 'statusline' (i.e. not empty),
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006034 this option takes precedence over 'ruler' and 'rulerformat'
6035 If the number of characters displayed is different from the number of
6036 bytes in the text (e.g., for a TAB or a multi-byte character), both
6037 the text column (byte number) and the screen column are shown,
6038 separated with a dash.
6039 For an empty line "0-1" is shown.
6040 For an empty buffer the line number will also be zero: "0,0-1".
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02006041 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is
6042 reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006043 If you don't want to see the ruler all the time but want to know where
6044 you are, use "g CTRL-G" |g_CTRL-G|.
6045 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
6046
6047 *'rulerformat'* *'ruf'*
6048'rulerformat' 'ruf' string (default empty)
6049 global
6050 {not in Vi}
6051 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline|
6052 feature}
6053 When this option is not empty, it determines the content of the ruler
6054 string, as displayed for the 'ruler' option.
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00006055 The format of this option is like that of 'statusline'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006056 The default ruler width is 17 characters. To make the ruler 15
6057 characters wide, put "%15(" at the start and "%)" at the end.
6058 Example: >
6059 :set rulerformat=%15(%c%V\ %p%%%)
6060<
6061 *'runtimepath'* *'rtp'* *vimfiles*
6062'runtimepath' 'rtp' string (default:
6063 Unix: "$HOME/.vim,
6064 $VIM/vimfiles,
6065 $VIMRUNTIME,
6066 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
6067 $HOME/.vim/after"
6068 Amiga: "home:vimfiles,
6069 $VIM/vimfiles,
6070 $VIMRUNTIME,
6071 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
6072 home:vimfiles/after"
6073 PC, OS/2: "$HOME/vimfiles,
6074 $VIM/vimfiles,
6075 $VIMRUNTIME,
6076 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
6077 $HOME/vimfiles/after"
6078 Macintosh: "$VIM:vimfiles,
6079 $VIMRUNTIME,
6080 $VIM:vimfiles:after"
6081 RISC-OS: "Choices:vimfiles,
6082 $VIMRUNTIME,
6083 Choices:vimfiles/after"
6084 VMS: "sys$login:vimfiles,
6085 $VIM/vimfiles,
6086 $VIMRUNTIME,
6087 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00006088 sys$login:vimfiles/after")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006089 global
6090 {not in Vi}
6091 This is a list of directories which will be searched for runtime
6092 files:
6093 filetype.vim filetypes by file name |new-filetype|
6094 scripts.vim filetypes by file contents |new-filetype-scripts|
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00006095 autoload/ automatically loaded scripts |autoload-functions|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006096 colors/ color scheme files |:colorscheme|
6097 compiler/ compiler files |:compiler|
6098 doc/ documentation |write-local-help|
6099 ftplugin/ filetype plugins |write-filetype-plugin|
6100 indent/ indent scripts |indent-expression|
6101 keymap/ key mapping files |mbyte-keymap|
6102 lang/ menu translations |:menutrans|
6103 menu.vim GUI menus |menu.vim|
Bram Moolenaar26852122016-05-24 20:02:38 +02006104 pack/ packages |:packadd|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006105 plugin/ plugin scripts |write-plugin|
6106 print/ files for printing |postscript-print-encoding|
Bram Moolenaarafeb4fa2006-02-01 21:51:12 +00006107 spell/ spell checking files |spell|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006108 syntax/ syntax files |mysyntaxfile|
6109 tutor/ files for vimtutor |tutor|
6110
6111 And any other file searched for with the |:runtime| command.
6112
6113 The defaults for most systems are setup to search five locations:
6114 1. In your home directory, for your personal preferences.
6115 2. In a system-wide Vim directory, for preferences from the system
6116 administrator.
6117 3. In $VIMRUNTIME, for files distributed with Vim.
6118 *after-directory*
6119 4. In the "after" directory in the system-wide Vim directory. This is
6120 for the system administrator to overrule or add to the distributed
6121 defaults (rarely needed)
6122 5. In the "after" directory in your home directory. This is for
6123 personal preferences to overrule or add to the distributed defaults
6124 or system-wide settings (rarely needed).
6125
Bram Moolenaard0796902016-09-16 20:02:31 +02006126 More entries are added when using |packages|. If it gets very long
6127 then `:set rtp` will be truncated, use `:echo &rtp` to see the full
6128 string.
Bram Moolenaar26852122016-05-24 20:02:38 +02006129
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006130 Note that, unlike 'path', no wildcards like "**" are allowed. Normal
6131 wildcards are allowed, but can significantly slow down searching for
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006132 runtime files. For speed, use as few items as possible and avoid
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006133 wildcards.
6134 See |:runtime|.
6135 Example: >
6136 :set runtimepath=~/vimruntime,/mygroup/vim,$VIMRUNTIME
6137< This will use the directory "~/vimruntime" first (containing your
6138 personal Vim runtime files), then "/mygroup/vim" (shared between a
6139 group of people) and finally "$VIMRUNTIME" (the distributed runtime
6140 files).
6141 You probably should always include $VIMRUNTIME somewhere, to use the
6142 distributed runtime files. You can put a directory before $VIMRUNTIME
6143 to find files which replace a distributed runtime files. You can put
6144 a directory after $VIMRUNTIME to find files which add to distributed
6145 runtime files.
6146 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6147 security reasons.
6148
6149 *'scroll'* *'scr'*
6150'scroll' 'scr' number (default: half the window height)
6151 local to window
6152 Number of lines to scroll with CTRL-U and CTRL-D commands. Will be
6153 set to half the number of lines in the window when the window size
6154 changes. If you give a count to the CTRL-U or CTRL-D command it will
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006155 be used as the new value for 'scroll'. Reset to half the window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006156 height with ":set scroll=0". {Vi is a bit different: 'scroll' gives
6157 the number of screen lines instead of file lines, makes a difference
6158 when lines wrap}
6159
6160 *'scrollbind'* *'scb'* *'noscrollbind'* *'noscb'*
6161'scrollbind' 'scb' boolean (default off)
6162 local to window
6163 {not in Vi}
6164 {not available when compiled without the |+scrollbind|
6165 feature}
6166 See also |scroll-binding|. When this option is set, the current
6167 window scrolls as other scrollbind windows (windows that also have
6168 this option set) scroll. This option is useful for viewing the
6169 differences between two versions of a file, see 'diff'.
6170 See |'scrollopt'| for options that determine how this option should be
6171 interpreted.
6172 This option is mostly reset when splitting a window to edit another
6173 file. This means that ":split | edit file" results in two windows
6174 with scroll-binding, but ":split file" does not.
6175
6176 *'scrolljump'* *'sj'*
6177'scrolljump' 'sj' number (default 1)
6178 global
6179 {not in Vi}
6180 Minimal number of lines to scroll when the cursor gets off the
6181 screen (e.g., with "j"). Not used for scroll commands (e.g., CTRL-E,
6182 CTRL-D). Useful if your terminal scrolls very slowly.
Bram Moolenaar1e015462005-09-25 22:16:38 +00006183 When set to a negative number from -1 to -100 this is used as the
6184 percentage of the window height. Thus -50 scrolls half the window
6185 height.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006186 NOTE: This option is set to 1 when 'compatible' is set.
6187
6188 *'scrolloff'* *'so'*
Bram Moolenaar50ba5262016-09-22 22:33:02 +02006189'scrolloff' 'so' number (default 0, set to 5 in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006190 global
6191 {not in Vi}
6192 Minimal number of screen lines to keep above and below the cursor.
6193 This will make some context visible around where you are working. If
6194 you set it to a very large value (999) the cursor line will always be
6195 in the middle of the window (except at the start or end of the file or
6196 when long lines wrap).
6197 For scrolling horizontally see 'sidescrolloff'.
6198 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
6199
6200 *'scrollopt'* *'sbo'*
6201'scrollopt' 'sbo' string (default "ver,jump")
6202 global
6203 {not available when compiled without the |+scrollbind|
6204 feature}
6205 {not in Vi}
6206 This is a comma-separated list of words that specifies how
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00006207 'scrollbind' windows should behave. 'sbo' stands for ScrollBind
6208 Options.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006209 The following words are available:
6210 ver Bind vertical scrolling for 'scrollbind' windows
6211 hor Bind horizontal scrolling for 'scrollbind' windows
6212 jump Applies to the offset between two windows for vertical
6213 scrolling. This offset is the difference in the first
6214 displayed line of the bound windows. When moving
6215 around in a window, another 'scrollbind' window may
6216 reach a position before the start or after the end of
6217 the buffer. The offset is not changed though, when
6218 moving back the 'scrollbind' window will try to scroll
6219 to the desired position when possible.
6220 When now making that window the current one, two
6221 things can be done with the relative offset:
6222 1. When "jump" is not included, the relative offset is
6223 adjusted for the scroll position in the new current
6224 window. When going back to the other window, the
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00006225 new relative offset will be used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006226 2. When "jump" is included, the other windows are
6227 scrolled to keep the same relative offset. When
6228 going back to the other window, it still uses the
6229 same relative offset.
6230 Also see |scroll-binding|.
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00006231 When 'diff' mode is active there always is vertical scroll binding,
6232 even when "ver" isn't there.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006233
6234 *'sections'* *'sect'*
6235'sections' 'sect' string (default "SHNHH HUnhsh")
6236 global
6237 Specifies the nroff macros that separate sections. These are pairs of
6238 two letters (See |object-motions|). The default makes a section start
6239 at the nroff macros ".SH", ".NH", ".H", ".HU", ".nh" and ".sh".
6240
6241 *'secure'* *'nosecure'* *E523*
6242'secure' boolean (default off)
6243 global
6244 {not in Vi}
6245 When on, ":autocmd", shell and write commands are not allowed in
6246 ".vimrc" and ".exrc" in the current directory and map commands are
6247 displayed. Switch it off only if you know that you will not run into
6248 problems, or when the 'exrc' option is off. On Unix this option is
6249 only used if the ".vimrc" or ".exrc" is not owned by you. This can be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006250 dangerous if the systems allows users to do a "chown". You better set
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006251 'secure' at the end of your ~/.vimrc then.
6252 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6253 security reasons.
6254
6255 *'selection'* *'sel'*
6256'selection' 'sel' string (default "inclusive")
6257 global
6258 {not in Vi}
6259 This option defines the behavior of the selection. It is only used
6260 in Visual and Select mode.
6261 Possible values:
6262 value past line inclusive ~
6263 old no yes
6264 inclusive yes yes
6265 exclusive yes no
6266 "past line" means that the cursor is allowed to be positioned one
6267 character past the line.
6268 "inclusive" means that the last character of the selection is included
6269 in an operation. For example, when "x" is used to delete the
6270 selection.
Bram Moolenaare4a3bcf2016-08-26 19:52:37 +02006271 When "old" is used and 'virtualedit' allows the cursor to move past
6272 the end of line the line break still isn't included.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006273 Note that when "exclusive" is used and selecting from the end
6274 backwards, you cannot include the last character of a line, when
6275 starting in Normal mode and 'virtualedit' empty.
6276
6277 The 'selection' option is set by the |:behave| command.
6278
6279 *'selectmode'* *'slm'*
6280'selectmode' 'slm' string (default "")
6281 global
6282 {not in Vi}
6283 This is a comma separated list of words, which specifies when to start
6284 Select mode instead of Visual mode, when a selection is started.
6285 Possible values:
6286 mouse when using the mouse
6287 key when using shifted special keys
6288 cmd when using "v", "V" or CTRL-V
6289 See |Select-mode|.
6290 The 'selectmode' option is set by the |:behave| command.
6291
6292 *'sessionoptions'* *'ssop'*
6293'sessionoptions' 'ssop' string (default: "blank,buffers,curdir,folds,
Bram Moolenaar18144c82006-04-12 21:52:12 +00006294 help,options,tabpages,winsize")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006295 global
6296 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02006297 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006298 feature}
6299 Changes the effect of the |:mksession| command. It is a comma
6300 separated list of words. Each word enables saving and restoring
6301 something:
6302 word save and restore ~
6303 blank empty windows
6304 buffers hidden and unloaded buffers, not just those in windows
6305 curdir the current directory
6306 folds manually created folds, opened/closed folds and local
6307 fold options
6308 globals global variables that start with an uppercase letter
Bram Moolenaar12805862005-01-05 22:16:17 +00006309 and contain at least one lowercase letter. Only
6310 String and Number types are stored.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006311 help the help window
6312 localoptions options and mappings local to a window or buffer (not
6313 global values for local options)
6314 options all options and mappings (also global values for local
6315 options)
6316 resize size of the Vim window: 'lines' and 'columns'
6317 sesdir the directory in which the session file is located
6318 will become the current directory (useful with
6319 projects accessed over a network from different
6320 systems)
6321 slash backslashes in file names replaced with forward
6322 slashes
Bram Moolenaar18144c82006-04-12 21:52:12 +00006323 tabpages all tab pages; without this only the current tab page
6324 is restored, so that you can make a session for each
6325 tab page separately
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006326 unix with Unix end-of-line format (single <NL>), even when
6327 on Windows or DOS
6328 winpos position of the whole Vim window
6329 winsize window sizes
6330
6331 Don't include both "curdir" and "sesdir".
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01006332 When neither "curdir" nor "sesdir" is included, file names are stored
6333 with absolute paths.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006334 "slash" and "unix" are useful on Windows when sharing session files
6335 with Unix. The Unix version of Vim cannot source dos format scripts,
6336 but the Windows version of Vim can source unix format scripts.
6337
6338 *'shell'* *'sh'* *E91*
6339'shell' 'sh' string (default $SHELL or "sh",
6340 MS-DOS and Win32: "command.com" or
6341 "cmd.exe", OS/2: "cmd")
6342 global
6343 Name of the shell to use for ! and :! commands. When changing the
6344 value also check these options: 'shelltype', 'shellpipe', 'shellslash'
6345 'shellredir', 'shellquote', 'shellxquote' and 'shellcmdflag'.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006346 It is allowed to give an argument to the command, e.g. "csh -f".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006347 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
6348 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
6349 If the name of the shell contains a space, you might need to enclose
6350 it in quotes. Example: >
6351 :set shell=\"c:\program\ files\unix\sh.exe\"\ -f
6352< Note the backslash before each quote (to avoid starting a comment) and
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006353 each space (to avoid ending the option value). Also note that the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006354 "-f" is not inside the quotes, because it is not part of the command
6355 name. And Vim automagically recognizes the backslashes that are path
6356 separators.
6357 For Dos 32 bits (DJGPP), you can set the $DJSYSFLAGS environment
6358 variable to change the way external commands are executed. See the
6359 libc.inf file of DJGPP.
6360 Under MS-Windows, when the executable ends in ".com" it must be
6361 included. Thus setting the shell to "command.com" or "4dos.com"
6362 works, but "command" and "4dos" do not work for all commands (e.g.,
6363 filtering).
6364 For unknown reasons, when using "4dos.com" the current directory is
6365 changed to "C:\". To avoid this set 'shell' like this: >
6366 :set shell=command.com\ /c\ 4dos
6367< This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6368 security reasons.
6369
6370 *'shellcmdflag'* *'shcf'*
Bram Moolenaar5dc62522012-02-13 00:05:22 +01006371'shellcmdflag' 'shcf' string (default: "-c";
Bram Moolenaardb7207e2012-02-22 17:30:19 +01006372 MS-DOS and Win32, when 'shell' does not
6373 contain "sh" somewhere: "/c")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006374 global
6375 {not in Vi}
6376 Flag passed to the shell to execute "!" and ":!" commands; e.g.,
6377 "bash.exe -c ls" or "command.com /c dir". For the MS-DOS-like
6378 systems, the default is set according to the value of 'shell', to
6379 reduce the need to set this option by the user. It's not used for
Bram Moolenaar5302d9e2011-09-14 17:55:08 +02006380 OS/2 (EMX figures this out itself).
6381 On Unix it can have more than one flag. Each white space separated
6382 part is passed as an argument to the shell command.
6383 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
6384 Also see |dos-shell| for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006385 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6386 security reasons.
6387
6388 *'shellpipe'* *'sp'*
6389'shellpipe' 'sp' string (default ">", "| tee", "|& tee" or "2>&1| tee")
6390 global
6391 {not in Vi}
6392 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
6393 feature}
6394 String to be used to put the output of the ":make" command in the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006395 error file. See also |:make_makeprg|. See |option-backslash| about
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006396 including spaces and backslashes.
6397 The name of the temporary file can be represented by "%s" if necessary
6398 (the file name is appended automatically if no %s appears in the value
6399 of this option).
6400 For the Amiga and MS-DOS the default is ">". The output is directly
6401 saved in a file and not echoed to the screen.
6402 For Unix the default it "| tee". The stdout of the compiler is saved
6403 in a file and echoed to the screen. If the 'shell' option is "csh" or
6404 "tcsh" after initializations, the default becomes "|& tee". If the
Bram Moolenaar8e5af3e2011-04-28 19:02:44 +02006405 'shell' option is "sh", "ksh", "mksh", "pdksh", "zsh" or "bash" the
6406 default becomes "2>&1| tee". This means that stderr is also included.
6407 Before using the 'shell' option a path is removed, thus "/bin/sh" uses
6408 "sh".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006409 The initialization of this option is done after reading the ".vimrc"
6410 and the other initializations, so that when the 'shell' option is set
6411 there, the 'shellpipe' option changes automatically, unless it was
6412 explicitly set before.
6413 When 'shellpipe' is set to an empty string, no redirection of the
6414 ":make" output will be done. This is useful if you use a 'makeprg'
6415 that writes to 'makeef' by itself. If you want no piping, but do
6416 want to include the 'makeef', set 'shellpipe' to a single space.
6417 Don't forget to precede the space with a backslash: ":set sp=\ ".
6418 In the future pipes may be used for filtering and this option will
6419 become obsolete (at least for Unix).
6420 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6421 security reasons.
6422
6423 *'shellquote'* *'shq'*
6424'shellquote' 'shq' string (default: ""; MS-DOS and Win32, when 'shell'
6425 contains "sh" somewhere: "\"")
6426 global
6427 {not in Vi}
6428 Quoting character(s), put around the command passed to the shell, for
6429 the "!" and ":!" commands. The redirection is kept outside of the
6430 quoting. See 'shellxquote' to include the redirection. It's
6431 probably not useful to set both options.
6432 This is an empty string by default. Only known to be useful for
6433 third-party shells on MS-DOS-like systems, such as the MKS Korn Shell
6434 or bash, where it should be "\"". The default is adjusted according
6435 the value of 'shell', to reduce the need to set this option by the
6436 user. See |dos-shell|.
6437 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6438 security reasons.
6439
6440 *'shellredir'* *'srr'*
6441'shellredir' 'srr' string (default ">", ">&" or ">%s 2>&1")
6442 global
6443 {not in Vi}
6444 String to be used to put the output of a filter command in a temporary
6445 file. See also |:!|. See |option-backslash| about including spaces
6446 and backslashes.
6447 The name of the temporary file can be represented by "%s" if necessary
6448 (the file name is appended automatically if no %s appears in the value
6449 of this option).
6450 The default is ">". For Unix, if the 'shell' option is "csh", "tcsh"
6451 or "zsh" during initializations, the default becomes ">&". If the
6452 'shell' option is "sh", "ksh" or "bash" the default becomes
6453 ">%s 2>&1". This means that stderr is also included.
6454 For Win32, the Unix checks are done and additionally "cmd" is checked
6455 for, which makes the default ">%s 2>&1". Also, the same names with
6456 ".exe" appended are checked for.
6457 The initialization of this option is done after reading the ".vimrc"
6458 and the other initializations, so that when the 'shell' option is set
6459 there, the 'shellredir' option changes automatically unless it was
6460 explicitly set before.
6461 In the future pipes may be used for filtering and this option will
6462 become obsolete (at least for Unix).
6463 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6464 security reasons.
6465
6466 *'shellslash'* *'ssl'* *'noshellslash'* *'nossl'*
6467'shellslash' 'ssl' boolean (default off)
6468 global
6469 {not in Vi} {only for MSDOS, MS-Windows and OS/2}
6470 When set, a forward slash is used when expanding file names. This is
6471 useful when a Unix-like shell is used instead of command.com or
6472 cmd.exe. Backward slashes can still be typed, but they are changed to
6473 forward slashes by Vim.
6474 Note that setting or resetting this option has no effect for some
6475 existing file names, thus this option needs to be set before opening
6476 any file for best results. This might change in the future.
6477 'shellslash' only works when a backslash can be used as a path
6478 separator. To test if this is so use: >
6479 if exists('+shellslash')
6480<
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00006481 *'shelltemp'* *'stmp'* *'noshelltemp'* *'nostmp'*
6482'shelltemp' 'stmp' boolean (Vi default off, Vim default on)
6483 global
6484 {not in Vi}
6485 When on, use temp files for shell commands. When off use a pipe.
6486 When using a pipe is not possible temp files are used anyway.
Bram Moolenaar97293012011-07-18 19:40:27 +02006487 Currently a pipe is only supported on Unix and MS-Windows 2K and
6488 later. You can check it with: >
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00006489 :if has("filterpipe")
6490< The advantage of using a pipe is that nobody can read the temp file
6491 and the 'shell' command does not need to support redirection.
6492 The advantage of using a temp file is that the file type and encoding
6493 can be detected.
6494 The |FilterReadPre|, |FilterReadPost| and |FilterWritePre|,
6495 |FilterWritePost| autocommands event are not triggered when
6496 'shelltemp' is off.
Bram Moolenaar269f5952016-07-15 22:54:41 +02006497 The `system()` function does not respect this option and always uses
6498 temp files.
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00006499
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006500 *'shelltype'* *'st'*
6501'shelltype' 'st' number (default 0)
6502 global
6503 {not in Vi} {only for the Amiga}
6504 On the Amiga this option influences the way how the commands work
6505 which use a shell.
6506 0 and 1: always use the shell
6507 2 and 3: use the shell only to filter lines
6508 4 and 5: use shell only for ':sh' command
6509 When not using the shell, the command is executed directly.
6510
6511 0 and 2: use "shell 'shellcmdflag' cmd" to start external commands
6512 1 and 3: use "shell cmd" to start external commands
6513
Bram Moolenaardb7207e2012-02-22 17:30:19 +01006514 *'shellxescape'* *'sxe'*
6515'shellxescape' 'sxe' string (default: "";
6516 for MS-DOS and MS-Windows: "\"&|<>()@^")
6517 global
6518 {not in Vi}
6519 When 'shellxquote' is set to "(" then the characters listed in this
6520 option will be escaped with a '^' character. This makes it possible
6521 to execute most external commands with cmd.exe.
6522
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006523 *'shellxquote'* *'sxq'*
6524'shellxquote' 'sxq' string (default: "";
Bram Moolenaarf66b3fc2012-02-20 22:18:30 +01006525 for Win32, when 'shell' is cmd.exe: "("
6526 for Win32, when 'shell' contains "sh"
6527 somewhere: "\""
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006528 for Unix, when using system(): "\"")
6529 global
6530 {not in Vi}
6531 Quoting character(s), put around the command passed to the shell, for
6532 the "!" and ":!" commands. Includes the redirection. See
6533 'shellquote' to exclude the redirection. It's probably not useful
6534 to set both options.
Bram Moolenaarf66b3fc2012-02-20 22:18:30 +01006535 When the value is '(' then ')' is appended. When the value is '"('
6536 then ')"' is appended.
6537 When the value is '(' then also see 'shellxescape'.
Bram Moolenaara64ba222012-02-12 23:23:31 +01006538 This is an empty string by default on most systems, but is known to be
6539 useful for on Win32 version, either for cmd.exe which automatically
6540 strips off the first and last quote on a command, or 3rd-party shells
6541 such as the MKS Korn Shell or bash, where it should be "\"". The
6542 default is adjusted according the value of 'shell', to reduce the need
6543 to set this option by the user. See |dos-shell|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006544 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6545 security reasons.
6546
6547 *'shiftround'* *'sr'* *'noshiftround'* *'nosr'*
6548'shiftround' 'sr' boolean (default off)
6549 global
6550 {not in Vi}
6551 Round indent to multiple of 'shiftwidth'. Applies to > and <
6552 commands. CTRL-T and CTRL-D in Insert mode always round the indent to
6553 a multiple of 'shiftwidth' (this is Vi compatible).
6554 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
6555
6556 *'shiftwidth'* *'sw'*
6557'shiftwidth' 'sw' number (default 8)
6558 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006559 Number of spaces to use for each step of (auto)indent. Used for
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006560 |'cindent'|, |>>|, |<<|, etc.
Bram Moolenaar3a0d8092012-10-21 03:02:54 +02006561 When zero the 'ts' value will be used. Use the |shiftwidth()|
6562 function to get the effective shiftwidth value.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006563
6564 *'shortmess'* *'shm'*
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00006565'shortmess' 'shm' string (Vim default "filnxtToO", Vi default: "",
6566 POSIX default: "A")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006567 global
6568 {not in Vi}
6569 This option helps to avoid all the |hit-enter| prompts caused by file
6570 messages, for example with CTRL-G, and to avoid some other messages.
6571 It is a list of flags:
6572 flag meaning when present ~
6573 f use "(3 of 5)" instead of "(file 3 of 5)"
6574 i use "[noeol]" instead of "[Incomplete last line]"
6575 l use "999L, 888C" instead of "999 lines, 888 characters"
6576 m use "[+]" instead of "[Modified]"
6577 n use "[New]" instead of "[New File]"
6578 r use "[RO]" instead of "[readonly]"
6579 w use "[w]" instead of "written" for file write message
6580 and "[a]" instead of "appended" for ':w >> file' command
6581 x use "[dos]" instead of "[dos format]", "[unix]" instead of
6582 "[unix format]" and "[mac]" instead of "[mac format]".
6583 a all of the above abbreviations
6584
6585 o overwrite message for writing a file with subsequent message
6586 for reading a file (useful for ":wn" or when 'autowrite' on)
6587 O message for reading a file overwrites any previous message.
6588 Also for quickfix message (e.g., ":cn").
6589 s don't give "search hit BOTTOM, continuing at TOP" or "search
6590 hit TOP, continuing at BOTTOM" messages
6591 t truncate file message at the start if it is too long to fit
6592 on the command-line, "<" will appear in the left most column.
6593 Ignored in Ex mode.
6594 T truncate other messages in the middle if they are too long to
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00006595 fit on the command line. "..." will appear in the middle.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006596 Ignored in Ex mode.
6597 W don't give "written" or "[w]" when writing a file
6598 A don't give the "ATTENTION" message when an existing swap file
6599 is found.
6600 I don't give the intro message when starting Vim |:intro|.
Bram Moolenaarea389e92014-05-28 21:40:52 +02006601 c don't give |ins-completion-menu| messages. For example,
6602 "-- XXX completion (YYY)", "match 1 of 2", "The only match",
6603 "Pattern not found", "Back at original", etc.
Bram Moolenaar426dd022016-03-15 15:09:29 +01006604 q use "recording" instead of "recording @a"
6605 F don't give the file info when editing a file, like `:silent`
6606 was used for the command
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006607
6608 This gives you the opportunity to avoid that a change between buffers
6609 requires you to hit <Enter>, but still gives as useful a message as
6610 possible for the space available. To get the whole message that you
6611 would have got with 'shm' empty, use ":file!"
6612 Useful values:
6613 shm= No abbreviation of message.
6614 shm=a Abbreviation, but no loss of information.
6615 shm=at Abbreviation, and truncate message when necessary.
6616
6617 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
6618 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
6619
6620 *'shortname'* *'sn'* *'noshortname'* *'nosn'*
6621'shortname' 'sn' boolean (default off)
6622 local to buffer
6623 {not in Vi, not in MS-DOS versions}
6624 Filenames are assumed to be 8 characters plus one extension of 3
6625 characters. Multiple dots in file names are not allowed. When this
6626 option is on, dots in file names are replaced with underscores when
6627 adding an extension (".~" or ".swp"). This option is not available
6628 for MS-DOS, because then it would always be on. This option is useful
6629 when editing files on an MS-DOS compatible filesystem, e.g., messydos
6630 or crossdos. When running the Win32 GUI version under Win32s, this
6631 option is always on by default.
6632
6633 *'showbreak'* *'sbr'* *E595*
6634'showbreak' 'sbr' string (default "")
6635 global
6636 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02006637 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006638 feature}
6639 String to put at the start of lines that have been wrapped. Useful
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01006640 values are "> " or "+++ ": >
6641 :set showbreak=>\
6642< Note the backslash to escape the trailing space. It's easier like
6643 this: >
Bram Moolenaar1a384422010-07-14 19:53:30 +02006644 :let &showbreak = '+++ '
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01006645< Only printable single-cell characters are allowed, excluding <Tab> and
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006646 comma (in a future version the comma might be used to separate the
6647 part that is shown at the end and at the start of a line).
6648 The characters are highlighted according to the '@' flag in
6649 'highlight'.
6650 Note that tabs after the showbreak will be displayed differently.
6651 If you want the 'showbreak' to appear in between line numbers, add the
6652 "n" flag to 'cpoptions'.
6653
6654 *'showcmd'* *'sc'* *'noshowcmd'* *'nosc'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02006655'showcmd' 'sc' boolean (Vim default: on, off for Unix,
6656 Vi default: off, set in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006657 global
6658 {not in Vi}
6659 {not available when compiled without the
6660 |+cmdline_info| feature}
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00006661 Show (partial) command in the last line of the screen. Set this
6662 option off if your terminal is slow.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006663 In Visual mode the size of the selected area is shown:
6664 - When selecting characters within a line, the number of characters.
Bram Moolenaarf91787c2010-07-17 12:47:16 +02006665 If the number of bytes is different it is also displayed: "2-6"
6666 means two characters and six bytes.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006667 - When selecting more than one line, the number of lines.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01006668 - When selecting a block, the size in screen characters:
6669 {lines}x{columns}.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006670 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
6671 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
6672
6673 *'showfulltag'* *'sft'* *'noshowfulltag'* *'nosft'*
6674'showfulltag' 'sft' boolean (default off)
6675 global
6676 {not in Vi}
6677 When completing a word in insert mode (see |ins-completion|) from the
6678 tags file, show both the tag name and a tidied-up form of the search
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006679 pattern (if there is one) as possible matches. Thus, if you have
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006680 matched a C function, you can see a template for what arguments are
6681 required (coding style permitting).
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00006682 Note that this doesn't work well together with having "longest" in
6683 'completeopt', because the completion from the search pattern may not
6684 match the typed text.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006685
6686 *'showmatch'* *'sm'* *'noshowmatch'* *'nosm'*
6687'showmatch' 'sm' boolean (default off)
6688 global
6689 When a bracket is inserted, briefly jump to the matching one. The
6690 jump is only done if the match can be seen on the screen. The time to
6691 show the match can be set with 'matchtime'.
6692 A Beep is given if there is no match (no matter if the match can be
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02006693 seen or not).
6694 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is
6695 reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006696 When the 'm' flag is not included in 'cpoptions', typing a character
6697 will immediately move the cursor back to where it belongs.
6698 See the "sm" field in 'guicursor' for setting the cursor shape and
6699 blinking when showing the match.
6700 The 'matchpairs' option can be used to specify the characters to show
6701 matches for. 'rightleft' and 'revins' are used to look for opposite
6702 matches.
Bram Moolenaarfd2ac762006-03-01 22:09:21 +00006703 Also see the matchparen plugin for highlighting the match when moving
6704 around |pi_paren.txt|.
6705 Note: Use of the short form is rated PG.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006706
6707 *'showmode'* *'smd'* *'noshowmode'* *'nosmd'*
6708'showmode' 'smd' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
6709 global
6710 If in Insert, Replace or Visual mode put a message on the last line.
6711 Use the 'M' flag in 'highlight' to set the type of highlighting for
6712 this message.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006713 When |XIM| may be used the message will include "XIM". But this
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006714 doesn't mean XIM is really active, especially when 'imactivatekey' is
6715 not set.
6716 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
6717 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
6718
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00006719 *'showtabline'* *'stal'*
6720'showtabline' 'stal' number (default 1)
6721 global
6722 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02006723 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00006724 feature}
6725 The value of this option specifies when the line with tab page labels
6726 will be displayed:
6727 0: never
6728 1: only if there are at least two tab pages
6729 2: always
6730 This is both for the GUI and non-GUI implementation of the tab pages
6731 line.
6732 See |tab-page| for more information about tab pages.
6733
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006734 *'sidescroll'* *'ss'*
6735'sidescroll' 'ss' number (default 0)
6736 global
6737 {not in Vi}
6738 The minimal number of columns to scroll horizontally. Used only when
6739 the 'wrap' option is off and the cursor is moved off of the screen.
6740 When it is zero the cursor will be put in the middle of the screen.
6741 When using a slow terminal set it to a large number or 0. When using
6742 a fast terminal use a small number or 1. Not used for "zh" and "zl"
6743 commands.
6744
6745 *'sidescrolloff'* *'siso'*
6746'sidescrolloff' 'siso' number (default 0)
6747 global
6748 {not in Vi}
6749 The minimal number of screen columns to keep to the left and to the
Bram Moolenaar482aaeb2005-09-29 18:26:07 +00006750 right of the cursor if 'nowrap' is set. Setting this option to a
6751 value greater than 0 while having |'sidescroll'| also at a non-zero
6752 value makes some context visible in the line you are scrolling in
6753 horizontally (except at beginning of the line). Setting this option
6754 to a large value (like 999) has the effect of keeping the cursor
6755 horizontally centered in the window, as long as one does not come too
6756 close to the beginning of the line.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006757 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
6758
6759 Example: Try this together with 'sidescroll' and 'listchars' as
6760 in the following example to never allow the cursor to move
Bram Moolenaar95ec9d62016-08-12 18:29:59 +02006761 onto the "extends" character: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006762
6763 :set nowrap sidescroll=1 listchars=extends:>,precedes:<
6764 :set sidescrolloff=1
Bram Moolenaar95ec9d62016-08-12 18:29:59 +02006765<
6766 *'signcolumn'* *'scl'*
6767'signcolumn' 'scl' string (default "auto")
6768 local to window
6769 {not in Vi}
6770 {not available when compiled without the |+signs|
6771 feature}
Bram Moolenaar09521312016-08-12 22:54:35 +02006772 Whether or not to draw the signcolumn. Valid values are:
6773 "auto" only when there is a sign to display
6774 "no" never
6775 "yes" always
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006776
6777
6778 *'smartcase'* *'scs'* *'nosmartcase'* *'noscs'*
6779'smartcase' 'scs' boolean (default off)
6780 global
6781 {not in Vi}
6782 Override the 'ignorecase' option if the search pattern contains upper
6783 case characters. Only used when the search pattern is typed and
6784 'ignorecase' option is on. Used for the commands "/", "?", "n", "N",
Bram Moolenaarc8734422012-06-01 22:38:45 +02006785 ":g" and ":s". Not used for "*", "#", "gd", tag search, etc. After
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006786 "*" and "#" you can make 'smartcase' used by doing a "/" command,
6787 recalling the search pattern from history and hitting <Enter>.
6788 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
6789
6790 *'smartindent'* *'si'* *'nosmartindent'* *'nosi'*
6791'smartindent' 'si' boolean (default off)
6792 local to buffer
6793 {not in Vi}
6794 {not available when compiled without the
6795 |+smartindent| feature}
6796 Do smart autoindenting when starting a new line. Works for C-like
6797 programs, but can also be used for other languages. 'cindent' does
6798 something like this, works better in most cases, but is more strict,
Bram Moolenaar81af9252010-12-10 20:35:50 +01006799 see |C-indenting|. When 'cindent' is on or 'indentexpr' is set,
Bram Moolenaar166af9b2010-11-16 20:34:40 +01006800 setting 'si' has no effect. 'indentexpr' is a more advanced
6801 alternative.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006802 Normally 'autoindent' should also be on when using 'smartindent'.
6803 An indent is automatically inserted:
6804 - After a line ending in '{'.
6805 - After a line starting with a keyword from 'cinwords'.
6806 - Before a line starting with '}' (only with the "O" command).
6807 When typing '}' as the first character in a new line, that line is
6808 given the same indent as the matching '{'.
6809 When typing '#' as the first character in a new line, the indent for
6810 that line is removed, the '#' is put in the first column. The indent
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006811 is restored for the next line. If you don't want this, use this
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006812 mapping: ":inoremap # X^H#", where ^H is entered with CTRL-V CTRL-H.
6813 When using the ">>" command, lines starting with '#' are not shifted
6814 right.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02006815 NOTE: 'smartindent' is reset when 'compatible' is set.
6816 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is
6817 reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006818
6819 *'smarttab'* *'sta'* *'nosmarttab'* *'nosta'*
6820'smarttab' 'sta' boolean (default off)
6821 global
6822 {not in Vi}
6823 When on, a <Tab> in front of a line inserts blanks according to
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00006824 'shiftwidth'. 'tabstop' or 'softtabstop' is used in other places. A
6825 <BS> will delete a 'shiftwidth' worth of space at the start of the
6826 line.
Bram Moolenaarafeb4fa2006-02-01 21:51:12 +00006827 When off, a <Tab> always inserts blanks according to 'tabstop' or
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00006828 'softtabstop'. 'shiftwidth' is only used for shifting text left or
6829 right |shift-left-right|.
Bram Moolenaarebcbd022007-05-12 14:28:25 +00006830 What gets inserted (a <Tab> or spaces) depends on the 'expandtab'
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006831 option. Also see |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the
Bram Moolenaar843ee412004-06-30 16:16:41 +00006832 number of spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02006833 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is
6834 reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006835 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
6836
6837 *'softtabstop'* *'sts'*
6838'softtabstop' 'sts' number (default 0)
6839 local to buffer
6840 {not in Vi}
6841 Number of spaces that a <Tab> counts for while performing editing
6842 operations, like inserting a <Tab> or using <BS>. It "feels" like
6843 <Tab>s are being inserted, while in fact a mix of spaces and <Tab>s is
6844 used. This is useful to keep the 'ts' setting at its standard value
6845 of 8, while being able to edit like it is set to 'sts'. However,
6846 commands like "x" still work on the actual characters.
6847 When 'sts' is zero, this feature is off.
Bram Moolenaar3a0d8092012-10-21 03:02:54 +02006848 When 'sts' is negative, the value of 'shiftwidth' is used.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02006849 'softtabstop' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set and restored
6850 when 'paste' is reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006851 See also |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the number of
6852 spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s.
6853 The 'L' flag in 'cpoptions' changes how tabs are used when 'list' is
6854 set.
6855 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
6856
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00006857 *'spell'* *'nospell'*
6858'spell' boolean (default off)
6859 local to window
6860 {not in Vi}
6861 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
6862 feature}
6863 When on spell checking will be done. See |spell|.
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00006864 The languages are specified with 'spelllang'.
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00006865
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00006866 *'spellcapcheck'* *'spc'*
Bram Moolenaar0dc065e2005-07-04 22:49:24 +00006867'spellcapcheck' 'spc' string (default "[.?!]\_[\])'" \t]\+")
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00006868 local to buffer
6869 {not in Vi}
6870 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
6871 feature}
6872 Pattern to locate the end of a sentence. The following word will be
6873 checked to start with a capital letter. If not then it is highlighted
Bram Moolenaar8aff23a2005-08-19 20:40:30 +00006874 with SpellCap |hl-SpellCap| (unless the word is also badly spelled).
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00006875 When this check is not wanted make this option empty.
6876 Only used when 'spell' is set.
Bram Moolenaar0dc065e2005-07-04 22:49:24 +00006877 Be careful with special characters, see |option-backslash| about
6878 including spaces and backslashes.
Bram Moolenaar90cfdbe2005-08-12 19:59:19 +00006879 To set this option automatically depending on the language, see
6880 |set-spc-auto|.
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00006881
Bram Moolenaar82cf9b62005-06-07 21:09:25 +00006882 *'spellfile'* *'spf'*
6883'spellfile' 'spf' string (default empty)
6884 local to buffer
6885 {not in Vi}
6886 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
6887 feature}
6888 Name of the word list file where words are added for the |zg| and |zw|
Bram Moolenaar045e82d2005-07-08 22:25:33 +00006889 commands. It must end in ".{encoding}.add". You need to include the
6890 path, otherwise the file is placed in the current directory.
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00006891 *E765*
6892 It may also be a comma separated list of names. A count before the
6893 |zg| and |zw| commands can be used to access each. This allows using
6894 a personal word list file and a project word list file.
Bram Moolenaar82cf9b62005-06-07 21:09:25 +00006895 When a word is added while this option is empty Vim will set it for
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00006896 you: Using the first directory in 'runtimepath' that is writable. If
6897 there is no "spell" directory yet it will be created. For the file
6898 name the first language name that appears in 'spelllang' is used,
Bram Moolenaar3b506942005-06-23 22:36:45 +00006899 ignoring the region.
6900 The resulting ".spl" file will be used for spell checking, it does not
6901 have to appear in 'spelllang'.
6902 Normally one file is used for all regions, but you can add the region
6903 name if you want to. However, it will then only be used when
6904 'spellfile' is set to it, for entries in 'spelllang' only files
6905 without region name will be found.
Bram Moolenaare7566042005-06-17 22:00:15 +00006906 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6907 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar82cf9b62005-06-07 21:09:25 +00006908
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00006909 *'spelllang'* *'spl'*
Bram Moolenaar82cf9b62005-06-07 21:09:25 +00006910'spelllang' 'spl' string (default "en")
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00006911 local to buffer
6912 {not in Vi}
6913 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
6914 feature}
Bram Moolenaar3b506942005-06-23 22:36:45 +00006915 A comma separated list of word list names. When the 'spell' option is
6916 on spellchecking will be done for these languages. Example: >
6917 set spelllang=en_us,nl,medical
6918< This means US English, Dutch and medical words are recognized. Words
6919 that are not recognized will be highlighted.
6920 The word list name must not include a comma or dot. Using a dash is
6921 recommended to separate the two letter language name from a
6922 specification. Thus "en-rare" is used for rare English words.
6923 A region name must come last and have the form "_xx", where "xx" is
6924 the two-letter, lower case region name. You can use more than one
6925 region by listing them: "en_us,en_ca" supports both US and Canadian
6926 English, but not words specific for Australia, New Zealand or Great
Bram Moolenaarfa735342016-01-03 22:14:44 +01006927 Britain. (Note: currently en_au and en_nz dictionaries are older than
6928 en_ca, en_gb and en_us).
Bram Moolenaarcc63c642013-11-12 04:44:01 +01006929 If the name "cjk" is included East Asian characters are excluded from
6930 spell checking. This is useful when editing text that also has Asian
6931 words.
Bram Moolenaar8aff23a2005-08-19 20:40:30 +00006932 *E757*
Bram Moolenaarce0842a2005-07-18 21:58:11 +00006933 As a special case the name of a .spl file can be given as-is. The
6934 first "_xx" in the name is removed and used as the region name
6935 (_xx is an underscore, two letters and followed by a non-letter).
6936 This is mainly for testing purposes. You must make sure the correct
6937 encoding is used, Vim doesn't check it.
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00006938 When 'encoding' is set the word lists are reloaded. Thus it's a good
Bram Moolenaarce0842a2005-07-18 21:58:11 +00006939 idea to set 'spelllang' after setting 'encoding' to avoid loading the
6940 files twice.
Bram Moolenaar3b506942005-06-23 22:36:45 +00006941 How the related spell files are found is explained here: |spell-load|.
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00006942
Bram Moolenaar98692072006-02-04 00:57:42 +00006943 If the |spellfile.vim| plugin is active and you use a language name
6944 for which Vim cannot find the .spl file in 'runtimepath' the plugin
6945 will ask you if you want to download the file.
6946
Bram Moolenaar90cfdbe2005-08-12 19:59:19 +00006947 After this option has been set successfully, Vim will source the files
6948 "spell/LANG.vim" in 'runtimepath'. "LANG" is the value of 'spelllang'
Bram Moolenaarafeb4fa2006-02-01 21:51:12 +00006949 up to the first comma, dot or underscore.
6950 Also see |set-spc-auto|.
Bram Moolenaar90cfdbe2005-08-12 19:59:19 +00006951
6952
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00006953 *'spellsuggest'* *'sps'*
6954'spellsuggest' 'sps' string (default "best")
6955 global
6956 {not in Vi}
6957 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
6958 feature}
Bram Moolenaar2c7a29c2005-12-12 22:02:31 +00006959 Methods used for spelling suggestions. Both for the |z=| command and
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00006960 the |spellsuggest()| function. This is a comma-separated list of
6961 items:
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00006962
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00006963 best Internal method that works best for English. Finds
6964 changes like "fast" and uses a bit of sound-a-like
6965 scoring to improve the ordering.
6966
6967 double Internal method that uses two methods and mixes the
6968 results. The first method is "fast", the other method
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00006969 computes how much the suggestion sounds like the bad
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00006970 word. That only works when the language specifies
6971 sound folding. Can be slow and doesn't always give
6972 better results.
6973
6974 fast Internal method that only checks for simple changes:
6975 character inserts/deletes/swaps. Works well for
6976 simple typing mistakes.
6977
Bram Moolenaar2c7a29c2005-12-12 22:02:31 +00006978 {number} The maximum number of suggestions listed for |z=|.
Bram Moolenaar8aff23a2005-08-19 20:40:30 +00006979 Not used for |spellsuggest()|. The number of
6980 suggestions is never more than the value of 'lines'
6981 minus two.
6982
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00006983 file:{filename} Read file {filename}, which must have two columns,
6984 separated by a slash. The first column contains the
6985 bad word, the second column the suggested good word.
6986 Example:
6987 theribal/terrible ~
6988 Use this for common mistakes that do not appear at the
6989 top of the suggestion list with the internal methods.
6990 Lines without a slash are ignored, use this for
6991 comments.
Bram Moolenaarbcb98982014-05-01 14:08:19 +02006992 The word in the second column must be correct,
6993 otherwise it will not be used. Add the word to an
6994 ".add" file if it is currently flagged as a spelling
6995 mistake.
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00006996 The file is used for all languages.
6997
6998 expr:{expr} Evaluate expression {expr}. Use a function to avoid
6999 trouble with spaces. |v:val| holds the badly spelled
7000 word. The expression must evaluate to a List of
7001 Lists, each with a suggestion and a score.
7002 Example:
7003 [['the', 33], ['that', 44]]
Bram Moolenaar2c7a29c2005-12-12 22:02:31 +00007004 Set 'verbose' and use |z=| to see the scores that the
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00007005 internal methods use. A lower score is better.
7006 This may invoke |spellsuggest()| if you temporarily
7007 set 'spellsuggest' to exclude the "expr:" part.
7008 Errors are silently ignored, unless you set the
7009 'verbose' option to a non-zero value.
7010
7011 Only one of "best", "double" or "fast" may be used. The others may
7012 appear several times in any order. Example: >
7013 :set sps=file:~/.vim/sugg,best,expr:MySuggest()
7014<
7015 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
7016 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00007017
7018
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007019 *'splitbelow'* *'sb'* *'nosplitbelow'* *'nosb'*
7020'splitbelow' 'sb' boolean (default off)
7021 global
7022 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02007023 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007024 feature}
7025 When on, splitting a window will put the new window below the current
7026 one. |:split|
7027
7028 *'splitright'* *'spr'* *'nosplitright'* *'nospr'*
7029'splitright' 'spr' boolean (default off)
7030 global
7031 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02007032 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007033 feature}
7034 When on, splitting a window will put the new window right of the
7035 current one. |:vsplit|
7036
7037 *'startofline'* *'sol'* *'nostartofline'* *'nosol'*
7038'startofline' 'sol' boolean (default on)
7039 global
7040 {not in Vi}
7041 When "on" the commands listed below move the cursor to the first
Bram Moolenaar843ee412004-06-30 16:16:41 +00007042 non-blank of the line. When off the cursor is kept in the same column
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007043 (if possible). This applies to the commands: CTRL-D, CTRL-U, CTRL-B,
Bram Moolenaar843ee412004-06-30 16:16:41 +00007044 CTRL-F, "G", "H", "M", "L", gg, and to the commands "d", "<<" and ">>"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007045 with a linewise operator, with "%" with a count and to buffer changing
7046 commands (CTRL-^, :bnext, :bNext, etc.). Also for an Ex command that
7047 only has a line number, e.g., ":25" or ":+".
7048 In case of buffer changing commands the cursor is placed at the column
7049 where it was the last time the buffer was edited.
7050 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set.
7051
Bram Moolenaar00654022011-02-25 14:42:19 +01007052 *'statusline'* *'stl'* *E540* *E542*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007053'statusline' 'stl' string (default empty)
Bram Moolenaarb5bf5b82004-12-24 14:35:23 +00007054 global or local to window |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007055 {not in Vi}
7056 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline|
7057 feature}
7058 When nonempty, this option determines the content of the status line.
7059 Also see |status-line|.
7060
7061 The option consists of printf style '%' items interspersed with
7062 normal text. Each status line item is of the form:
7063 %-0{minwid}.{maxwid}{item}
Bram Moolenaar5e9b2fa2016-02-01 22:37:05 +01007064 All fields except the {item} are optional. A single percent sign can
Bram Moolenaar00654022011-02-25 14:42:19 +01007065 be given as "%%". Up to 80 items can be specified. *E541*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007066
Bram Moolenaar238a5642006-02-21 22:12:05 +00007067 When the option starts with "%!" then it is used as an expression,
7068 evaluated and the result is used as the option value. Example: >
7069 :set statusline=%!MyStatusLine()
7070< The result can contain %{} items that will be evaluated too.
Bram Moolenaar61d35bd2012-03-28 20:51:51 +02007071 Note that the "%!" expression is evaluated in the context of the
7072 current window and buffer, while %{} items are evaluated in the
7073 context of the window that the statusline belongs to.
Bram Moolenaar238a5642006-02-21 22:12:05 +00007074
7075 When there is error while evaluating the option then it will be made
7076 empty to avoid further errors. Otherwise screen updating would loop.
7077
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007078 Note that the only effect of 'ruler' when this option is set (and
7079 'laststatus' is 2) is controlling the output of |CTRL-G|.
7080
7081 field meaning ~
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007082 - Left justify the item. The default is right justified
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007083 when minwid is larger than the length of the item.
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007084 0 Leading zeroes in numeric items. Overridden by '-'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007085 minwid Minimum width of the item, padding as set by '-' & '0'.
7086 Value must be 50 or less.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007087 maxwid Maximum width of the item. Truncation occurs with a '<'
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007088 on the left for text items. Numeric items will be
7089 shifted down to maxwid-2 digits followed by '>'number
7090 where number is the amount of missing digits, much like
7091 an exponential notation.
7092 item A one letter code as described below.
7093
7094 Following is a description of the possible statusline items. The
7095 second character in "item" is the type:
7096 N for number
7097 S for string
7098 F for flags as described below
7099 - not applicable
7100
7101 item meaning ~
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00007102 f S Path to the file in the buffer, as typed or relative to current
7103 directory.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007104 F S Full path to the file in the buffer.
7105 t S File name (tail) of file in the buffer.
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00007106 m F Modified flag, text is "[+]"; "[-]" if 'modifiable' is off.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007107 M F Modified flag, text is ",+" or ",-".
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00007108 r F Readonly flag, text is "[RO]".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007109 R F Readonly flag, text is ",RO".
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00007110 h F Help buffer flag, text is "[help]".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007111 H F Help buffer flag, text is ",HLP".
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00007112 w F Preview window flag, text is "[Preview]".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007113 W F Preview window flag, text is ",PRV".
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00007114 y F Type of file in the buffer, e.g., "[vim]". See 'filetype'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007115 Y F Type of file in the buffer, e.g., ",VIM". See 'filetype'.
7116 {not available when compiled without |+autocmd| feature}
Bram Moolenaar7fd73202010-07-25 16:58:46 +02007117 q S "[Quickfix List]", "[Location List]" or empty.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007118 k S Value of "b:keymap_name" or 'keymap' when |:lmap| mappings are
7119 being used: "<keymap>"
7120 n N Buffer number.
Bram Moolenaar00654022011-02-25 14:42:19 +01007121 b N Value of character under cursor.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007122 B N As above, in hexadecimal.
7123 o N Byte number in file of byte under cursor, first byte is 1.
7124 Mnemonic: Offset from start of file (with one added)
7125 {not available when compiled without |+byte_offset| feature}
7126 O N As above, in hexadecimal.
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007127 N N Printer page number. (Only works in the 'printheader' option.)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007128 l N Line number.
7129 L N Number of lines in buffer.
7130 c N Column number.
7131 v N Virtual column number.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007132 V N Virtual column number as -{num}. Not displayed if equal to 'c'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007133 p N Percentage through file in lines as in |CTRL-G|.
7134 P S Percentage through file of displayed window. This is like the
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +02007135 percentage described for 'ruler'. Always 3 in length, unless
7136 translated.
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007137 a S Argument list status as in default title. ({current} of {max})
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007138 Empty if the argument file count is zero or one.
Bram Moolenaar238a5642006-02-21 22:12:05 +00007139 { NF Evaluate expression between '%{' and '}' and substitute result.
Bram Moolenaar4770d092006-01-12 23:22:24 +00007140 Note that there is no '%' before the closing '}'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007141 ( - Start of item group. Can be used for setting the width and
7142 alignment of a section. Must be followed by %) somewhere.
7143 ) - End of item group. No width fields allowed.
Bram Moolenaard1f56e62006-02-22 21:25:37 +00007144 T N For 'tabline': start of tab page N label. Use %T after the last
7145 label. This information is used for mouse clicks.
7146 X N For 'tabline': start of close tab N label. Use %X after the
7147 label, e.g.: %3Xclose%X. Use %999X for a "close current tab"
7148 mark. This information is used for mouse clicks.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007149 < - Where to truncate line if too long. Default is at the start.
7150 No width fields allowed.
7151 = - Separation point between left and right aligned items.
7152 No width fields allowed.
Bram Moolenaar238a5642006-02-21 22:12:05 +00007153 # - Set highlight group. The name must follow and then a # again.
7154 Thus use %#HLname# for highlight group HLname. The same
7155 highlighting is used, also for the statusline of non-current
7156 windows.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007157 * - Set highlight group to User{N}, where {N} is taken from the
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007158 minwid field, e.g. %1*. Restore normal highlight with %* or %0*.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007159 The difference between User{N} and StatusLine will be applied
7160 to StatusLineNC for the statusline of non-current windows.
7161 The number N must be between 1 and 9. See |hl-User1..9|
7162
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00007163 When displaying a flag, Vim removes the leading comma, if any, when
7164 that flag comes right after plaintext. This will make a nice display
7165 when flags are used like in the examples below.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007166
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007167 When all items in a group becomes an empty string (i.e. flags that are
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007168 not set) and a minwid is not set for the group, the whole group will
7169 become empty. This will make a group like the following disappear
7170 completely from the statusline when none of the flags are set. >
7171 :set statusline=...%(\ [%M%R%H]%)...
Bram Moolenaare392eb42015-11-19 20:38:09 +01007172< *g:actual_curbuf*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007173 Beware that an expression is evaluated each and every time the status
7174 line is displayed. The current buffer and current window will be set
7175 temporarily to that of the window (and buffer) whose statusline is
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007176 currently being drawn. The expression will evaluate in this context.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007177 The variable "actual_curbuf" is set to the 'bufnr()' number of the
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00007178 real current buffer.
7179
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02007180 The 'statusline' option will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from
7181 a modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00007182
7183 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
7184 evaluating 'statusline' |textlock|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007185
7186 If the statusline is not updated when you want it (e.g., after setting
7187 a variable that's used in an expression), you can force an update by
7188 setting an option without changing its value. Example: >
7189 :let &ro = &ro
7190
7191< A result of all digits is regarded a number for display purposes.
7192 Otherwise the result is taken as flag text and applied to the rules
7193 described above.
7194
Bram Moolenaarcd71fa32005-03-11 22:46:48 +00007195 Watch out for errors in expressions. They may render Vim unusable!
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007196 If you are stuck, hold down ':' or 'Q' to get a prompt, then quit and
7197 edit your .vimrc or whatever with "vim -u NONE" to get it right.
7198
7199 Examples:
7200 Emulate standard status line with 'ruler' set >
7201 :set statusline=%<%f\ %h%m%r%=%-14.(%l,%c%V%)\ %P
7202< Similar, but add ASCII value of char under the cursor (like "ga") >
7203 :set statusline=%<%f%h%m%r%=%b\ 0x%B\ \ %l,%c%V\ %P
7204< Display byte count and byte value, modified flag in red. >
7205 :set statusline=%<%f%=\ [%1*%M%*%n%R%H]\ %-19(%3l,%02c%03V%)%O'%02b'
7206 :hi User1 term=inverse,bold cterm=inverse,bold ctermfg=red
7207< Display a ,GZ flag if a compressed file is loaded >
7208 :set statusline=...%r%{VarExists('b:gzflag','\ [GZ]')}%h...
7209< In the |:autocmd|'s: >
7210 :let b:gzflag = 1
7211< And: >
7212 :unlet b:gzflag
7213< And define this function: >
7214 :function VarExists(var, val)
7215 : if exists(a:var) | return a:val | else | return '' | endif
7216 :endfunction
7217<
7218 *'suffixes'* *'su'*
7219'suffixes' 'su' string (default ".bak,~,.o,.h,.info,.swp,.obj")
7220 global
7221 {not in Vi}
7222 Files with these suffixes get a lower priority when multiple files
7223 match a wildcard. See |suffixes|. Commas can be used to separate the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007224 suffixes. Spaces after the comma are ignored. A dot is also seen as
7225 the start of a suffix. To avoid a dot or comma being recognized as a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007226 separator, precede it with a backslash (see |option-backslash| about
7227 including spaces and backslashes).
7228 See 'wildignore' for completely ignoring files.
7229 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
7230 suffixes from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
7231 uses another default.
7232
7233 *'suffixesadd'* *'sua'*
7234'suffixesadd' 'sua' string (default "")
7235 local to buffer
7236 {not in Vi}
7237 {not available when compiled without the
7238 |+file_in_path| feature}
7239 Comma separated list of suffixes, which are used when searching for a
7240 file for the "gf", "[I", etc. commands. Example: >
7241 :set suffixesadd=.java
7242<
7243 *'swapfile'* *'swf'* *'noswapfile'* *'noswf'*
7244'swapfile' 'swf' boolean (default on)
7245 local to buffer
7246 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007247 Use a swapfile for the buffer. This option can be reset when a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007248 swapfile is not wanted for a specific buffer. For example, with
7249 confidential information that even root must not be able to access.
7250 Careful: All text will be in memory:
7251 - Don't use this for big files.
7252 - Recovery will be impossible!
7253 A swapfile will only be present when |'updatecount'| is non-zero and
7254 'swapfile' is set.
7255 When 'swapfile' is reset, the swap file for the current buffer is
7256 immediately deleted. When 'swapfile' is set, and 'updatecount' is
7257 non-zero, a swap file is immediately created.
7258 Also see |swap-file| and |'swapsync'|.
Bram Moolenaar76f3b1a2014-03-27 22:30:07 +01007259 If you want to open a new buffer without creating a swap file for it,
7260 use the |:noswapfile| modifier.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007261
7262 This option is used together with 'bufhidden' and 'buftype' to
7263 specify special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
7264
7265 *'swapsync'* *'sws'*
7266'swapsync' 'sws' string (default "fsync")
7267 global
7268 {not in Vi}
7269 When this option is not empty a swap file is synced to disk after
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007270 writing to it. This takes some time, especially on busy unix systems.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007271 When this option is empty parts of the swap file may be in memory and
7272 not written to disk. When the system crashes you may lose more work.
7273 On Unix the system does a sync now and then without Vim asking for it,
7274 so the disadvantage of setting this option off is small. On some
7275 systems the swap file will not be written at all. For a unix system
7276 setting it to "sync" will use the sync() call instead of the default
7277 fsync(), which may work better on some systems.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00007278 The 'fsync' option is used for the actual file.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007279
7280 *'switchbuf'* *'swb'*
7281'switchbuf' 'swb' string (default "")
7282 global
7283 {not in Vi}
7284 This option controls the behavior when switching between buffers.
7285 Possible values (comma separated list):
7286 useopen If included, jump to the first open window that
7287 contains the specified buffer (if there is one).
7288 Otherwise: Do not examine other windows.
7289 This setting is checked with |quickfix| commands, when
7290 jumping to errors (":cc", ":cn", "cp", etc.). It is
7291 also used in all buffer related split commands, for
7292 example ":sbuffer", ":sbnext", or ":sbrewind".
Bram Moolenaar779b74b2006-04-10 14:55:34 +00007293 usetab Like "useopen", but also consider windows in other tab
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00007294 pages.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007295 split If included, split the current window before loading
Bram Moolenaar15146672011-10-20 22:22:38 +02007296 a buffer for a |quickfix| command that display errors.
7297 Otherwise: do not split, use current window.
Bram Moolenaara594d772015-06-19 14:41:49 +02007298 vsplit Just like "split" but split vertically.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00007299 newtab Like "split", but open a new tab page. Overrules
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02007300 "split" when both are present.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007301
Bram Moolenaar3b56eb32005-07-11 22:40:32 +00007302 *'synmaxcol'* *'smc'*
7303'synmaxcol' 'smc' number (default 3000)
7304 local to buffer
7305 {not in Vi}
7306 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7307 feature}
Bram Moolenaarce0842a2005-07-18 21:58:11 +00007308 Maximum column in which to search for syntax items. In long lines the
7309 text after this column is not highlighted and following lines may not
7310 be highlighted correctly, because the syntax state is cleared.
Bram Moolenaar3b56eb32005-07-11 22:40:32 +00007311 This helps to avoid very slow redrawing for an XML file that is one
7312 long line.
7313 Set to zero to remove the limit.
7314
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007315 *'syntax'* *'syn'*
7316'syntax' 'syn' string (default empty)
7317 local to buffer
7318 {not in Vi}
7319 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7320 feature}
7321 When this option is set, the syntax with this name is loaded, unless
7322 syntax highlighting has been switched off with ":syntax off".
7323 Otherwise this option does not always reflect the current syntax (the
7324 b:current_syntax variable does).
7325 This option is most useful in a modeline, for a file which syntax is
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00007326 not automatically recognized. Example, in an IDL file:
7327 /* vim: set syntax=idl : */ ~
7328 When a dot appears in the value then this separates two filetype
7329 names. Example:
7330 /* vim: set syntax=c.doxygen : */ ~
7331 This will use the "c" syntax first, then the "doxygen" syntax.
7332 Note that the second one must be prepared to be loaded as an addition,
7333 otherwise it will be skipped. More than one dot may appear.
7334 To switch off syntax highlighting for the current file, use: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007335 :set syntax=OFF
7336< To switch syntax highlighting on according to the current value of the
7337 'filetype' option: >
7338 :set syntax=ON
7339< What actually happens when setting the 'syntax' option is that the
7340 Syntax autocommand event is triggered with the value as argument.
7341 This option is not copied to another buffer, independent of the 's' or
7342 'S' flag in 'cpoptions'.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00007343 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007344
Bram Moolenaarfd2ac762006-03-01 22:09:21 +00007345 *'tabline'* *'tal'*
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00007346'tabline' 'tal' string (default empty)
Bram Moolenaar7e8fd632006-02-18 22:14:51 +00007347 global
7348 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02007349 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
Bram Moolenaar7e8fd632006-02-18 22:14:51 +00007350 feature}
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00007351 When nonempty, this option determines the content of the tab pages
7352 line at the top of the Vim window. When empty Vim will use a default
Bram Moolenaard1f56e62006-02-22 21:25:37 +00007353 tab pages line. See |setting-tabline| for more info.
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00007354
7355 The tab pages line only appears as specified with the 'showtabline'
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00007356 option and only when there is no GUI tab line. When 'e' is in
7357 'guioptions' and the GUI supports a tab line 'guitablabel' is used
Bram Moolenaar7f036442010-08-15 15:24:20 +02007358 instead. Note that the two tab pages lines are very different.
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00007359
7360 The value is evaluated like with 'statusline'. You can use
7361 |tabpagenr()|, |tabpagewinnr()| and |tabpagebuflist()| to figure out
Bram Moolenaard1f56e62006-02-22 21:25:37 +00007362 the text to be displayed. Use "%1T" for the first label, "%2T" for
7363 the second one, etc. Use "%X" items for closing labels.
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00007364
7365 Keep in mind that only one of the tab pages is the current one, others
7366 are invisible and you can't jump to their windows.
7367
Bram Moolenaar7e8fd632006-02-18 22:14:51 +00007368
Bram Moolenaarfd2ac762006-03-01 22:09:21 +00007369 *'tabpagemax'* *'tpm'*
7370'tabpagemax' 'tpm' number (default 10)
7371 global
7372 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02007373 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
Bram Moolenaarfd2ac762006-03-01 22:09:21 +00007374 feature}
7375 Maximum number of tab pages to be opened by the |-p| command line
7376 argument or the ":tab all" command. |tabpage|
7377
7378
7379 *'tabstop'* *'ts'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007380'tabstop' 'ts' number (default 8)
7381 local to buffer
7382 Number of spaces that a <Tab> in the file counts for. Also see
7383 |:retab| command, and 'softtabstop' option.
7384
7385 Note: Setting 'tabstop' to any other value than 8 can make your file
7386 appear wrong in many places (e.g., when printing it).
7387
7388 There are four main ways to use tabs in Vim:
7389 1. Always keep 'tabstop' at 8, set 'softtabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to 4
7390 (or 3 or whatever you prefer) and use 'noexpandtab'. Then Vim
Bram Moolenaarebcbd022007-05-12 14:28:25 +00007391 will use a mix of tabs and spaces, but typing <Tab> and <BS> will
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007392 behave like a tab appears every 4 (or 3) characters.
7393 2. Set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use
7394 'expandtab'. This way you will always insert spaces. The
7395 formatting will never be messed up when 'tabstop' is changed.
7396 3. Set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use a
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007397 |modeline| to set these values when editing the file again. Only
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007398 works when using Vim to edit the file.
7399 4. Always set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to the same value, and
7400 'noexpandtab'. This should then work (for initial indents only)
7401 for any tabstop setting that people use. It might be nice to have
7402 tabs after the first non-blank inserted as spaces if you do this
7403 though. Otherwise aligned comments will be wrong when 'tabstop' is
7404 changed.
7405
7406 *'tagbsearch'* *'tbs'* *'notagbsearch'* *'notbs'*
7407'tagbsearch' 'tbs' boolean (default on)
7408 global
7409 {not in Vi}
7410 When searching for a tag (e.g., for the |:ta| command), Vim can either
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007411 use a binary search or a linear search in a tags file. Binary
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007412 searching makes searching for a tag a LOT faster, but a linear search
7413 will find more tags if the tags file wasn't properly sorted.
7414 Vim normally assumes that your tags files are sorted, or indicate that
7415 they are not sorted. Only when this is not the case does the
7416 'tagbsearch' option need to be switched off.
7417
7418 When 'tagbsearch' is on, binary searching is first used in the tags
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007419 files. In certain situations, Vim will do a linear search instead for
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007420 certain files, or retry all files with a linear search. When
7421 'tagbsearch' is off, only a linear search is done.
7422
7423 Linear searching is done anyway, for one file, when Vim finds a line
7424 at the start of the file indicating that it's not sorted: >
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00007425 !_TAG_FILE_SORTED 0 /some comment/
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007426< [The whitespace before and after the '0' must be a single <Tab>]
7427
7428 When a binary search was done and no match was found in any of the
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01007429 files listed in 'tags', and case is ignored or a pattern is used
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007430 instead of a normal tag name, a retry is done with a linear search.
7431 Tags in unsorted tags files, and matches with different case will only
7432 be found in the retry.
7433
Bram Moolenaard4755bb2004-09-02 19:12:26 +00007434 If a tag file indicates that it is case-fold sorted, the second,
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01007435 linear search can be avoided when case is ignored. Use a value of '2'
7436 in the "!_TAG_FILE_SORTED" line for this. A tag file can be case-fold
7437 sorted with the -f switch to "sort" in most unices, as in the command:
7438 "sort -f -o tags tags". For "Exuberant ctags" version 5.x or higher
7439 (at least 5.5) the --sort=foldcase switch can be used for this as
7440 well. Note that case must be folded to uppercase for this to work.
7441
7442 By default, tag searches are case-sensitive. Case is ignored when
7443 'ignorecase' is set and 'tagcase' is "followic", or when 'tagcase' is
7444 "ignore".
Bram Moolenaar66e29d72016-08-20 16:57:02 +02007445 Also when 'tagcase' is "followscs" and 'smartcase' is set, or
7446 'tagcase' is "smart", and the pattern contains only lowercase
7447 characters.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007448
7449 When 'tagbsearch' is off, tags searching is slower when a full match
7450 exists, but faster when no full match exists. Tags in unsorted tags
7451 files may only be found with 'tagbsearch' off.
7452 When the tags file is not sorted, or sorted in a wrong way (not on
7453 ASCII byte value), 'tagbsearch' should be off, or the line given above
7454 must be included in the tags file.
7455 This option doesn't affect commands that find all matching tags (e.g.,
7456 command-line completion and ":help").
7457 {Vi: always uses binary search in some versions}
7458
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01007459 *'tagcase'* *'tc'*
7460'tagcase' 'tc' string (default "followic")
7461 global or local to buffer |global-local|
7462 {not in Vi}
7463 This option specifies how case is handled when searching the tags
7464 file:
7465 followic Follow the 'ignorecase' option
Bram Moolenaar66e29d72016-08-20 16:57:02 +02007466 followscs Follow the 'smartcase' and 'ignorecase' options
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01007467 ignore Ignore case
7468 match Match case
Bram Moolenaar66e29d72016-08-20 16:57:02 +02007469 smart Ignore case unless an upper case letter is used
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01007470
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007471 *'taglength'* *'tl'*
7472'taglength' 'tl' number (default 0)
7473 global
7474 If non-zero, tags are significant up to this number of characters.
7475
7476 *'tagrelative'* *'tr'* *'notagrelative'* *'notr'*
7477'tagrelative' 'tr' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
7478 global
7479 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarc6fe9192006-04-09 21:54:49 +00007480 If on and using a tags file in another directory, file names in that
7481 tags file are relative to the directory where the tags file is.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007482 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
7483 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
7484
7485 *'tags'* *'tag'* *E433*
7486'tags' 'tag' string (default "./tags,tags", when compiled with
7487 |+emacs_tags|: "./tags,./TAGS,tags,TAGS")
7488 global or local to buffer |global-local|
7489 Filenames for the tag command, separated by spaces or commas. To
7490 include a space or comma in a file name, precede it with a backslash
7491 (see |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes).
7492 When a file name starts with "./", the '.' is replaced with the path
7493 of the current file. But only when the 'd' flag is not included in
7494 'cpoptions'. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. Also see
7495 |tags-option|.
7496 "*", "**" and other wildcards can be used to search for tags files in
Bram Moolenaare2b590e2010-08-08 18:29:48 +02007497 a directory tree. See |file-searching|. E.g., "/lib/**/tags" will
7498 find all files named "tags" below "/lib". The filename itself cannot
7499 contain wildcards, it is used as-is. E.g., "/lib/**/tags?" will find
7500 files called "tags?". {not available when compiled without the
7501 |+path_extra| feature}
Bram Moolenaare7eb9df2005-09-09 19:49:30 +00007502 The |tagfiles()| function can be used to get a list of the file names
7503 actually used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007504 If Vim was compiled with the |+emacs_tags| feature, Emacs-style tag
7505 files are also supported. They are automatically recognized. The
7506 default value becomes "./tags,./TAGS,tags,TAGS", unless case
7507 differences are ignored (MS-Windows). |emacs-tags|
7508 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
7509 file names from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
7510 uses another default.
7511 {Vi: default is "tags /usr/lib/tags"}
7512
7513 *'tagstack'* *'tgst'* *'notagstack'* *'notgst'*
7514'tagstack' 'tgst' boolean (default on)
7515 global
7516 {not in all versions of Vi}
7517 When on, the |tagstack| is used normally. When off, a ":tag" or
7518 ":tselect" command with an argument will not push the tag onto the
7519 tagstack. A following ":tag" without an argument, a ":pop" command or
7520 any other command that uses the tagstack will use the unmodified
7521 tagstack, but does change the pointer to the active entry.
7522 Resetting this option is useful when using a ":tag" command in a
7523 mapping which should not change the tagstack.
7524
Bram Moolenaar8a5115c2016-01-09 19:41:11 +01007525 *'tcldll'*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01007526'tcldll' string (default depends on the build)
Bram Moolenaar8a5115c2016-01-09 19:41:11 +01007527 global
7528 {not in Vi}
7529 {only available when compiled with the |+tcl/dyn|
7530 feature}
7531 Specifies the name of the Tcl shared library. The default is
7532 DYNAMIC_TCL_DLL, which was specified at compile time.
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02007533 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaar8a5115c2016-01-09 19:41:11 +01007534 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
7535 security reasons.
7536
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007537 *'term'* *E529* *E530* *E531*
7538'term' string (default is $TERM, if that fails:
7539 in the GUI: "builtin_gui"
7540 on Amiga: "amiga"
7541 on BeOS: "beos-ansi"
7542 on Mac: "mac-ansi"
7543 on MiNT: "vt52"
7544 on MS-DOS: "pcterm"
7545 on OS/2: "os2ansi"
7546 on Unix: "ansi"
7547 on VMS: "ansi"
7548 on Win 32: "win32")
7549 global
7550 Name of the terminal. Used for choosing the terminal control
7551 characters. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
7552 For example: >
7553 :set term=$TERM
7554< See |termcap|.
7555
7556 *'termbidi'* *'tbidi'*
7557 *'notermbidi'* *'notbidi'*
7558'termbidi' 'tbidi' boolean (default off, on for "mlterm")
7559 global
7560 {not in Vi}
7561 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
7562 feature}
7563 The terminal is in charge of Bi-directionality of text (as specified
7564 by Unicode). The terminal is also expected to do the required shaping
7565 that some languages (such as Arabic) require.
7566 Setting this option implies that 'rightleft' will not be set when
7567 'arabic' is set and the value of 'arabicshape' will be ignored.
7568 Note that setting 'termbidi' has the immediate effect that
7569 'arabicshape' is ignored, but 'rightleft' isn't changed automatically.
7570 This option is reset when the GUI is started.
7571 For further details see |arabic.txt|.
7572
7573 *'termencoding'* *'tenc'*
7574'termencoding' 'tenc' string (default ""; with GTK+ 2 GUI: "utf-8"; with
7575 Macintosh GUI: "macroman")
7576 global
7577 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
7578 feature}
7579 {not in Vi}
7580 Encoding used for the terminal. This specifies what character
7581 encoding the keyboard produces and the display will understand. For
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01007582 the GUI it only applies to the keyboard ('encoding' is used for the
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00007583 display). Except for the Mac when 'macatsui' is off, then
7584 'termencoding' should be "macroman".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007585 *E617*
7586 Note: This does not apply to the GTK+ 2 GUI. After the GUI has been
7587 successfully initialized, 'termencoding' is forcibly set to "utf-8".
7588 Any attempts to set a different value will be rejected, and an error
7589 message is shown.
Bram Moolenaarac360bf2015-09-01 20:31:20 +02007590 For the Win32 GUI and console versions 'termencoding' is not used,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007591 because the Win32 system always passes Unicode characters.
7592 When empty, the same encoding is used as for the 'encoding' option.
7593 This is the normal value.
7594 Not all combinations for 'termencoding' and 'encoding' are valid. See
7595 |encoding-table|.
7596 The value for this option must be supported by internal conversions or
7597 iconv(). When this is not possible no conversion will be done and you
7598 will probably experience problems with non-ASCII characters.
7599 Example: You are working with the locale set to euc-jp (Japanese) and
7600 want to edit a UTF-8 file: >
7601 :let &termencoding = &encoding
7602 :set encoding=utf-8
7603< You need to do this when your system has no locale support for UTF-8.
7604
Bram Moolenaar61be73b2016-04-29 22:59:22 +02007605 *'termguicolors'* *'tgc'*
7606'termguicolors' 'tgc' boolean (default off)
7607 global
7608 {not in Vi}
7609 {not available when compiled without the
7610 |+termguicolors| feature}
7611 When on, uses |highlight-guifg| and |highlight-guibg| attributes in
7612 the terminal (thus using 24-bit color). Requires a ISO-8613-3
7613 compatible terminal.
7614 If setting this option does not work (produces a colorless UI)
7615 reading |xterm-true-color| might help.
7616
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007617 *'terse'* *'noterse'*
7618'terse' boolean (default off)
7619 global
7620 When set: Add 's' flag to 'shortmess' option (this makes the message
7621 for a search that hits the start or end of the file not being
7622 displayed). When reset: Remove 's' flag from 'shortmess' option. {Vi
7623 shortens a lot of messages}
7624
7625 *'textauto'* *'ta'* *'notextauto'* *'nota'*
7626'textauto' 'ta' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
7627 global
7628 {not in Vi}
7629 This option is obsolete. Use 'fileformats'.
7630 For backwards compatibility, when 'textauto' is set, 'fileformats' is
7631 set to the default value for the current system. When 'textauto' is
7632 reset, 'fileformats' is made empty.
7633 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
7634 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
7635
7636 *'textmode'* *'tx'* *'notextmode'* *'notx'*
7637'textmode' 'tx' boolean (MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2: default on,
7638 others: default off)
7639 local to buffer
7640 {not in Vi}
7641 This option is obsolete. Use 'fileformat'.
7642 For backwards compatibility, when 'textmode' is set, 'fileformat' is
7643 set to "dos". When 'textmode' is reset, 'fileformat' is set to
7644 "unix".
7645
7646 *'textwidth'* *'tw'*
7647'textwidth' 'tw' number (default 0)
7648 local to buffer
7649 {not in Vi}
7650 Maximum width of text that is being inserted. A longer line will be
7651 broken after white space to get this width. A zero value disables
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02007652 this.
7653 'textwidth' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set and restored
7654 when 'paste' is reset.
7655 When 'textwidth' is zero, 'wrapmargin' may be used. See also
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007656 'formatoptions' and |ins-textwidth|.
Bram Moolenaarfc1421e2006-04-20 22:17:20 +00007657 When 'formatexpr' is set it will be used to break the line.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007658 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
7659
7660 *'thesaurus'* *'tsr'*
7661'thesaurus' 'tsr' string (default "")
7662 global or local to buffer |global-local|
7663 {not in Vi}
7664 List of file names, separated by commas, that are used to lookup words
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007665 for thesaurus completion commands |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-T|. Each line in
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007666 the file should contain words with similar meaning, separated by
7667 non-keyword characters (white space is preferred). Maximum line
7668 length is 510 bytes.
Bram Moolenaar9a7224b2012-04-30 15:56:52 +02007669 To obtain a file to be used here, check out this ftp site:
Bram Moolenaar38a55632016-02-15 22:07:32 +01007670 [Sorry this link doesn't work anymore, do you know the right one?]
Bram Moolenaar9a7224b2012-04-30 15:56:52 +02007671 ftp://ftp.ox.ac.uk/pub/wordlists/ First get the README file.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007672 To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007673 after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file
7674 name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes.
7675 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
7676 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
7677 uses another default.
7678 Backticks cannot be used in this option for security reasons.
7679
7680 *'tildeop'* *'top'* *'notildeop'* *'notop'*
7681'tildeop' 'top' boolean (default off)
7682 global
7683 {not in Vi}
7684 When on: The tilde command "~" behaves like an operator.
7685 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
7686
7687 *'timeout'* *'to'* *'notimeout'* *'noto'*
7688'timeout' 'to' boolean (default on)
7689 global
7690 *'ttimeout'* *'nottimeout'*
Bram Moolenaar50ba5262016-09-22 22:33:02 +02007691'ttimeout' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|))
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007692 global
7693 {not in Vi}
7694 These two options together determine the behavior when part of a
7695 mapped key sequence or keyboard code has been received:
7696
7697 'timeout' 'ttimeout' action ~
7698 off off do not time out
7699 on on or off time out on :mappings and key codes
7700 off on time out on key codes
7701
7702 If both options are off, Vim will wait until either the complete
7703 mapping or key sequence has been received, or it is clear that there
7704 is no mapping or key sequence for the received characters. For
7705 example: if you have mapped "vl" and Vim has received 'v', the next
7706 character is needed to see if the 'v' is followed by an 'l'.
7707 When one of the options is on, Vim will wait for about 1 second for
7708 the next character to arrive. After that the already received
7709 characters are interpreted as single characters. The waiting time can
7710 be changed with the 'timeoutlen' option.
7711 On slow terminals or very busy systems timing out may cause
7712 malfunctioning cursor keys. If both options are off, Vim waits
7713 forever after an entered <Esc> if there are key codes that start
7714 with <Esc>. You will have to type <Esc> twice. If you do not have
7715 problems with key codes, but would like to have :mapped key
7716 sequences not timing out in 1 second, set the 'ttimeout' option and
7717 reset the 'timeout' option.
7718
7719 NOTE: 'ttimeout' is reset when 'compatible' is set.
7720
7721 *'timeoutlen'* *'tm'*
7722'timeoutlen' 'tm' number (default 1000)
7723 global
7724 {not in all versions of Vi}
7725 *'ttimeoutlen'* *'ttm'*
Bram Moolenaar50ba5262016-09-22 22:33:02 +02007726'ttimeoutlen' 'ttm' number (default -1, set to 100 in |defaults.vim|))
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007727 global
7728 {not in Vi}
7729 The time in milliseconds that is waited for a key code or mapped key
7730 sequence to complete. Also used for CTRL-\ CTRL-N and CTRL-\ CTRL-G
7731 when part of a command has been typed.
7732 Normally only 'timeoutlen' is used and 'ttimeoutlen' is -1. When a
7733 different timeout value for key codes is desired set 'ttimeoutlen' to
7734 a non-negative number.
7735
7736 ttimeoutlen mapping delay key code delay ~
7737 < 0 'timeoutlen' 'timeoutlen'
7738 >= 0 'timeoutlen' 'ttimeoutlen'
7739
7740 The timeout only happens when the 'timeout' and 'ttimeout' options
7741 tell so. A useful setting would be >
7742 :set timeout timeoutlen=3000 ttimeoutlen=100
7743< (time out on mapping after three seconds, time out on key codes after
7744 a tenth of a second).
7745
7746 *'title'* *'notitle'*
7747'title' boolean (default off, on when title can be restored)
7748 global
7749 {not in Vi}
7750 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
7751 feature}
7752 When on, the title of the window will be set to the value of
7753 'titlestring' (if it is not empty), or to:
7754 filename [+=-] (path) - VIM
7755 Where:
7756 filename the name of the file being edited
7757 - indicates the file cannot be modified, 'ma' off
7758 + indicates the file was modified
7759 = indicates the file is read-only
7760 =+ indicates the file is read-only and modified
7761 (path) is the path of the file being edited
7762 - VIM the server name |v:servername| or "VIM"
7763 Only works if the terminal supports setting window titles
7764 (currently Amiga console, Win32 console, all GUI versions and
7765 terminals with a non- empty 't_ts' option - these are Unix xterm and
7766 iris-ansi by default, where 't_ts' is taken from the builtin termcap).
7767 *X11*
7768 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original title will
7769 be restored if possible. The output of ":version" will include "+X11"
7770 when HAVE_X11 was defined, otherwise it will be "-X11". This also
7771 works for the icon name |'icon'|.
7772 But: When Vim was started with the |-X| argument, restoring the title
7773 will not work (except in the GUI).
7774 If the title cannot be restored, it is set to the value of 'titleold'.
7775 You might want to restore the title outside of Vim then.
7776 When using an xterm from a remote machine you can use this command:
7777 rsh machine_name xterm -display $DISPLAY &
7778 then the WINDOWID environment variable should be inherited and the
7779 title of the window should change back to what it should be after
7780 exiting Vim.
7781
7782 *'titlelen'*
7783'titlelen' number (default 85)
7784 global
7785 {not in Vi}
7786 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
7787 feature}
7788 Gives the percentage of 'columns' to use for the length of the window
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007789 title. When the title is longer, only the end of the path name is
7790 shown. A '<' character before the path name is used to indicate this.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007791 Using a percentage makes this adapt to the width of the window. But
7792 it won't work perfectly, because the actual number of characters
7793 available also depends on the font used and other things in the title
7794 bar. When 'titlelen' is zero the full path is used. Otherwise,
7795 values from 1 to 30000 percent can be used.
7796 'titlelen' is also used for the 'titlestring' option.
7797
7798 *'titleold'*
7799'titleold' string (default "Thanks for flying Vim")
7800 global
7801 {not in Vi}
7802 {only available when compiled with the |+title|
7803 feature}
7804 This option will be used for the window title when exiting Vim if the
7805 original title cannot be restored. Only happens if 'title' is on or
7806 'titlestring' is not empty.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00007807 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
7808 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007809 *'titlestring'*
7810'titlestring' string (default "")
7811 global
7812 {not in Vi}
7813 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
7814 feature}
7815 When this option is not empty, it will be used for the title of the
7816 window. This happens only when the 'title' option is on.
7817 Only works if the terminal supports setting window titles (currently
7818 Amiga console, Win32 console, all GUI versions and terminals with a
7819 non-empty 't_ts' option).
7820 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original title will
7821 be restored if possible |X11|.
7822 When this option contains printf-style '%' items, they will be
7823 expanded according to the rules used for 'statusline'.
7824 Example: >
7825 :auto BufEnter * let &titlestring = hostname() . "/" . expand("%:p")
7826 :set title titlestring=%<%F%=%l/%L-%P titlelen=70
7827< The value of 'titlelen' is used to align items in the middle or right
7828 of the available space.
7829 Some people prefer to have the file name first: >
7830 :set titlestring=%t%(\ %M%)%(\ (%{expand(\"%:~:.:h\")})%)%(\ %a%)
7831< Note the use of "%{ }" and an expression to get the path of the file,
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007832 without the file name. The "%( %)" constructs are used to add a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007833 separating space only when needed.
7834 NOTE: Use of special characters in 'titlestring' may cause the display
7835 to be garbled (e.g., when it contains a CR or NL character).
7836 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| feature}
7837
7838 *'toolbar'* *'tb'*
7839'toolbar' 'tb' string (default "icons,tooltips")
7840 global
7841 {only for |+GUI_GTK|, |+GUI_Athena|, |+GUI_Motif| and
7842 |+GUI_Photon|}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007843 The contents of this option controls various toolbar settings. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007844 possible values are:
7845 icons Toolbar buttons are shown with icons.
7846 text Toolbar buttons shown with text.
7847 horiz Icon and text of a toolbar button are
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007848 horizontally arranged. {only in GTK+ 2 GUI}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007849 tooltips Tooltips are active for toolbar buttons.
7850 Tooltips refer to the popup help text which appears after the mouse
7851 cursor is placed over a toolbar button for a brief moment.
7852
7853 If you want the toolbar to be shown with icons as well as text, do the
7854 following: >
7855 :set tb=icons,text
7856< Motif and Athena cannot display icons and text at the same time. They
7857 will show icons if both are requested.
7858
7859 If none of the strings specified in 'toolbar' are valid or if
7860 'toolbar' is empty, this option is ignored. If you want to disable
7861 the toolbar, you need to set the 'guioptions' option. For example: >
7862 :set guioptions-=T
7863< Also see |gui-toolbar|.
7864
7865 *'toolbariconsize'* *'tbis'*
7866'toolbariconsize' 'tbis' string (default "small")
7867 global
7868 {not in Vi}
7869 {only in the GTK+ 2 GUI}
7870 Controls the size of toolbar icons. The possible values are:
Bram Moolenaar77cdfd12016-03-12 12:57:59 +01007871 tiny Use tiny icons.
7872 small Use small icons (default).
7873 medium Use medium-sized icons.
7874 large Use large icons.
7875 huge Use even larger icons.
7876 giant Use very big icons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007877 The exact dimensions in pixels of the various icon sizes depend on
Bram Moolenaar77cdfd12016-03-12 12:57:59 +01007878 the current theme. Common dimensions are giant=48x48, huge=32x32,
7879 large=24x24, medium=24x24, small=20x20 and tiny=16x16.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007880
7881 If 'toolbariconsize' is empty, the global default size as determined
7882 by user preferences or the current theme is used.
7883
7884 *'ttybuiltin'* *'tbi'* *'nottybuiltin'* *'notbi'*
7885'ttybuiltin' 'tbi' boolean (default on)
7886 global
7887 {not in Vi}
7888 When on, the builtin termcaps are searched before the external ones.
7889 When off the builtin termcaps are searched after the external ones.
7890 When this option is changed, you should set the 'term' option next for
7891 the change to take effect, for example: >
7892 :set notbi term=$TERM
7893< See also |termcap|.
7894 Rationale: The default for this option is "on", because the builtin
7895 termcap entries are generally better (many systems contain faulty
7896 xterm entries...).
7897
7898 *'ttyfast'* *'tf'* *'nottyfast'* *'notf'*
7899'ttyfast' 'tf' boolean (default off, on when 'term' is xterm, hpterm,
7900 sun-cmd, screen, rxvt, dtterm or
7901 iris-ansi; also on when running Vim in
7902 a DOS console)
7903 global
7904 {not in Vi}
7905 Indicates a fast terminal connection. More characters will be sent to
7906 the screen for redrawing, instead of using insert/delete line
7907 commands. Improves smoothness of redrawing when there are multiple
7908 windows and the terminal does not support a scrolling region.
7909 Also enables the extra writing of characters at the end of each screen
7910 line for lines that wrap. This helps when using copy/paste with the
7911 mouse in an xterm and other terminals.
7912
7913 *'ttymouse'* *'ttym'*
7914'ttymouse' 'ttym' string (default depends on 'term')
7915 global
7916 {not in Vi}
7917 {only in Unix and VMS, doesn't work in the GUI; not
7918 available when compiled without |+mouse|}
7919 Name of the terminal type for which mouse codes are to be recognized.
Bram Moolenaar2c7a7632007-05-10 18:19:11 +00007920 Currently these strings are valid:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007921 *xterm-mouse*
7922 xterm xterm-like mouse handling. The mouse generates
7923 "<Esc>[Mscr", where "scr" is three bytes:
7924 "s" = button state
7925 "c" = column plus 33
7926 "r" = row plus 33
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02007927 This only works up to 223 columns! See "dec",
7928 "urxvt", and "sgr" for solutions.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007929 xterm2 Works like "xterm", but with the xterm reporting the
7930 mouse position while the mouse is dragged. This works
7931 much faster and more precise. Your xterm must at
Bram Moolenaarbc7aa852005-03-06 23:38:09 +00007932 least at patchlevel 88 / XFree 3.3.3 for this to
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007933 work. See below for how Vim detects this
7934 automatically.
7935 *netterm-mouse*
7936 netterm NetTerm mouse handling. The mouse generates
7937 "<Esc>}r,c<CR>", where "r,c" are two decimal numbers
7938 for the row and column.
7939 *dec-mouse*
7940 dec DEC terminal mouse handling. The mouse generates a
7941 rather complex sequence, starting with "<Esc>[".
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00007942 This is also available for an Xterm, if it was
7943 configured with "--enable-dec-locator".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007944 *jsbterm-mouse*
7945 jsbterm JSB term mouse handling.
7946 *pterm-mouse*
7947 pterm QNX pterm mouse handling.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01007948 *urxvt-mouse*
7949 urxvt Mouse handling for the urxvt (rxvt-unicode) terminal.
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02007950 The mouse works only if the terminal supports this
7951 encoding style, but it does not have 223 columns limit
7952 unlike "xterm" or "xterm2".
Bram Moolenaar9b451252012-08-15 17:43:31 +02007953 *sgr-mouse*
7954 sgr Mouse handling for the terminal that emits SGR-styled
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02007955 mouse reporting. The mouse works even in columns
7956 beyond 223. This option is backward compatible with
7957 "xterm2" because it can also decode "xterm2" style
7958 mouse codes.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007959
7960 The mouse handling must be enabled at compile time |+mouse_xterm|
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02007961 |+mouse_dec| |+mouse_netterm| |+mouse_jsbterm| |+mouse_urxvt|
7962 |+mouse_sgr|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007963 Only "xterm"(2) is really recognized. NetTerm mouse codes are always
7964 recognized, if enabled at compile time. DEC terminal mouse codes
7965 are recognized if enabled at compile time, and 'ttymouse' is not
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02007966 "xterm", "xterm2", "urxvt" or "sgr" (because dec mouse codes conflict
7967 with them).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007968 This option is automatically set to "xterm", when the 'term' option is
Bram Moolenaar45758762016-10-12 23:08:06 +02007969 set to a name that starts with "xterm", "mlterm", "screen", "tmux",
7970 "st" (full match only), "st-" or "stterm", and 'ttymouse' is not set
7971 already.
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02007972 Additionally, if vim is compiled with the |+termresponse| feature and
7973 |t_RV| is set to the escape sequence to request the xterm version
7974 number, more intelligent detection process runs.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007975 The "xterm2" value will be set if the xterm version is reported to be
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02007976 from 95 to 276. The "sgr" value will be set if the xterm version is
7977 277 or highter.
7978 If you do not want 'ttymouse' to be set to "xterm2" or "sgr"
7979 automatically, set t_RV to an empty string: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007980 :set t_RV=
7981<
7982 *'ttyscroll'* *'tsl'*
7983'ttyscroll' 'tsl' number (default 999)
7984 global
7985 Maximum number of lines to scroll the screen. If there are more lines
7986 to scroll the window is redrawn. For terminals where scrolling is
7987 very slow and redrawing is not slow this can be set to a small number,
7988 e.g., 3, to speed up displaying.
7989
7990 *'ttytype'* *'tty'*
7991'ttytype' 'tty' string (default from $TERM)
7992 global
7993 Alias for 'term', see above.
7994
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02007995 *'undodir'* *'udir'*
7996'undodir' 'udir' string (default ".")
7997 global
7998 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02007999 {only when compiled with the |+persistent_undo| feature}
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02008000 List of directory names for undo files, separated with commas.
Bram Moolenaarb230bd52010-05-25 21:02:00 +02008001 See |'backupdir'| for details of the format.
Bram Moolenaar6a244fe2010-05-24 22:02:24 +02008002 "." means using the directory of the file. The undo file name for
8003 "file.txt" is ".file.txt.un~".
8004 For other directories the file name is the full path of the edited
8005 file, with path separators replaced with "%".
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02008006 When writing: The first directory that exists is used. "." always
8007 works, no directories after "." will be used for writing.
8008 When reading all entries are tried to find an undo file. The first
8009 undo file that exists is used. When it cannot be read an error is
8010 given, no further entry is used.
8011 See |undo-persistence|.
8012
Bram Moolenaar543b7ef2013-06-01 14:50:56 +02008013 *'undofile'* *'noundofile'* *'udf'* *'noudf'*
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02008014'undofile' 'udf' boolean (default off)
8015 local to buffer
8016 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02008017 {only when compiled with the |+persistent_undo| feature}
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02008018 When on, Vim automatically saves undo history to an undo file when
8019 writing a buffer to a file, and restores undo history from the same
8020 file on buffer read.
Bram Moolenaarb230bd52010-05-25 21:02:00 +02008021 The directory where the undo file is stored is specified by 'undodir'.
8022 For more information about this feature see |undo-persistence|.
Bram Moolenaar59f931e2010-07-24 20:27:03 +02008023 The undo file is not read when 'undoreload' causes the buffer from
8024 before a reload to be saved for undo.
Bram Moolenaar97d62492012-11-15 21:28:22 +01008025 When 'undofile' is turned off the undo file is NOT deleted.
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02008026
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008027 *'undolevels'* *'ul'*
8028'undolevels' 'ul' number (default 100, 1000 for Unix, VMS,
8029 Win32 and OS/2)
Bram Moolenaarf5a2fd82013-11-06 05:26:15 +01008030 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008031 {not in Vi}
8032 Maximum number of changes that can be undone. Since undo information
8033 is kept in memory, higher numbers will cause more memory to be used
8034 (nevertheless, a single change can use an unlimited amount of memory).
8035 Set to 0 for Vi compatibility: One level of undo and "u" undoes
8036 itself: >
8037 set ul=0
8038< But you can also get Vi compatibility by including the 'u' flag in
8039 'cpoptions', and still be able to use CTRL-R to repeat undo.
Bram Moolenaar945e2db2010-06-05 17:43:32 +02008040 Also see |undo-two-ways|.
Bram Moolenaarf5a2fd82013-11-06 05:26:15 +01008041 Set to -1 for no undo at all. You might want to do this only for the
8042 current buffer: >
8043 setlocal ul=-1
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008044< This helps when you run out of memory for a single change.
Bram Moolenaar32efaf62014-11-05 17:02:17 +01008045
8046 The local value is set to -123456 when the global value is to be used.
8047
Bram Moolenaar945e2db2010-06-05 17:43:32 +02008048 Also see |clear-undo|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008049
Bram Moolenaar59f931e2010-07-24 20:27:03 +02008050 *'undoreload'* *'ur'*
8051'undoreload' 'ur' number (default 10000)
8052 global
8053 {not in Vi}
8054 Save the whole buffer for undo when reloading it. This applies to the
8055 ":e!" command and reloading for when the buffer changed outside of
8056 Vim. |FileChangedShell|
8057 The save only happens when this options is negative or when the number
8058 of lines is smaller than the value of this option.
8059 Set this option to zero to disable undo for a reload.
8060
8061 When saving undo for a reload, any undo file is not read.
8062
8063 Note that this causes the whole buffer to be stored in memory. Set
8064 this option to a lower value if you run out of memory.
8065
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008066 *'updatecount'* *'uc'*
8067'updatecount' 'uc' number (default: 200)
8068 global
8069 {not in Vi}
8070 After typing this many characters the swap file will be written to
8071 disk. When zero, no swap file will be created at all (see chapter on
8072 recovery |crash-recovery|). 'updatecount' is set to zero by starting
8073 Vim with the "-n" option, see |startup|. When editing in readonly
8074 mode this option will be initialized to 10000.
8075 The swapfile can be disabled per buffer with |'swapfile'|.
8076 When 'updatecount' is set from zero to non-zero, swap files are
8077 created for all buffers that have 'swapfile' set. When 'updatecount'
8078 is set to zero, existing swap files are not deleted.
8079 Also see |'swapsync'|.
8080 This option has no meaning in buffers where |'buftype'| is "nofile"
8081 or "nowrite".
8082
8083 *'updatetime'* *'ut'*
8084'updatetime' 'ut' number (default 4000)
8085 global
8086 {not in Vi}
8087 If this many milliseconds nothing is typed the swap file will be
8088 written to disk (see |crash-recovery|). Also used for the
8089 |CursorHold| autocommand event.
8090
8091 *'verbose'* *'vbs'*
8092'verbose' 'vbs' number (default 0)
8093 global
8094 {not in Vi, although some versions have a boolean
8095 verbose option}
8096 When bigger than zero, Vim will give messages about what it is doing.
8097 Currently, these messages are given:
8098 >= 1 When the viminfo file is read or written.
8099 >= 2 When a file is ":source"'ed.
Bram Moolenaar87b5ca52006-03-04 21:55:31 +00008100 >= 5 Every searched tags file and include file.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008101 >= 8 Files for which a group of autocommands is executed.
8102 >= 9 Every executed autocommand.
8103 >= 12 Every executed function.
8104 >= 13 When an exception is thrown, caught, finished, or discarded.
8105 >= 14 Anything pending in a ":finally" clause.
8106 >= 15 Every executed Ex command (truncated at 200 characters).
8107
8108 This option can also be set with the "-V" argument. See |-V|.
8109 This option is also set by the |:verbose| command.
8110
Bram Moolenaar5c06f8b2005-05-31 22:14:58 +00008111 When the 'verbosefile' option is set then the verbose messages are not
8112 displayed.
8113
8114 *'verbosefile'* *'vfile'*
8115'verbosefile' 'vfile' string (default empty)
8116 global
8117 {not in Vi}
8118 When not empty all messages are written in a file with this name.
8119 When the file exists messages are appended.
8120 Writing to the file ends when Vim exits or when 'verbosefile' is made
Bram Moolenaar80794b12010-06-13 05:20:42 +02008121 empty. Writes are buffered, thus may not show up for some time.
Bram Moolenaar5c06f8b2005-05-31 22:14:58 +00008122 Setting 'verbosefile' to a new value is like making it empty first.
8123 The difference with |:redir| is that verbose messages are not
8124 displayed when 'verbosefile' is set.
8125
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008126 *'viewdir'* *'vdir'*
8127'viewdir' 'vdir' string (default for Amiga, MS-DOS, OS/2 and Win32:
8128 "$VIM/vimfiles/view",
8129 for Unix: "~/.vim/view",
8130 for Macintosh: "$VIM:vimfiles:view"
8131 for VMS: "sys$login:vimfiles/view"
8132 for RiscOS: "Choices:vimfiles/view")
8133 global
8134 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02008135 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008136 feature}
8137 Name of the directory where to store files for |:mkview|.
8138 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
8139 security reasons.
8140
8141 *'viewoptions'* *'vop'*
8142'viewoptions' 'vop' string (default: "folds,options,cursor")
8143 global
8144 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02008145 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008146 feature}
8147 Changes the effect of the |:mkview| command. It is a comma separated
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008148 list of words. Each word enables saving and restoring something:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008149 word save and restore ~
8150 cursor cursor position in file and in window
8151 folds manually created folds, opened/closed folds and local
8152 fold options
8153 options options and mappings local to a window or buffer (not
8154 global values for local options)
Bram Moolenaar6e932462014-09-09 18:48:09 +02008155 localoptions same as "options"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008156 slash backslashes in file names replaced with forward
8157 slashes
8158 unix with Unix end-of-line format (single <NL>), even when
8159 on Windows or DOS
8160
8161 "slash" and "unix" are useful on Windows when sharing view files
8162 with Unix. The Unix version of Vim cannot source dos format scripts,
8163 but the Windows version of Vim can source unix format scripts.
8164
8165 *'viminfo'* *'vi'* *E526* *E527* *E528*
8166'viminfo' 'vi' string (Vi default: "", Vim default for MS-DOS,
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01008167 Windows and OS/2: '100,<50,s10,h,rA:,rB:,
8168 for Amiga: '100,<50,s10,h,rdf0:,rdf1:,rdf2:
8169 for others: '100,<50,s10,h)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008170 global
8171 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02008172 {not available when compiled without the |+viminfo|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008173 feature}
8174 When non-empty, the viminfo file is read upon startup and written
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008175 when exiting Vim (see |viminfo-file|). The string should be a comma
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008176 separated list of parameters, each consisting of a single character
8177 identifying the particular parameter, followed by a number or string
8178 which specifies the value of that parameter. If a particular
8179 character is left out, then the default value is used for that
8180 parameter. The following is a list of the identifying characters and
8181 the effect of their value.
8182 CHAR VALUE ~
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008183 *viminfo-!*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008184 ! When included, save and restore global variables that start
8185 with an uppercase letter, and don't contain a lowercase
8186 letter. Thus "KEEPTHIS and "K_L_M" are stored, but "KeepThis"
Bram Moolenaar680eeca2010-10-20 17:44:42 +02008187 and "_K_L_M" are not. Nested List and Dict items may not be
Bram Moolenaar166af9b2010-11-16 20:34:40 +01008188 read back correctly, you end up with an empty item.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008189 *viminfo-quote*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008190 " Maximum number of lines saved for each register. Old name of
8191 the '<' item, with the disadvantage that you need to put a
8192 backslash before the ", otherwise it will be recognized as the
8193 start of a comment!
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008194 *viminfo-%*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008195 % When included, save and restore the buffer list. If Vim is
8196 started with a file name argument, the buffer list is not
8197 restored. If Vim is started without a file name argument, the
Bram Moolenaard042dc82015-11-24 19:18:36 +01008198 buffer list is restored from the viminfo file. Quickfix
8199 ('buftype'), unlisted ('buflisted'), unnamed and buffers on
8200 removable media (|viminfo-r|) are not saved.
Bram Moolenaar15d0a8c2004-09-06 17:44:46 +00008201 When followed by a number, the number specifies the maximum
8202 number of buffers that are stored. Without a number all
8203 buffers are stored.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008204 *viminfo-'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008205 ' Maximum number of previously edited files for which the marks
8206 are remembered. This parameter must always be included when
8207 'viminfo' is non-empty.
8208 Including this item also means that the |jumplist| and the
8209 |changelist| are stored in the viminfo file.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008210 *viminfo-/*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008211 / Maximum number of items in the search pattern history to be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008212 saved. If non-zero, then the previous search and substitute
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008213 patterns are also saved. When not included, the value of
8214 'history' is used.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008215 *viminfo-:*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008216 : Maximum number of items in the command-line history to be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008217 saved. When not included, the value of 'history' is used.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008218 *viminfo-<*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008219 < Maximum number of lines saved for each register. If zero then
8220 registers are not saved. When not included, all lines are
8221 saved. '"' is the old name for this item.
8222 Also see the 's' item below: limit specified in Kbyte.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008223 *viminfo-@*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008224 @ Maximum number of items in the input-line history to be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008225 saved. When not included, the value of 'history' is used.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008226 *viminfo-c*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008227 c When included, convert the text in the viminfo file from the
8228 'encoding' used when writing the file to the current
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00008229 'encoding'. See |viminfo-encoding|.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008230 *viminfo-f*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008231 f Whether file marks need to be stored. If zero, file marks ('0
8232 to '9, 'A to 'Z) are not stored. When not present or when
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008233 non-zero, they are all stored. '0 is used for the current
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008234 cursor position (when exiting or when doing ":wviminfo").
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008235 *viminfo-h*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008236 h Disable the effect of 'hlsearch' when loading the viminfo
8237 file. When not included, it depends on whether ":nohlsearch"
8238 has been used since the last search command.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008239 *viminfo-n*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008240 n Name of the viminfo file. The name must immediately follow
Bram Moolenaar063b9d12016-07-09 20:21:48 +02008241 the 'n'. Must be at the end of the option! If the "-i"
8242 argument was given when starting Vim, that file name overrides
8243 the one given here with 'viminfo'. Environment variables are
8244 expanded when opening the file, not when setting the option.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008245 *viminfo-r*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008246 r Removable media. The argument is a string (up to the next
8247 ','). This parameter can be given several times. Each
8248 specifies the start of a path for which no marks will be
8249 stored. This is to avoid removable media. For MS-DOS you
8250 could use "ra:,rb:", for Amiga "rdf0:,rdf1:,rdf2:". You can
8251 also use it for temp files, e.g., for Unix: "r/tmp". Case is
8252 ignored. Maximum length of each 'r' argument is 50
8253 characters.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008254 *viminfo-s*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008255 s Maximum size of an item in Kbyte. If zero then registers are
8256 not saved. Currently only applies to registers. The default
8257 "s10" will exclude registers with more than 10 Kbyte of text.
8258 Also see the '<' item above: line count limit.
8259
8260 Example: >
8261 :set viminfo='50,<1000,s100,:0,n~/vim/viminfo
8262<
8263 '50 Marks will be remembered for the last 50 files you
8264 edited.
8265 <1000 Contents of registers (up to 1000 lines each) will be
8266 remembered.
8267 s100 Registers with more than 100 Kbyte text are skipped.
8268 :0 Command-line history will not be saved.
8269 n~/vim/viminfo The name of the file to use is "~/vim/viminfo".
8270 no / Since '/' is not specified, the default will be used,
8271 that is, save all of the search history, and also the
8272 previous search and substitute patterns.
8273 no % The buffer list will not be saved nor read back.
8274 no h 'hlsearch' highlighting will be restored.
8275
8276 When setting 'viminfo' from an empty value you can use |:rviminfo| to
8277 load the contents of the file, this is not done automatically.
8278
8279 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
8280 security reasons.
8281
8282 *'virtualedit'* *'ve'*
8283'virtualedit' 've' string (default "")
8284 global
8285 {not in Vi}
8286 {not available when compiled without the
8287 |+virtualedit| feature}
8288 A comma separated list of these words:
8289 block Allow virtual editing in Visual block mode.
8290 insert Allow virtual editing in Insert mode.
8291 all Allow virtual editing in all modes.
Bram Moolenaarefd2bf12006-03-16 21:41:35 +00008292 onemore Allow the cursor to move just past the end of the line
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00008293
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008294 Virtual editing means that the cursor can be positioned where there is
Bram Moolenaarebcbd022007-05-12 14:28:25 +00008295 no actual character. This can be halfway into a tab or beyond the end
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008296 of the line. Useful for selecting a rectangle in Visual mode and
8297 editing a table.
Bram Moolenaarefd2bf12006-03-16 21:41:35 +00008298 "onemore" is not the same, it will only allow moving the cursor just
8299 after the last character of the line. This makes some commands more
8300 consistent. Previously the cursor was always past the end of the line
8301 if the line was empty. But it is far from Vi compatible. It may also
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00008302 break some plugins or Vim scripts. For example because |l| can move
8303 the cursor after the last character. Use with care!
Bram Moolenaar9ba7e172013-07-17 22:37:26 +02008304 Using the `$` command will move to the last character in the line, not
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00008305 past it. This may actually move the cursor to the left!
Bram Moolenaar9ba7e172013-07-17 22:37:26 +02008306 The `g$` command will move to the end of the screen line.
Bram Moolenaarefd2bf12006-03-16 21:41:35 +00008307 It doesn't make sense to combine "all" with "onemore", but you will
8308 not get a warning for it.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008309
8310 *'visualbell'* *'vb'* *'novisualbell'* *'novb'* *beep*
8311'visualbell' 'vb' boolean (default off)
8312 global
8313 {not in Vi}
8314 Use visual bell instead of beeping. The terminal code to display the
8315 visual bell is given with 't_vb'. When no beep or flash is wanted,
8316 use ":set vb t_vb=".
8317 Note: When the GUI starts, 't_vb' is reset to its default value. You
8318 might want to set it again in your |gvimrc|.
8319 In the GUI, 't_vb' defaults to "<Esc>|f", which inverts the display
8320 for 20 msec. If you want to use a different time, use "<Esc>|40f",
8321 where 40 is the time in msec.
8322 Does not work on the Amiga, you always get a screen flash.
8323 Also see 'errorbells'.
8324
8325 *'warn'* *'nowarn'*
8326'warn' boolean (default on)
8327 global
8328 Give a warning message when a shell command is used while the buffer
8329 has been changed.
8330
8331 *'weirdinvert'* *'wiv'* *'noweirdinvert'* *'nowiv'*
8332'weirdinvert' 'wiv' boolean (default off)
8333 global
8334 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00008335 This option has the same effect as the 't_xs' terminal option.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008336 It is provided for backwards compatibility with version 4.x.
8337 Setting 'weirdinvert' has the effect of making 't_xs' non-empty, and
8338 vice versa. Has no effect when the GUI is running.
8339
8340 *'whichwrap'* *'ww'*
8341'whichwrap' 'ww' string (Vim default: "b,s", Vi default: "")
8342 global
8343 {not in Vi}
8344 Allow specified keys that move the cursor left/right to move to the
8345 previous/next line when the cursor is on the first/last character in
8346 the line. Concatenate characters to allow this for these keys:
8347 char key mode ~
8348 b <BS> Normal and Visual
8349 s <Space> Normal and Visual
Bram Moolenaar87b5ca52006-03-04 21:55:31 +00008350 h "h" Normal and Visual (not recommended)
8351 l "l" Normal and Visual (not recommended)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008352 < <Left> Normal and Visual
8353 > <Right> Normal and Visual
8354 ~ "~" Normal
8355 [ <Left> Insert and Replace
8356 ] <Right> Insert and Replace
8357 For example: >
8358 :set ww=<,>,[,]
8359< allows wrap only when cursor keys are used.
8360 When the movement keys are used in combination with a delete or change
8361 operator, the <EOL> also counts for a character. This makes "3h"
8362 different from "3dh" when the cursor crosses the end of a line. This
8363 is also true for "x" and "X", because they do the same as "dl" and
8364 "dh". If you use this, you may also want to use the mapping
8365 ":map <BS> X" to make backspace delete the character in front of the
8366 cursor.
Bram Moolenaar362e1a32006-03-06 23:29:24 +00008367 When 'l' is included and it is used after an operator at the end of a
8368 line then it will not move to the next line. This makes "dl", "cl",
8369 "yl" etc. work normally.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008370 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
8371 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
8372
8373 *'wildchar'* *'wc'*
8374'wildchar' 'wc' number (Vim default: <Tab>, Vi default: CTRL-E)
8375 global
8376 {not in Vi}
8377 Character you have to type to start wildcard expansion in the
8378 command-line, as specified with 'wildmode'.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00008379 More info here: |cmdline-completion|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008380 The character is not recognized when used inside a macro. See
8381 'wildcharm' for that.
8382 Although 'wc' is a number option, you can set it to a special key: >
8383 :set wc=<Esc>
8384< NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
8385 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
8386
8387 *'wildcharm'* *'wcm'*
8388'wildcharm' 'wcm' number (default: none (0))
8389 global
8390 {not in Vi}
8391 'wildcharm' works exactly like 'wildchar', except that it is
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00008392 recognized when used inside a macro. You can find "spare" command-line
8393 keys suitable for this option by looking at |ex-edit-index|. Normally
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008394 you'll never actually type 'wildcharm', just use it in mappings that
8395 automatically invoke completion mode, e.g.: >
8396 :set wcm=<C-Z>
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00008397 :cnoremap ss so $vim/sessions/*.vim<C-Z>
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008398< Then after typing :ss you can use CTRL-P & CTRL-N.
8399
8400 *'wildignore'* *'wig'*
8401'wildignore' 'wig' string (default "")
8402 global
8403 {not in Vi}
8404 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
8405 feature}
8406 A list of file patterns. A file that matches with one of these
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02008407 patterns is ignored when expanding |wildcards|, completing file or
8408 directory names, and influences the result of |expand()|, |glob()| and
8409 |globpath()| unless a flag is passed to disable this.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008410 The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|.
8411 Also see 'suffixes'.
8412 Example: >
8413 :set wildignore=*.o,*.obj
8414< The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
8415 a pattern from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
8416 uses another default.
8417
Bram Moolenaar94950a92010-12-02 16:01:29 +01008418
Bram Moolenaar81af9252010-12-10 20:35:50 +01008419 *'wildignorecase'* *'wic'* *'nowildignorecase'* *'nowic'*
Bram Moolenaar94950a92010-12-02 16:01:29 +01008420'wildignorecase' 'wic' boolean (default off)
8421 global
8422 {not in Vi}
8423 When set case is ignored when completing file names and directories.
Bram Moolenaar71afbfe2013-03-19 16:49:16 +01008424 Has no effect when 'fileignorecase' is set.
Bram Moolenaar94950a92010-12-02 16:01:29 +01008425 Does not apply when the shell is used to expand wildcards, which
8426 happens when there are special characters.
8427
8428
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008429 *'wildmenu'* *'wmnu'* *'nowildmenu'* *'nowmnu'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02008430'wildmenu' 'wmnu' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008431 global
8432 {not in Vi}
8433 {not available if compiled without the |+wildmenu|
8434 feature}
8435 When 'wildmenu' is on, command-line completion operates in an enhanced
8436 mode. On pressing 'wildchar' (usually <Tab>) to invoke completion,
8437 the possible matches are shown just above the command line, with the
8438 first match highlighted (overwriting the status line, if there is
8439 one). Keys that show the previous/next match, such as <Tab> or
8440 CTRL-P/CTRL-N, cause the highlight to move to the appropriate match.
8441 When 'wildmode' is used, "wildmenu" mode is used where "full" is
8442 specified. "longest" and "list" do not start "wildmenu" mode.
Bram Moolenaar26402cb2013-02-20 21:26:00 +01008443 You can check the current mode with |wildmenumode()|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008444 If there are more matches than can fit in the line, a ">" is shown on
8445 the right and/or a "<" is shown on the left. The status line scrolls
8446 as needed.
8447 The "wildmenu" mode is abandoned when a key is hit that is not used
8448 for selecting a completion.
8449 While the "wildmenu" is active the following keys have special
8450 meanings:
8451
8452 <Left> <Right> - select previous/next match (like CTRL-P/CTRL-N)
8453 <Down> - in filename/menu name completion: move into a
8454 subdirectory or submenu.
8455 <CR> - in menu completion, when the cursor is just after a
8456 dot: move into a submenu.
8457 <Up> - in filename/menu name completion: move up into
8458 parent directory or parent menu.
8459
8460 This makes the menus accessible from the console |console-menus|.
8461
8462 If you prefer the <Left> and <Right> keys to move the cursor instead
8463 of selecting a different match, use this: >
8464 :cnoremap <Left> <Space><BS><Left>
8465 :cnoremap <Right> <Space><BS><Right>
8466<
8467 The "WildMenu" highlighting is used for displaying the current match
8468 |hl-WildMenu|.
8469
8470 *'wildmode'* *'wim'*
8471'wildmode' 'wim' string (Vim default: "full")
8472 global
8473 {not in Vi}
8474 Completion mode that is used for the character specified with
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008475 'wildchar'. It is a comma separated list of up to four parts. Each
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00008476 part specifies what to do for each consecutive use of 'wildchar'. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008477 first part specifies the behavior for the first use of 'wildchar',
8478 The second part for the second use, etc.
8479 These are the possible values for each part:
8480 "" Complete only the first match.
8481 "full" Complete the next full match. After the last match,
8482 the original string is used and then the first match
8483 again.
8484 "longest" Complete till longest common string. If this doesn't
8485 result in a longer string, use the next part.
8486 "longest:full" Like "longest", but also start 'wildmenu' if it is
8487 enabled.
8488 "list" When more than one match, list all matches.
8489 "list:full" When more than one match, list all matches and
8490 complete first match.
8491 "list:longest" When more than one match, list all matches and
8492 complete till longest common string.
8493 When there is only a single match, it is fully completed in all cases.
8494
8495 Examples: >
8496 :set wildmode=full
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00008497< Complete first full match, next match, etc. (the default) >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008498 :set wildmode=longest,full
8499< Complete longest common string, then each full match >
8500 :set wildmode=list:full
8501< List all matches and complete each full match >
8502 :set wildmode=list,full
8503< List all matches without completing, then each full match >
8504 :set wildmode=longest,list
8505< Complete longest common string, then list alternatives.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00008506 More info here: |cmdline-completion|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008507
Bram Moolenaarb5bf5b82004-12-24 14:35:23 +00008508 *'wildoptions'* *'wop'*
8509'wildoptions' 'wop' string (default "")
8510 global
8511 {not in Vi}
8512 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
8513 feature}
8514 A list of words that change how command line completion is done.
8515 Currently only one word is allowed:
8516 tagfile When using CTRL-D to list matching tags, the kind of
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00008517 tag and the file of the tag is listed. Only one match
Bram Moolenaarb5bf5b82004-12-24 14:35:23 +00008518 is displayed per line. Often used tag kinds are:
8519 d #define
8520 f function
8521 Also see |cmdline-completion|.
8522
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008523 *'winaltkeys'* *'wak'*
8524'winaltkeys' 'wak' string (default "menu")
8525 global
8526 {not in Vi}
8527 {only used in Win32, Motif, GTK and Photon GUI}
8528 Some GUI versions allow the access to menu entries by using the ALT
8529 key in combination with a character that appears underlined in the
8530 menu. This conflicts with the use of the ALT key for mappings and
8531 entering special characters. This option tells what to do:
8532 no Don't use ALT keys for menus. ALT key combinations can be
8533 mapped, but there is no automatic handling. This can then be
8534 done with the |:simalt| command.
8535 yes ALT key handling is done by the windowing system. ALT key
8536 combinations cannot be mapped.
8537 menu Using ALT in combination with a character that is a menu
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008538 shortcut key, will be handled by the windowing system. Other
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008539 keys can be mapped.
8540 If the menu is disabled by excluding 'm' from 'guioptions', the ALT
8541 key is never used for the menu.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00008542 This option is not used for <F10>; on Win32 and with GTK <F10> will
8543 select the menu, unless it has been mapped.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008544
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00008545 *'window'* *'wi'*
8546'window' 'wi' number (default screen height - 1)
8547 global
8548 Window height. Do not confuse this with the height of the Vim window,
8549 use 'lines' for that.
Bram Moolenaar19a09a12005-03-04 23:39:37 +00008550 Used for |CTRL-F| and |CTRL-B| when there is only one window and the
8551 value is smaller than 'lines' minus one. The screen will scroll
8552 'window' minus two lines, with a minimum of one.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00008553 When 'window' is equal to 'lines' minus one CTRL-F and CTRL-B scroll
8554 in a much smarter way, taking care of wrapping lines.
8555 When resizing the Vim window, the value is smaller than 1 or more than
8556 or equal to 'lines' it will be set to 'lines' minus 1.
8557 {Vi also uses the option to specify the number of displayed lines}
8558
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008559 *'winheight'* *'wh'* *E591*
8560'winheight' 'wh' number (default 1)
8561 global
8562 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02008563 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008564 feature}
8565 Minimal number of lines for the current window. This is not a hard
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008566 minimum, Vim will use fewer lines if there is not enough room. If the
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00008567 focus goes to a window that is smaller, its size is increased, at the
8568 cost of the height of other windows.
8569 Set 'winheight' to a small number for normal editing.
8570 Set it to 999 to make the current window fill most of the screen.
8571 Other windows will be only 'winminheight' high. This has the drawback
8572 that ":all" will create only two windows. To avoid "vim -o 1 2 3 4"
8573 to create only two windows, set the option after startup is done,
8574 using the |VimEnter| event: >
8575 au VimEnter * set winheight=999
8576< Minimum value is 1.
8577 The height is not adjusted after one of the commands that change the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008578 height of the current window.
8579 'winheight' applies to the current window. Use 'winminheight' to set
8580 the minimal height for other windows.
8581
8582 *'winfixheight'* *'wfh'* *'nowinfixheight'* *'nowfh'*
8583'winfixheight' 'wfh' boolean (default off)
8584 local to window
8585 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02008586 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008587 feature}
8588 Keep the window height when windows are opened or closed and
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00008589 'equalalways' is set. Also for |CTRL-W_=|. Set by default for the
8590 |preview-window| and |quickfix-window|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008591 The height may be changed anyway when running out of room.
8592
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00008593 *'winfixwidth'* *'wfw'* *'nowinfixwidth'* *'nowfw'*
8594'winfixwidth' 'wfw' boolean (default off)
8595 local to window
8596 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02008597 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00008598 feature}
8599 Keep the window width when windows are opened or closed and
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00008600 'equalalways' is set. Also for |CTRL-W_=|.
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00008601 The width may be changed anyway when running out of room.
8602
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008603 *'winminheight'* *'wmh'*
8604'winminheight' 'wmh' number (default 1)
8605 global
8606 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02008607 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008608 feature}
8609 The minimal height of a window, when it's not the current window.
8610 This is a hard minimum, windows will never become smaller.
8611 When set to zero, windows may be "squashed" to zero lines (i.e. just a
8612 status bar) if necessary. They will return to at least one line when
8613 they become active (since the cursor has to have somewhere to go.)
8614 Use 'winheight' to set the minimal height of the current window.
8615 This option is only checked when making a window smaller. Don't use a
8616 large number, it will cause errors when opening more than a few
8617 windows. A value of 0 to 3 is reasonable.
8618
8619 *'winminwidth'* *'wmw'*
8620'winminwidth' 'wmw' number (default 1)
8621 global
8622 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02008623 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008624 feature}
8625 The minimal width of a window, when it's not the current window.
8626 This is a hard minimum, windows will never become smaller.
8627 When set to zero, windows may be "squashed" to zero columns (i.e. just
8628 a vertical separator) if necessary. They will return to at least one
8629 line when they become active (since the cursor has to have somewhere
8630 to go.)
8631 Use 'winwidth' to set the minimal width of the current window.
8632 This option is only checked when making a window smaller. Don't use a
8633 large number, it will cause errors when opening more than a few
8634 windows. A value of 0 to 12 is reasonable.
8635
8636 *'winwidth'* *'wiw'* *E592*
8637'winwidth' 'wiw' number (default 20)
8638 global
8639 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02008640 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008641 feature}
8642 Minimal number of columns for the current window. This is not a hard
8643 minimum, Vim will use fewer columns if there is not enough room. If
8644 the current window is smaller, its size is increased, at the cost of
8645 the width of other windows. Set it to 999 to make the current window
8646 always fill the screen. Set it to a small number for normal editing.
8647 The width is not adjusted after one of the commands to change the
8648 width of the current window.
8649 'winwidth' applies to the current window. Use 'winminwidth' to set
8650 the minimal width for other windows.
8651
8652 *'wrap'* *'nowrap'*
8653'wrap' boolean (default on)
8654 local to window
8655 {not in Vi}
8656 This option changes how text is displayed. It doesn't change the text
8657 in the buffer, see 'textwidth' for that.
8658 When on, lines longer than the width of the window will wrap and
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008659 displaying continues on the next line. When off lines will not wrap
8660 and only part of long lines will be displayed. When the cursor is
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008661 moved to a part that is not shown, the screen will scroll
8662 horizontally.
8663 The line will be broken in the middle of a word if necessary. See
8664 'linebreak' to get the break at a word boundary.
8665 To make scrolling horizontally a bit more useful, try this: >
8666 :set sidescroll=5
8667 :set listchars+=precedes:<,extends:>
8668< See 'sidescroll', 'listchars' and |wrap-off|.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01008669 This option can't be set from a |modeline| when the 'diff' option is
8670 on.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008671
8672 *'wrapmargin'* *'wm'*
8673'wrapmargin' 'wm' number (default 0)
8674 local to buffer
8675 Number of characters from the right window border where wrapping
8676 starts. When typing text beyond this limit, an <EOL> will be inserted
8677 and inserting continues on the next line.
8678 Options that add a margin, such as 'number' and 'foldcolumn', cause
8679 the text width to be further reduced. This is Vi compatible.
8680 When 'textwidth' is non-zero, this option is not used.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02008681 This option is set to 0 when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste'
8682 is reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008683 See also 'formatoptions' and |ins-textwidth|. {Vi: works differently
8684 and less usefully}
8685
8686 *'wrapscan'* *'ws'* *'nowrapscan'* *'nows'*
8687'wrapscan' 'ws' boolean (default on) *E384* *E385*
8688 global
Bram Moolenaarac6e65f2005-08-29 22:25:38 +00008689 Searches wrap around the end of the file. Also applies to |]s| and
8690 |[s|, searching for spelling mistakes.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008691
8692 *'write'* *'nowrite'*
8693'write' boolean (default on)
8694 global
8695 {not in Vi}
8696 Allows writing files. When not set, writing a file is not allowed.
8697 Can be used for a view-only mode, where modifications to the text are
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008698 still allowed. Can be reset with the |-m| or |-M| command line
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008699 argument. Filtering text is still possible, even though this requires
8700 writing a temporary file.
8701
8702 *'writeany'* *'wa'* *'nowriteany'* *'nowa'*
8703'writeany' 'wa' boolean (default off)
8704 global
8705 Allows writing to any file with no need for "!" override.
8706
8707 *'writebackup'* *'wb'* *'nowritebackup'* *'nowb'*
8708'writebackup' 'wb' boolean (default on with |+writebackup| feature, off
8709 otherwise)
8710 global
8711 {not in Vi}
8712 Make a backup before overwriting a file. The backup is removed after
8713 the file was successfully written, unless the 'backup' option is
Bram Moolenaar1aeaf8c2012-05-18 13:46:39 +02008714 also on.
8715 WARNING: Switching this option off means that when Vim fails to write
8716 your buffer correctly and then, for whatever reason, Vim exits, you
8717 lose both the original file and what you were writing. Only reset
8718 this option if your file system is almost full and it makes the write
8719 fail (and make sure not to exit Vim until the write was successful).
8720 See |backup-table| for another explanation.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008721 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway.
8722 NOTE: This option is set to the default value when 'compatible' is
8723 set.
8724
8725 *'writedelay'* *'wd'*
8726'writedelay' 'wd' number (default 0)
8727 global
8728 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar802a0d92016-06-26 16:17:58 +02008729 The number of milliseconds to wait for each character sent to the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008730 screen. When non-zero, characters are sent to the terminal one by
8731 one. For MS-DOS pcterm this does not work. For debugging purposes.
8732
8733 vim:tw=78:ts=8:ft=help:norl: